Owner’s Manual
VECTRA
Operation, Safety and Maintenance
Reproduction or translation, in whole or in parts,
is not permitted without prior written consent from
Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
All rights as understood under the copyright laws are explicitly
reserved by Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this
manual are based on the latest production information
available at the time of publication.
The right is reserved to make changes at any time without
notice.
Edition: July 2007.
TS 1557-A-08
VECTRA
©Copyright by Vauxhall Motors Ltd., England.
VAUXHALL Vectra
Operation, Safety, Maintenance
Data specific to your vehicle
Please enter your vehicle’s data here to keep it ea sily accessible.
This information is available under the section "Technical da ta " as well as on the identification plate and in the Serv ice Booklet.
Fuel
De signation
Engine oil
Grade
Viscosity
Tyre pressure
Tyre size
with up to 3 pe ople
with full load
Summer tyres
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Winter tyres
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Weights
Pe rmissible Gross Vehicle
Weight
–
EC ke rbweight
=
L oading
Your Vectra
is an intelligent c om bina tion of forwardlooking technology, impressiv e safety ,
env ironmenta l friendliness a nd economy.
It now lies with you to drive your vehicle
safely and ensure that it perform s
perfectly. This O wner’s Manual provides
you with all the necessary information to
that end.
Make sure y our pa ssengers a re awa re
of the p ossible risk of accid ent and injury
which may result from im proper use of the
vehic le.
You m ust alway s comply w ith the sp ecific
laws of the c ountry that y ou are travelling
through. These laws ma y differ from the
inform ation in this Ow ner’s Manual.
When instructed to consult a w ork shop,
we recomm end that y ou consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
All Vauxhall Authorised Repairers provide
first-class service at rea sonable prices.
Make use of the Owner’s
Manual:
z The "In brief" section will give you an
initial overv iew.
z The table of c ontents at the beginning of
the Owner’ s M anual and within the
individual chapters will show y ou where
every thing is.
z Its index will help you find what you
want.
z It w ill fa miliarise you with the
sophisticated technology.
z It w ill increase y our pleasure in your
vehicle.
z It w ill help you to handle your vehic le
expertly .
The O wner’s Manual is designed to be
clearly laid-out and easily understood.
This symbol signifies:
6 Continue read ing on next pa ge.
3 The asterisk signifies equipment not
fitted to all v ehicles (model variants,
engine op tions, models specific to one
country, optional equipment, Genuine
Vauxhall Parts and Acc essories).
9 Warn ing
Text marked 9 Warning provides
information on risk of accident or injury.
Disregard of the instructions may lead
to injuries or endanger life. Inform your
passeng ers accordingly.
Y ellow arrows in the illustrations serve as
points of reference or indicate some action
to be performed.
Black arrows in the illustrations indicate a
reaction or a second action to be
performed.
You will receiv e q uick , reliab le and
individual service.
Direc tional da ta, e.g. left or right, or front
or back, in the descriptions alway s relate to
the direction of travel.
Ex perienced mechanics, trained by
Vauxhall, work a ccord ing to specific
Vauxhall instructions.
Thank y ou for choosing a Vaux hall. We
wish you many hours of plea surable
driving.
The Owner’ s Manual should always be k ept
in the v ehicle: Rea dy to hand in the glove
compartment.
Your V auxhall Team
Contents
Comm itment to c ustomer
satisfaction:
Our ai m: to k eep you happy with your
vehicle. All Vauxhall Authorised Repairers
offer first-class serv ice a t competitiv e
prices. Experienced, factory-trained
technicians w ork according to factory
instructions. Y our Authorised Repa irer can
supply you with GEN UINE VAU XHALLAPPRO VED PARTS , which hav e und ergone
stringent quality and precision chec ks, and
of course useful and a ttrac tiv e
VAUXHALL-APPROVED AC CESSO RIES.
Our nam e i s your guara ntee!
For d eta ils of the
Va uxhall Authorised Rep airer Netw ork,
please r ing this number; 0845 090 2044
In b rief .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... . 2
K eys, doors, w indows, sunroof ... ..... .... .. 26
S eats, interior ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 50
Instrum ents, controls . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 98
Lighting ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 128
Infotainment system . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 137
C lim ate c ontrol .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 140
Driving and op eration ... .... ..... .... ..... .... 168
S elf-help, vehicle care .... .... ..... .... ..... .... 228
S ervice, maintena nce ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 268
Technical data .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 282
Index . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 314
2
In brief
In brief
To unlock and open vehicle:
Press bu tton q , pull door handle
6 Door locks, child safety locks –
see p age 41,
key s – see page 26,
electronic im mobiliser – see pag e 27,
remote control – see page 28,
central locking – see p age 30,
mechanical a nti-theft locking system 3 –
see p age 30,
Vauxhall a la rm system 3 – see pag e 38.
To unlock an d open the luggage
com partment:
Press button q on remote con trol,
press button o n boot lid/tailgate
and fo r Estate, pull catch
under handle
6 Remote control – see page 28,
central loc king – see page 30,
Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see page 38,
electrically op erated tailgate 3 –
see page 35.
In brief
To adjust front seats:
Pull han dle, slide seat,
release handle
To adjust front seat backrests:
Turn handwheel
6 Seats – see page 50,
seat p osition – see page 52,
electrically a djustable front sea ts –
see page 52.
Do not lean on seat b ackrest whilst
adjusting it.
9 Warning
Important: Do not sit nearer than
10 inches (25 cm ) from the steering
wheel, to permit sa fe airbag deployment.
Move seat backrest to suit seating position.
6 Seats – see pag e 50,
seat position – see page 52,
folding d ow n front passenger’ s seat
backrest – see page 66,
electrica lly adjusta ble front seats –
see p age 52.
3
To adjust fron t seat height 3 :
Operate lever on outboard side of
seat
Pump a ction of lever
Upwa rds:
Seat higher
Downwards:
Seat lower
6 Seats – see page 50,
seat position –see page 52,
electrically adjustable front seats –
see page 52.
4
In brief
Adjusting fron t seat inc lination 3:
Operate fro nt lever on outboard
side of seat
Electric seat adjustment 3 :
Operate switch o n outboard side
of seat
Pump action of lever
Upwards:
S eat steeper
Downwards:
S eat flatter
1
Adjusting the longitudinal position
2
3
Adjusting the inclination
Heig ht adjustment
6 Seats – see page 50,
seat p osition – see page 52,
electrically a djustable front sea ts –
see page 52.
4
5
Seat back rest adjustment
Lum bar supp ort 3
6 Seats – see pag e 52,
seat position – see page 52,
electrica lly adjusta ble front seats –
see p age 52.
To adjust head restraint height 3
of front and o utboard rear seats:
Press button to release,
adjust height, engage in position
6 Head restraints – see page 55,
hea d restraint position – see p age 56,
rear head restra ints – see p age 55.
In brief
To adjust head restraint angle 3
of front and outboard rear seats:
Swivel bottom edge of head
restraint forwards or backwards
6 Head restra ints – see p age 55,
head restraint position – see pag e 56,
rea r head restraints – see pag e 55.
To apply seat belt:
Pull o ut seat belt smoothly from
inertia reel, guide it over the
shou lder and engage in the
belt buckle
The seat b elt must not be twisted at any
point. The lap belt m ust lie snugly a gainst
the body. The bac krests m ust not be tilted
back too far (recommended m aximum
tilting a ngle approx . 25°).
To relea se belt, press red button on belt
buckle.
6 Three-point seat belts – see page 72,
airbag systems 3 – see page 81,
seat position – see page 52.
5
Adjusting interior mirror:
Swivel mirror hou sing
S wivel lever on underside of m irror housing
to reduce d azzle at night.
6 Mirror – see page 44,
automatic a nti-daz zle interior m irror 3 –
see page 44.
6
In brief
To adjust exterior mirrors:
Four-way switch in driver’s do or
If the outer m irror switch (1) is pressed, the
four-wa y switch operates the driver’s and
front passenger’s mirrors 3 , a nd if the inner
mirror switch (2) is pressed, it only operates
the front passenger’s m irror.
6 Mirrors – see pa ge 43,
aspherical exterior m irrors 3 – see pa ge 43,
automatic anti-dazz le exterior m irrors 3 –
see page 43,
heated exterior m irrors – see pag e 13,
electric seat adjustment 3 – see p age 54.
Steering column lock and ignition :
Turn key to position 1.
Mo ve steering wheel slightly to
release steering column loc k
Positions:
0 = Ig nition off
1 = S teering free, ignition off
2 = Ig nition on, for diesel engines:
Preheating
3 = S tarting
6 Starting – see page 15,
electronic im mobiliser – see pag e 27,
parking the v ehicle – see page 16.
Steerin g wh eel adjustment 3 :
Move lever down ,
adjust height and distance,
move lever up,
engage
Adjust steering wheel only when vehicle is
stationary and steering colum n loc k is
released.
6 Airb ag systems 3 – see page 81.
In brief
Turn light
7
=
8
=
9
=
AUTO =
switch:
Off
Parking lights
Dipped or main beam
Automatic dipped
beam activation 3
Press button:
>
= Front fog lights 3
r
= Fog tail light
6 Lighting – see pa ge 128,
head lig ht control indicator –
see pages 100, 126, 128.
Headlight flash, main beam and
dipped beam:
Headlight
= Pull stalk
flash
towards
steering wheel
Main beam
= Push stalk
forwards
Dipped beam = Push stalk
forwards again
or pull towards
steering wheel
6 Main beam, headlight flash –
see p age 129.
Switch on tu rn signal lights:
Right
= Stalk up
Left
= Stalk down
6 Turn signal lights – see page 130.
7
8
In brief
In brief
1
Page
Side air v ents ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 142
2
Front pa ssenger’s airbag . .... ..... .... . 81
3
Centre air v ents .... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 142
4
Infotainm ent system 3 . .... .... ..... ... 137
5
Central information display for
time, date, outside temperature,
Infotainm ent system 3,
check control 3,
trip computer 3,
Electronic Climate Control 3 . ..... ... 108
6
Turn signal lights... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 7
Headlight flash,
dipped beam a nd main beam . .... .... 7
Door-to-door lighting 3 .... .... ..... .... 133
Parking lights ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 134
Cruise control 3 .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 200
7
Steering wheel remote c ontrol 3 .. 137
8
Instruments .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .. 98
9
Horn .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .. 11
Driver’ s airb ag . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 81
10
11
Pa ge
Windscreen wiper,
wind screen wash system,
headlight wash system 3 and
rear window w ash system 3 .... ..... .. 11
Pa rk ing lights, dipped beam ... ..... 128
Instrument illumination ... ..... .... ..... 134
Fog tail lig ht .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... 131
Front fog lights 3 ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... 130
Head lig ht range adjustment 3 ..... 131
9
Page
19 Ashtray s ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 94
20 S towa ge c om partment
with AUX input 3 .... .... ..... .... ..... .... 138
21 C igarette lighter 3 or socket ... .... .. 93
22 C lim ate c ontrol .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 163
23 Heated seat (left) 3 .... ..... .... ..... .... 144
Haz ard warning lights .... .... ..... .... 131
Parking distance sensors 3 . ..... .... 202
12
Unlock ing the bonnet ... .... ..... .... .... 228
24 Glove compartment ... ..... .... ... 95, 135
13
Starter switch with steering
colum n lock ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... ... 6
25 Fusebox . ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 246
14
Ac celera tor pedal .... .... .... ..... .... .... 184
15
Brake peda l ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 185, 208
16
Steering wheel adjustm ent .. .... ..... ... 6
17
Clutch ped al 3 . .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 185
18
Heated seat (right) 3 and
seat climate control 3 . .... ..... .... ..... 144
Vauxhall a la rm system 3 ..... .... ..... . 38
Rear w indow blind 3 ... .... ..... .... ..... . 49
and
Electronic S tability Programme 3 196
SPORT mode 3 ... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 198
10
In brief
Control indicato rs
O
Turn signal l ights,
see pages 7, 98, 130.
I
Eng ine oi l pressure,
see page 98.
R
Brak e system , clut ch system,
see pages 99, 209, 276.
p
Alternat or,
see page 99.
v
Airb ag systems 3 ,
belt t ensioners 3,
see pages 74, 86.
W
Coola nt temperat ure,
see pages 100, 106.
8
Exterior l ights,
see pages 100, 128.
1
SPO RT mode of autom atic
tra nsm ission 3,
see pages 100, 178, 179.
T
Winter progr amm e of
autom atic transmission 3 or
Easytronic 3,
see pages 100, 172, 180.
(
Door open 3,
see page 100.
j
Easytronic 3,
start ing the eng ine 3,
see pages 100, 169.
t
Bulb replac em ent 3,
see p ages 100, 252.
u
Anti -lock Bra ke Syst em (A BS ),
see page 210.
s
Open lugg age comp artment,
see p ages 34, 101.
p
>
Front fog lights 3 ,
see p ages 101, 130.
Electro-hyd raulic p ower
assisted steer ing,
see page 103.
v
C
Main beam ,
see p ages 7, 101, 128.
Electronic S tabil ity Prog ramm e
(ES P® P lu s ) 3 ,
see pages 103, 196.
r
Fog t ail li ght,
see p ages 101, 131.
y
Seat occupancy recogniti on 3,
see pages 87, 103.
r
Pa rking distance sensors 3,
see p ages 101, 202.
S
Engine oil level 3 ,
see pages 103, 272.
u
Continuous Dam ping Control 3 ,
SPORT m ode,
see p ages 101, 198.
m
C ruise cont rol 3,
see page 200.
Y
Fuel lev el,
see pages 103, 106, 228.
Z
Exhaust g ases 3,
see pages 104, 192.
w
Tyre p ressure monitori ng
system 3,
see pages 104, 204.
B
Ad aptiv e Forwa rd Lighting
(AFL) 3,
see pages 104, 132.
X
Seat belt 3,
see p age 101.
A
Engine electronic s, transmission
elect ronics 3, diesel fuel fi lter 3 ,
immob iliser,
see p ages 27, 101, 192.
!
Pr eheating for diesel engines 3,
diesel p artic le fi lter 3,
see p ages 102, 194.
H
Coolant lev el ,
see p ages 102, 275.
In brief
Hazard warning lights:
On
= Press ¨
Off
= Press ¨ again
6 Hazard w arning lights – see pa ge 131.
Activate horn:
Press j in c entre of steering
wh eel
6 Airbag system s 3 – see pag e 81,
remote control on steering wheel 3 –
see p age 137.
11
Win dscreen wiper:
Gently push stalk upwards
§
=
Off
$
=
Adjustable timed
interval wipe
%
=
Slow
&
=
Fast
Press the stalk down from position §:
S ingle swipe.
6 Windscreen wiper – see page 126,
adjustable wiper interva l 3 – see pa ge 126,
wiper blades – see pages 277, 278,
vehicle c are – see page 264.
12
In brief
Automatic wiping with rain
sen sor 3:
Gently push stalk upwards
§
= Off
$
= Automatic wipin g with
rain senso r
Autom atic wiping $ :
Low sensitivity :
Move adjuster wheel
to the left
High sensitivity:
Move adjuster wheel
to the right
6 Windscreen wiper – see page 126,
wiper blades – see pages 277, 278,
vehic le care – see p age 264.
Operating windscreen and
headlight wash systems 3 :
Pull stalk towards steering wheel
6 Windscreen wa sh system and headlight
wash system 3 – see page 127,
further information – see pag es 264, 278.
Operating rear window wiper 3
and wash systems 3 :
Wiper on = Push stalk
forwards
Wiper off = Push stalk
forwards again
Wash
= Hold stalk in fully
forwards positio n
6 Rear window wiper 3 and rear window
wash 3 systems – see page 127,
further inform ation – see pages 264, 277,
278.
In brief
Heated rear window,
heated exterior mirrors:
On
= Press Ü
Off = Press Ü again
To demist or defrost windows:
Set air distribution to l,
turn rotary knob for temperature
and airflo w clockwise;
6 Air c onditioning 3 – see page 140,
heated rear window, heated exterior
mirrors – see page 143.
Air con ditioning system 3:
Press bu ttons n and V ;
Automatic air conditioning
system 3:
Press bu ttons n and V ,
turn rotary knob for
temperature clockwise,
airflow to A;
Electronic Climate Control 3:
Press bu tton V
6 C lim ate control – see pa ge 140.
13
Setting auto matic m ode of
Electronic Climate Control 3:
Press AUTO button,
set temperature for driver’s
and front passenger’s sides using
left and right rotary knobs
6 Electronic C limate Control 3 –
see page 156.
14
In brief
Manual transmission:
Reverse gear: with vehicle sta tionary, pull
the ring up three seconds after depressing
clutch ped al and engage gear.
If the gear does not engag e, set the lever in
neutral, release the clutch pedal and
depress again; then repeat gear selection.
Easytronic 3 :
N
= Idling
o
= D rive positio n
+
= Higher gear
= Lower gear
A/M = Switch between
Automatic and Man ual
mode
R
= Reverse gear (with
selector lever lock)
The selector lever must alway s be mov ed in
the appropriate direction as far as it will
go. Upon release, it autom atically returns
to the centre position. Pay heed to the
gear/mode ind icator in the transm ission
display .
The footb rake must b e depressed when
starting.
6 Easytronic 3 – see page 168.
Automatic transmissio n 3 :
P
= Park position
R = Reverse gear
N = Neutral position (idling)
D = Au tomatic gear selection
Selector lever in D to the left:
Man ual mo de
+ = Higher gear
- = Lower gear
P or N must b e engaged when starting .
In brief
In order to leav e P, switch on ignition,
depress footbrake and press b utton on
selector lever.
Before starting-o ff, check:
To engag e P or R, press button on selector
lev er.
P Only with vehicle stationary, apply
ha nd brake beforehand.
R Only if vehicle is stationary.
z Engine oil level and fluid levels in engine
compa rtm ent – see p ages 271 to 279.
6 Automatic transmission 3 –
see page 176.
15
z Tyre pressure and condition –
see pages 204, 211, 299.
z All windows, mirrors, ex terior lighting
and number plates a re free from dirt,
snow and ice and are operational.
z No objec ts are placed in front of the rear
window, on the instrument p anel or in
the area in w hich the airbags infla te.
z Seats, seat b elts and mirrors are
correctly adjusted.
z Brake opera tion.
To start engine:
Operate clutch and brake pedals,
automatic transmission 3
in P or N,
Easytronic 3: D epress brake,
do no t accelerate,
Petrol engines: Turn key to 3;
Diesel engines: Turn key to 2,
when control indicator !
goes out1) , tu rn key to 3;
release key once engine
is running
To restart or switch off the engine, turn key
bac k to 0.
To switch on the ignition, only turn the key
to 2.
6 Electronic im mobiliser – see pag e 27,
diesel fuel system – see page 228.
1)
Preh eatin g system sw itches on o nly if outside
tem perature is low .
16
In brief
Parking the vehic le
z Always ap ply the ha nd brake firmly
without pressing the release button;
to do this, fold up the armrest 3. Apply
handbrake as fully as possible on an
uphill or downhill incline. To red uce the
amount of force required to activa te the
handbrake, depress the footbrake at the
same time.
Releasing th e handbrake:
Raise lever slightly,
press release button,
lower lever fully
6 Handbrake – see pag e 209.
z Sw itch off the engine; to do this, turn the
ignition key to 0. Remov e the ignition k ey
and turn the steering wheel until the
steering colum n lock (anti-theft
protection) enga ges. In v ehicles with
automatic transmission 3, the key ca n
only be removed when the selector lev er
is in P.
z If the vehicle is parked on a flat surfa ce
or an uphill incline, engage first gear
before switching off the ignition if y ou
have manual transmission or
Easy tronic 3 ; if the vehicle has
automatic transmission 3, place the
selector lever in P. O n an uphill incline,
also turn the front wheels away from the
kerb.
If the vehicle is on a downhill incline,
eng age reverse gear before switching off
the ig nition if you have ma nual
transm ission or Easytronic 3; if the
vehicle has automatic transmission 3,
place the selector lever in P. Also turn the
front wheels towards the kerb.
z Lock the doors and luggage
compartment and ac tiv ate the Vauxhall
alarm sy stem 3 by pressing button p on
the remote control.
To activate the mechanical anti-theft
loc king sy stem 3 , press button p a gain
no more than 15 seconds after locking.
Advice when parking:
z Do not park vehicle on easily ignitable
surfaces, since the hot exhaust system
temperatures could cause the surfa ce to
ignite.
z On v ehicles with Easy tronic 3 , control
ind ic ator R fla shes for a few seconds
after the ignition is switched off if the
ha nd brake ha s not been a pplied –
see page 174.
z Close windows and sunroof 3 .
z The eng ine cooling fans m ay run after
the eng ine has been switched off –
see page 271.
6 Remote control – see page 28,
central loc king – see pag e 30,
Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see page 38,
vehicle d ecommissioning – see page 281.
In brief
17
That was a brief overview of the
most important in formation for
your first drive in your vehicle.
The other pages o f this chapter
con tain a summary of the
interesting fun ction s in your
vehicle.
The remain ing ch apters of the
Owner’s Manual contain
impo rtant information on
operatio n, safety and
maintenance as well as a
com plete in dex.
18
In brief
Airbag system
The a irb ag system c onsists of several
separate systems.
Front airb ag system
The front airbag system will be triggered in
the event of a serious ac cident involving a
frontal impact and forms safety cushions
for the driver and front passenger.
The forward movem ent of the d riv er and
front passenger is check ed a nd the risk of
injuries to the upper body a nd head are
thereby substantially reduced.
Side airb ag system 3
The side a irb ag system triggers when a
side-on collision occurs a nd provides a
safety barrier for the driver and/or front
passenger in the respective front door
area. This reduc es the risk of injury to the
up per body considera bly, in the event of a
side-impact.
C ur tain ai rbag syst em 3
The curtain a irba g system triggers in the
event of a side-on collision and provides a
safety barrier in the head area on the
respective side of the v ehicle. This red uces
the risk of injury to the head considera bly in
the event of a side-on collision.
6 Airb ag systems 3 – see page 81.
In brief
Active head restraints 3 at front
seats
Operating menus in th e
information display 3
S elec tion using multi-function knob:
Rotate and press multi-function knob.
In the event of a rear-im pact, the active
head restraints tilt forwards a little. The
head is more effectively supported by the
head restraint and the d ang er of injuries
caused by whiplash in the neck area is
red uced.
Menu options are selected using menus
and using the buttons/four-way button
or the multi-function knob of the
Infotainment sy stem 3 or the left-hand
adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel.
The respective menu options a re show n
on the display.
To exit a m enu, turn the m ulti-func tion
knob left or right to Return or Mai n and
select.
Active head restraints are id entified by the
lettering ACTIVE on the head restraint
guide sleev es.
6 Head restra ints – see p age 55.
To select w ith four-way button:
Press the four-way button up, down, right
or left.
19
20
In brief
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
1
257.0
Ø 40
8
7.0
Ø 31.0
Tyres
Selection using left-ha nd adjuster wheel on
steering wheel:
Rotate and press adjuster wheel.
6 Information display – see page 108.
19,5° 19:36
All values
miles
Coolant level
mph
ch eck
gal.
miles/ gal.
Trip computer 3
The trip computer provides information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and ev alua ted electronically.
Functions:
z Range,
z Instanta neous consum ption,
z Distanc e travelled,
z Average speed,
z Effective consumption,
z Average consumption,
z Stop watch,
z Tyre pressure 3.
6 Trip comp uter 3 – see pages 114, 120.
OK
Check control
3
The check control softwa re monitors:
z Fluid levels,
z Tyre pressures 3 ,
z Remote control battery,
z Vauxhall alarm system 3,
z Important ex terior lights, inc luding
cables and fuses.
6 Check control 3 – see pa ge 124.
In brief
Remote control on steering
wheel 3
The functions of the Infotainm ent system 3
and the information display can be
opera ted with the buttons and ad juster
wheels on the steering wheel.
Further information is available in the
Infotainm ent system operating
instructions.
6 Remote control on steering wheel 3 –
see page 137,
Infotainm ent system – see page 137.
Twin Audio
3
Tw in Audio p rov id es rear seat occupants
with the opportunity to listen to a different
audio source tha n the one selected by the
driver on the Infotainment sy stem 3 .
FlexOrganizer 3
Only a n audio source tha t is not currently
active on the Infotainm ent system c an be
controlled using Twin Audio.
The sy stem consists of:
z Variable partition net,
z Variable partition wall,
z Partition rod,
z Mesh pockets for the side walls,
z Hooks.
Tw o headp hone connections are a vailable,
with separate volum e c ontrols.
Further inform ation is av ailable in the
Infotainment sy stem opera ting
instructions.
6 Twin Audio 3 – see page 138.
The side walls contain retaining strips,
where va rious components can be
attached to divide the lugg age
compa rtm ent or fasten loads.
6 FlexO rg aniz er 3 – see page 69.
21
22
In brief
C ur ve lighti ng
The Xenon light b eam pivots based on
steering wheel position and vehicle speed,
from app rox . 6 mph (10 km/h).
The headlights shine at an angle of up
to 15° to the right or left of the direction of
travel.
Turn lig hting
An add itional light illuminates at certain
steering w heel settings (a fter approx. 90°),
turn signal settings and speeds up to
app rox . 25 mph (40 k m/h).
Travel Assistant
3
The Trav el Assistant contains:
z Arm rest,
z Stowage compartments,
z Waste container,
z Drink holders,
z Acc essory sockets,
z Connection console
e.g. for DVD p la yer 3,
z Elec tric cool box,
z Foldaway tables,
z Tw in Audio (rear audio module) 3 or
stowage compartm ent.
The Trav el Assistant is installed on a
console above the c entre seat in the rear.
6 Trav el Assistant 3 – see page 58.
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) 3
On vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlights, AFL
improves illumination of:
z C urves (curv e lighting),
z Intersec tions and tight turns (turn
lighting).
The lig ht beam projects at a 90° angle to
the left or right of the v ehicle up to a
distance of a pprox. 30 metres.
Mot or way lighti ng
At higher speeds and continuous straight
ahead travel, the dipped bea m
automatically raises slightly, thereby
increa sing hea dlight rang e.
6 Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL) 3 –
see page 132.
In brief
23
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
Tyres
Parking distance senso rs
3
When rev erse gear is selected, the pa rk ing
distance sensors switch on automatically.
The p arking dista nce sensors ca n also be
activated at speeds of less than 15 m ph
(25 k m/h) by pressing the r button on
the instrum ent panel.
If the vehicle approaches a n ob stacle to
the front or rea r, a series of signals is
audible in the vehicle interior. The interval
between the signals becomes shorter a s
the d istance is reduced. If the dista nce is
less than 30 cm , the signal will b e
continuous.
6 Park ing distance sensors 3 –
see page 202.
SPORT mode
3
To activ ate
Press the SPORT button. The LED in the
button illuminates.
SPORT mode is used to cha ng e
damping 3 , steering 3, throttle application
and the shifting tim es and shifting p oints
for Easytronic 3 and automatic
tra nsmission 3 whilst driving.
Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3
The tyre p ressure monitoring system
continuously monitors the pressure of all
four tyres while the vehicle is being driven.
A pressure sensor is insta lled in ea ch wheel.
The tyre p ressures of the indiv idua l tyres
are transmitted to a controller, where they
are compared.
Damping and steering 3 b ecome more
direct and provide better contac t with the
road surface. The engine reacts more
quic kly to ac celera tor m ovem ents.
The current tyre pressures ca n be
displayed on the Gra phic al Inform ation
Display or the Colour Inform ation
Display 3.
With automatic transmission 3, the shift
tim es are reduced and g ear changes occur
at higher eng ine speeds (not w hen cruise
control 3 is a ctive).
Deviating tyre pressures are displayed in
the form of messages on the information
display whilst driving.
6 SPO RT mode 3 – see page 198.
6 Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 –
see page 204.
24
In brief
z To close:
– Hold down the r button on the rem ote
control until the tailgate is closed.
- or – When the key is inserted in the starter
switch and the handbrake is applied ,
hold down the x button in the driver’ s
door until the ta ilg ate is shut.
- or – Press the F button in the tailgate.
Electrically operated tailgate,
Estate 3
z To op en:
– Hold down remote control button r
(see page 35, Fig. 17548 J) for a pprox.
1 second.
- or – When the k ey is inserted in the starter
switch and the handbrak e is app lied,
hold down the x button in the driver’s
door for approx. 1 second .
- or – Unlock the tailgate and open by pulling
the ca tch beneath the handle.
6 Electrically operated tailgate 3 –
see p age 35.
Towing equipment with pivoting
cou pling ball bar 3
The relea se lev er is in the left stowag e
compa rtm ent in the lugga ge
compa rtm ent. O pen cover.
z Pull release lever downwards.
– The LED on the lev er is illuminated w hile
the coupling b all bar is not engaged.
– In ad dition, a warning buzzer sounds
and the coupling ball bar pivots
downwards.
z Piv ot the coupling ball b ar backw ards
until it engages.
– LED m ust extinguish,
– Warning buzzer must cease,
– O therwise, repea t the procedure.
6 Tow ing equipment with pivoting
coupling ball b ar 3 – see page 222.
In brief
Diesel particle filter 3
The d iesel pa rticle filter system removes
polluting soot particles out of the engine
exhaust ga ses. The system includes a
self-cleaning function that op erates
automatically whilst driving. The filter is
cleaned by burning the trapped soot
particles at a high temperature. There ma y
be an increase in fuel consumption,
exhaust smell, and engine cooling fan
opera tion 3 during the self-clea ning
opera tion.
The self-cleaning function cannot operate
automatically during c ertain driving
situations where the engine does not reach
its norma l operating tempera ture.
An ex ample of this would b e driv ing only
short distances in cold weather.
If the filter needs cleaning and rec ent
driving situa tions did not allow the function
to autom atically operate, then control
indica tor ! will flash. If this occurs, then
you may continue to drive the vehicle
normally . The vehicle will not be damaged
and does not req uire service.
The self-cleaning function will
autom atic ally operate whilst driving after
the engine has reached its norma l
op erating temperature. Control
indica tor ! will continue to flash until the
self-c leaning operation is complete. This
may ta ke up to 20 minutes of driving.
The time will be shorter at higher vehicle
speeds.
6 Diesel particle filter 3 – see page 194.
25
26
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Keys, doors, windows,
sunroof
Replacem ent keys ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Loc k cylinders . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ca r Pass 3 ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Key with foldaw ay key section 3 . ..... .
Electronic immobiliser... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Store and activate personal vehicle
settings using the remote control ... .
Remote control .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Central locking system . .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Fault when locking or unlocking... ..... .
Lug gage compartment .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Vauxhall alarm system 3. ..... .... .... ..... .
Child safety locks . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Universal remote c ontrol in mirror
housing 3.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ex terior mirrors..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Interior mirror .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Electric windows 3 ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Wind ow s in rear doors . .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Sunroof 3 .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Electrically operated rear window
blind 3 .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Sunblinds for rear door windows 3 ... .
26
26
26
26
27
28
28
30
33
34
38
41
41
43
44
45
47
47
49
49
Replacement keys
The key number is specified in the vehic le
docum ents and in the C ar Pass 3.
The key is a c onstituent of the electronic
immobiliser. Ordering keys from a Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer g uarantees problem free op eration of the electronic
immobiliser.
Keep the sp are k ey in a safe plac e.
Locks - see pa ge 266.
Loc k cylinders
Designed to free-wheel if they are
forcefully rotated without the correct k ey or
if the correct key is not fully inserted.
To reset, turn cy linder with the c orrect key
until its slot is vertica l, remove key and then
re-insert it. If the cylinder still free-wheels,
turn the key through 180° and rep eat
op eration.
Car Pass 3
The Ca r Pass contains a ll of the vehicle’s
data and should therefore not be k ept in
the vehicle.
Have your Ca r Pa ss to hand when
consulting a Vaux hall Authorised Repairer.
Key with foldaway key section 3
Press button to extend. Press button to
retrac t and audibly engage key sec tion.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
27
If c ontrol indicator A illuminates a fter
the engine is started, there is a fault in
the engine elec tronics or transmission
electronics 3 (see pages 101, 174, 182,
192) or there is water in the diesel fuel
filter 3 (see page 274).
Not e
The immobiliser does not lock the doors.
Therefore, after leaving the v ehicle a lways
lock it and switch on the Vaux hall alarm
system 3 – see p ages 30, 38.
Electronic immo biliser
The sy stem checks whether the vehicle m ay
be sta rted using the key that has been
inserted. If the k ey is recognised as
"authorised" the vehicle can be started.
The c heck is carried out via a transponder
in the k ey.
The electronic imm ob iliser activates
automatically when the k ey is removed
from the starter switch.
The c od e number of the electronic
immobiliser is giv en in the C ar Pass.
Control i nd icator for imm obiliser
Control indica tor A illuminates briefly
when the ig nition is sw itched on.
If the control indicator flashes w hen the
ignition is on, there is a fault in the sy stem;
the engine cannot be started. S witc h off
the ignition and then rep eat the start
attempt.
If the control indicator A continues to
flash, try to start the engine using the spare
key and conta ct a workshop for assistance.
28
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
The remote control has a range of approx .
5 metres. This rang e ca n be a ffected by
outside influences. Aim the rem ote control
at the vehicle to operate.
Store and activate person al
vehicle settings using th e remote
control
The last settings selec ted for:
z Instrument illumination,
Handle the remote control with care,
protec t it from moisture and high
temperatures a nd avoid unnecessary
operation.
z Central locking,
z Memory function 3 for driver’s seat
and mirror,
The ha zard warning lights illuminate to
indicate that the remote c ontrol is
operational.
z Elec tronic C limate Control 3
are automatically stored depending on the
vehic le key used .
Different settings are stored for each
rem ote control. Use of a remote control will
activate the settings associa ted with it.
The settings for five remote controls can be
stored.
C entra l lock ing system,
see page 30.
Remote co ntro l
The remote control is integrated in the key.
Used to operate:
z C entral locking system,
z Mechanic al anti-theft locking system 3 ,
z Vauxhall alarm system 3,
z Electrically operated tailgate, Estate 3.
In a ddition, electric windows 3 and electric
sunroof 3 can be closed using the remote
control.
Mechanic al anti -theft locki ng system 3 ,
see page 30.
Boot l id or ta ilgat e,
see page 34.
Vauxhall ala rm system 3,
see page 38.
Electric w indows 3 ,
see page 45.
Electrica lly op era ted sunr oof 3,
see page 47.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Fault
If the central locking system cannot be
opera ted with the remote control, it m ay b e
due to the following :
Mak e sure that you dispose of old batteries
in accordance with env ironmental
protec tion regulations.
Remot e cont rol synchronisati on
After a battery change, unlock door with
key in lock - see page 33. Inserting the key
into the lock sy nc hronises the remote
control.
z The range of the rem ote control has
been ex ceeded.
z Remote control b attery v olta ge is too
low. Battery replac ement - see next
column.
z Freq uent, rep eated opera tion of the
remote control outside the reception
ra nge of the vehicle (e.g. too far from
vehicle, rem ote control is then no longer
recognised). Remote control
synchronisation – see end column.
z If the centra l loc king sy stem is
ov erloaded as a result of repeated
op eration at short interv als. The power
supply is c ut off for a b rief period.
z Interference from higher-power radio
waves from other sources.
To elim inate the cause of a fault, we
recom mend contacting a workshop for
assistance.
Manual unlocking and locking using the
vehic le key - see page 33.
29
Rem ote control b attery rep lacement
Replace the battery as soon as the range
of the rem ote control becom es reduced.
Extending the key – see page 26.
Open the remote c ontrol. Replace the
battery (b attery ty pe – see page 307),
noting insta lla tion position. Close the
remote control.
30
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Cen tral locking system
For doors, b oot lid/tailgate and tank flap.
To unlock
Press button q on rem ote control.
To lock
Press button p on remote control.
Mechanic al anti -theft locki ng system 3
9 Warnin g
Do not use the system if there are people
in the vehicle. The doors cannot b e
unlocked from inside.
All doors must be c losed . Press button p
on rem ote control again no more tha n
15 seconds after locking.
Lock buttons on all doors are positioned
such tha t doors ca nnot be opened.
If the ignition wa s on, the driver’s door
must be opened and closed once so that
the vehicle can be secured .
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Program ming unloc king m ode 3
When the vehicle is delivered from the
factory, the remote c ontrol is preset so that
a single press of the q button op ens all of
the d oors and the luggage compartment.
The unit c an be config ured so that a single
press of the q button unlocks the entire
vehic le or just the driver’s door.
Change to presetting:
Hold b utton q on the remote control and
button m in the driv er’s door depressed
simulta neously until a double buzzer
sounds. Afterwa rd s, only the driver’s door
will be unlocked when b utton q is pressed
once.
The entire vehicle is then unlocked by
pressing button q on the remote control
twice.
To restore the origina l settings, hold
button q on the remote control and
button m in the driv er’s door depressed
simulta neously until a buz zer sound s.
The current setting is stored for the remote
control - see page 28.
31
Autom atic locking 3
The central locking ca n be set to lock
automatically at a certain sp eed.
To activate the function, hold button p on
the remote control and button m in the
driver’s door dep ressed simultaneously
until a double buzzer sounds.
Central l oc king sw itch for loc king a nd
unl ocking the d oors from inside the
vehicle
Press button m in the driver’ s door:
Doors and luggag e comp artment are
lock ed.
Press button ) in the driver’ s d oor:
Doors and luggag e comp artment are
unlocked.
In the Estate with electrically operated
tailg ate 3, the doors and lugga ge
compartment are locked and unlocked
with button m.
When the mechanical anti-theft locking
sy stem is active 3 (see p age 30), the doors
cannot b e unlocked with this b utton.
If the v ehicle is locked using the remote
control, b uttons m and ) in the driv er’s
door are inopera ble.
The doors and lugga ge c om partment a re
unlocked by switching off the ignition or by
pressing button ) or, for Estate with
electrically op erated tailgate 3, b y
pressing button m in the driv er’s door.
Individ ual doors can b e unlocked by
pulling the lock button.
To deactivate the function, hold button p
on the remote control and button m in the
driver’s door dep ressed simultaneously
until a buzzer sounds.
The current setting is stored for the rem ote
control - see page 28.
32
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
The electric windows 3 can be closed from
outside: hold d own button p on the
remote control until all windows are closed.
Note
z If the driv er’s door is not closed properly ,
the central lock ing sy stem will unlock
again immediately after locking.
The sunroof 3 can be c losed from outside:
hold down button p on the remote control
until the roof is fully closed.
z 30 seconds after unlocking using the
remote control, the doors automa tic ally
lock again 3 if neither a door nor the
lugga ge c om partment has been
op ened.
Vehicle with electrically retrac ta ble
exterior mirrors 3:
When closing the windows using the
remote control, the ex terior mirrors will also
be retracted. The mirrors w ill be folded
bac k out when the vehicle is unlocked using
the remote control.
z To lock the doors from within (e.g. to
prevent undesired acc ess from outside),
press the central lock ing button m.
z If they are locked, the doors and the
lugga ge c om partment unlock
automa tic ally in the event of an a ccident
of a certain sev erity (to permit outside
assistance). Prerequisite: Ignition must
not be switched off.
Closing the wi ndows 3 a nd sunroof 3
from outside using the remote contr ol
9 Warning
Take care when operating the electric
windows 3 a nd the sunroof 3. Risk of
injury , particularly to c hildren.
Vehicle passeng ers must be informed
accordingly.
K eep a close watch on the windows and
sunroof when c losing them. Ensure that
nothing becomes trapped in them a s
they move.
If the mirrors a re retracted using the button
in the driver’s door, they remain in this
position w hen the doors are unlocked.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Autom atic closing 3
If the mec hanical anti-theft lock ing
system 3 is activated , the elec tric
windows 3 and sunroof 3 are
automatically closed and the electric ally
retractab le exterior m irrors 3 are
automatically retracted as soon as the rain
sensor 3 detects water on the windscreen.
Ma lfunction in centra l locki ng system
To unlock:
Insert key into driver’s door lock and turn
towards front of v ehicle a s far as it will go.
Turn key back to a v ertical position a nd
remove. The other d oors can b e unlocked
by pulling the interior lock b utton (unless
the mechanical anti-theft locking sy stem 3
has been ena bled). The luggage
compa rtm ent and the tank flap
remain locked .
To safeguard the battery from discha rge
by the rain sensor 3, after four hours the
electric windows 3 a nd sunroof 3 are
automatically closed and the electric ally
retractab le exterior m irrors 3 a re
automatically retracted .
For further information on electric
windows 3 and the sunroof 3 –
see pages 47, 49.
Fault
If the central locking system cannot be
opera ted with the remote control, it m ay b e
due to the following :
z The c entral lock ing system is ov erloaded
as a result of repeated operation a t short
intervals. The power sup ply is cut off for
a brief p eriod.
z Defective fuse in fusebox –
see pa ge 246.
Seek the assistanc e of a workshop to rectify
the ca use of the fa ult. To open the driver’s
door with the k ey - see the following
section.
33
Fault when lockin g or unlocking
Rem ote control fa ul t
To unlock:
Insert key into lock in driver’s door and turn
tow ards front of vehicle as far as it will go.
Turn key b ack to v ertical position a nd
remove from lock. Unloc k d riv er’s d oor with
central locking switch - see page 31.
The mechanical anti-theft lock ing sy stem 3
is d eactivated when the key is inserted in
the starter switch.
To lock :
Open front p assenger’s door, close driver’s
door, lock vehicle using central locking
switch (see page 31), close front
passenger’s door.
To lock:
Lock front pa ssenger’s door and rear doors
by pressing the interior lock b utton. Lock
driver’s door with key in lock. Turn key
towards rea r of vehicle as far as it will go,
turn key to a vertical position and remove.
The unlocked tank flap and the lugga ge
compa rtm ent cannot be locked .
34
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Luggage compartment
To unlock
Press button q on rem ote control.
To op en
The luggage compartment of the S aloon /
Hatch is opened by pressing the button,
and the luggag e com partment of the
Estate is opened by pulling the ca tc h
beneath the handle.
Illum ination of control ind icator s
indica tes that the b oot lid/tailgate is open.
For notes on open boot lid /tailgate see p age 37.
Elec trica lly operated tailgate, Estate 3 –
see next pag e.
To close
There is a handle on the inside of the
boot lid/tailgate for closing the luggag e
compa rtm ent.
With the Estate, do not operate the catch
beneath the ha ndle when closing,
otherwise the luggage compartment will
be unloc ked again.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
35
Electri cally operated t ailgat e, Estat e 3
In Estate vehicles w ith a n elec trica lly
op erated tailgate, the tailga te can b e
electrica lly opened and c losed after
unlocking.
9 Warning
Mak e sure there is more tha n 2 m etres
clearance b efore operating the electric
tailgate. O bserve the pivoting z one of the
tailgate during operation and d o not
enter the p iv oting zone.
To lock
Press button p on the remote control
– or –
Press central locking b utton m in d riv er’s
door when the doors are closed.
To op en:
Unlock the vehic le by pressing button q on
the rem ote control; the tailga te is opened
electrica lly by pulling the catch beneath
the handle.
– or –
Briefly press button r on the remote
control to unlock the tailgate (the doors
remain locked .) The tailga te is opened
electrically by pulling the catch beneath
the ha ndle.
– or –
Hold down button r on the rem ote control
for more tha n 1 second (the doors remain
locked); the tailgate is unlocked and opens
electrically
– or –
6
36
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
With the key in the starter sw itc h and the
handbrake applied, hold button x in
the d riv er’s door depressed for app rox .
1 second; the tailgate opens electrically.
To close:
Hold d ow n button r on the remote control
until the tailgate is closed.
– or –
Hold down button x in the driver’s door
when the k ey is inserted in the starter
switch until the tailga te is closed.
– or –
Press button F in the tailgate; the tailgate
closes electrically.
To lock, press button p on the remote
control.
Tailgate opening and closing is indicated
by the rea r turn sig na l lig hts flashing three
times.
If the luggage compartment is not closed
within 20 minutes of opening, the button in
the tailgate is deactivated.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Interruption of tailgate op ening/closing
proced ure
The opening or closing p rocess is
immediately interrupted by:
briefly pressing button x in the driver’ s
door,
– or –
button r on the remote control,
– or –
the external button beneath the hand le,
– or –
button F in the ta ilg ate.
Safety function
The tailgate has an obstruction detection
fa cility . If the tailgate encounters
resistance during the automatic closing
movem ent, the closing procedure is
stopped imm ediately and the tailgate is
slowly op ened again.
The tailga te remains in this position for
10 second s a nd then slowly reopens.
Fault in electrically op erated tailgate
If the electronic drive should fail, the
tailg ate c an be op ened and closed
manually, although more force is required
to close the tailgate.
Vehicles with towing equipment 3:
When tow ing a carava n/trailer, the
tailg ate c annot be opera ted using
button r on the rem ote control or
button x in the driver’ s d oor.
Opening the tailgate when the doors a re
lock ed via the central locking system
If the doors are loc ked via the central
lock ing system, the tailgate can be op ened
by pressing button r on the rem ote control
and pulling the catch beneath the handle.
37
O pen boot lid , open tail gate
9 Warnin g
Do not drive with the boot lid or tailgate
open or ajar, e.g . when transporting
bulky objects, since toxic exhaust gas
could penetra te the interior.
Also, the num ber p late of the Estate
cannot be clearly read unless the
lug gage compartment is closed.
Fitting accessories to the boot lid/tailgate
will increase its weight. If it becom es too
hea vy, the boot lid/tailgate w ill then not
stay open.
38
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Vauxhall alarm system
3
Monitors:
z Doors, luggage compa rtm ent, bonnet,
z Passenger compartment,
z Vehicle tilt, e.g. if it is raised,
z Ignition.
To activ ate
All doors, w indows, the sunroof 3 and the
bonnet must b e closed. Press button p on
the rem ote control.
Act ivat ion without monitoring of
pa ssenger comp artment a nd vehicle ti lt
Activate e.g. when animals are left in the
vehicle.
If the ignition wa s switched on, the driver’s
door m ust be opened and closed ag ain so
that the anti-theft alarm system can be
activated again.
1. Close boot lid/tailgate and bonnet.
2. Press b utton Ä; LED in button flashes
(maximum of 10 seconds).
3. Close doors.
4. Switch on anti-theft alarm system .
LED illuminates. After a pprox.
10 seconds, the sy stem is activated
without monitoring of the passenger
compartment or vehicle tilt. LED
fla shes until system is switched off.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
39
After the first 10 seconds of anti-theft
alarm system activation:
z LED flashes
=
slow ly
z LED illuminates =
for approx.
1 second
System switched on.
Switch-off function.
If a system fa ult occ urs, contact a
work shop for assistance.
Light emit ting d iode (LED)
During the first 10 seconds of anti-theft
alarm system activation:
z LED
illuminates
z LED flashes
quick ly
=
Test, switch-on d elay.
=
Door, luggag e
com partment or
bonnet op en, or
system fault.
To deact ivat e
Press button q on the remote control
– or –
turn on the ignition.
If there is a fault in the remote control,
unlock vehicle as describ ed on p age 33.
If the alarm is triggered w hen the driv er’s
door is opened, d eactivate the anti-theft
alarm sy stem by sw itc hing on the ignition.
40
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
3. After the luggage compartment is
closed, monitoring of the passeng er
compa rtm ent, luggage comp artm ent
and v ehicle tilt is reactivated after a
5 minute d elay and the tailga te is
locked. To override the delay, p ress
button p on the rem ote control.
Note
z C hanges to the vehicle interior, such as
the use of ex tra seat covers, could imp air
the function of passeng er comp artm ent
monitoring.
Est ate with electri cally operated
tai lgate 3 :
To open and close the lugga ge
compartment when the anti-theft
alarm system is active:
1. Briefly press button r on the remote
control – lugg age compartment is
unlocked (see page 34), and monitoring
of the passenger c om partment and
vehicle tilt is d isabled.
2. Open lug gage compartment –
see pa ge 34.
z Disable passenger compartm ent
monitoring if the vehicle interior is being
hea ted.
Alarm
An alarm can be triggered w hilst the a ntitheft alarm system is active, indicated by:
z an acoustic sig nal (horn) and
z a v isual signal (hazard w arning lights).
The number of alarms and the d uration
thereof are stipulated by law.
The alarm can be silenc ed b y pressing a
button on the remote control or by
switching on the ig nition. The anti-theft
alarm system is d eactivated at the same
tim e.
Ala rm siren wit h integrated b attery 3
The alarm siren monitors the on-board
voltage network and triggers an ala rm if
this network is manipulated (e.g . if the
vehicle’s ba ttery is disconnected by
unauthorised persons). The alarm siren ha s
its own power supply and is therefore not
dependent on the vehicle’s battery.
If the vehicle’s battery is to be
disconnected (e.g. for maintenance w ork ),
the alarm siren must be dea ctivated as
follows: sw itch the ignition on then off,
disconnect the vehicle’s battery within
15 seconds.
To swit ch off alarm siren:
S witc h ignition on then off.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
41
The p rogram med universal remote control
can replace the individual remote control
units of the sy stems to be operated . Three
buttons on the und ersid e of the mirror
housing ca n be used to operate various
systems.
C onsult y our Vauxhall Authorised Rep airer
for details on comp atible system s.
9 Warnin g
Child safety lo cks
9 Warning
Use the child safety locks whenever
children are oc cup ying the rear seats.
Disreg ard may lead to injuries or
endanger life. Vehicle passengers must
be informed accordingly.
Turn rotary knob nea r rear door lock from
the v ertical position using key;
door cannot be opened from inside.
Universal remote co ntro l in mirror
housing 3
To op erate up to 3 different remotely op erated systems (e.g . garage door,
domestic alarm sy stem, dom estic ex terior
lig hting).
Ensure that no persons, animals or
objects are in the movement zone of the
sy stem to be opera ted (e.g. a garage
door). Vehicle pa ssengers m ust be
informed of the haz ards.
Basic program ming of t he univ er sa l
remot e cont rol system
1. Switch on ignition.
2. When programming for the first time,
press both outer buttons on the m irror
housing , until the control ind ic ator
along side the b uttons fla shes rapidly
(after approx. 20 seconds).
3. Hold the ma nual remote control unit at a
distance of 0 to 30 c m from the control
button area of the mirror housing.
42
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
4. Press the button on the manual remote
control unit while pressing and holding
the desired button of the univ ersal
remote control.
Prog ramm ing the universal remot e
control system for vari able code systems
1. Perform b asic prog ra mming –
see prev ious pag e.
5. The control indica tor in the mirror
housing will flash slowly at first. As soon
as it flashes rapidly , release b oth
buttons. The universal remote control
system is now programmed for the
chosen system .
2. Activate synchronisation m ode of
system (see system manufac turer’s
opera ting manual) and briefly press the
pre-prog ra mmed button on the
universal remote control three times
within 30 sec onds.
6. To prog ra mme other buttons with other
system s, repeat steps 3 to 5.
3. The universal remote control system is
now programm ed for v ariable c od e
systems. To program me other sy stems
for variable codes, repeat steps 1 and 2
for the other buttons on the universal
rem ote control.
Button setting s ca n only be erased all at
once. It is not possible to erase ind iv idual
button setting s. Buttons can, however, be
individually reprogrammed - see
"Reprogramming indiv idua l button
settings".
Usi ng t he universal remote control system
With the ignition on, press the required
universal remote control b utton and the
control indicator in the mirror housing will
illuminate. The pre-programm ed system
can now be operated using the universal
remote control system .
In order to erase the programm ing of all
3 buttons, press both outer buttons and
release a s soon as the LED begins to flash
(after approx. 20 seconds). All button
settings have now been clea red and can
be programm ed a new at any time.
If a sy stem cannot be operated after
rep eated programming, and the control
indicator flashes ra pidly for a short time
after the relevant button has been pressed
and then illuminates for 2 seconds, the
receiver may be equipped with a variable
code sy stem - see next column.
Reprog ramm ing indiv idual button
settings
If a button that has already b een
programm ed is to b e used for a different
system, repeat steps 3 to 5 of the ba sic
programm ing procedure described
previously.
C lea ring all progra mmed but ton sett ings
Before selling the vehicle, it is a good id ea
to erase button setting s.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
43
Note
Keep replac ed m anual tra nsmitters for
possible reprogram ming. The manua l
transm itters can also continue to be used.
If, after repeated a ttempts at execution of
the a bove steps, a system cannot b e
actuated with the universal remote control,
seek the assistance of a workshop.
During programming, the vehicle should be
within the range of the receiver. Under no
circumstanc es should the vehicle be in the
movement zone of a system (e.g . garage
door).
Do not programme a system without an
automatic safety stop (m anufactured
before April 1982).
Take note of the sy stem manufacturer’s
safety instruc tions for drives and manual
rem ote control units.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting exterior mir rors 3
Ad justment using the four-way switch in
the driver’s door: If the outer mirror sw itch
(1) is p ressed, the four-way switch opera tes
the driver’s and front passenger’s
mirrors 3. If the inner mirror switch (2) is
pressed, it only operates the front
passenger’s mirror.
The glass of the mirror is adjusted in the
relev ant direction in accordance with the
op eration of the four-way switch.
Elec trica l seat adjustment with
Memory function 3:
If the inner m irror switch (2) is pressed, the
front passenger-side ex terior mirror is
pointed automatically at the rear tyres
after rev erse g ear is eng aged, in order to
assist parking (not if tow ing a carav an/
tra iler) 3.
Sw inging i n exterior mi rror
Manually: The exterior mirrors can be
folded in by gently pressing the outer edge
of the housing.
Electrically 3 (both mirror sw itches must
not be latched into position):
Push four-way switch to the right:
outside rear view mirrors swivel in.
Push four-way switch to the left:
outside rear view mirrors swivel out.
Return the mirrors to the driving position
before starting-off.
The mirrors can b e retra cted from the
outside: Press button p on the remote
control approx. 1 second . The m irrors will
be extended the next time the vehicle is
unlocked.
S wivelling only a llowed at speeds of up to
4 mph (7 km /h).
44
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Automat ic anti- dazzle ext eri or mirror 3
on the d river’s side
Dazzle from following v ehicles at night is
autom atic ally reduc ed.
The mirror does not reduc e da zzle when:
z the ig nition is sw itc hed off,
z rev erse gear is eng aged or selector lever
set to R,
z the interior lights are on,
z a d oor is open.
For the safety of pedestrians, the exterior
mirrors will swing out of their normal
mounting p osition if they are bumped with
sufficient force. Reposition the m irror by
apply ing slight pressure to the mirror
housing.
Aspherical exterior mi rror 3
The asp herical m irror g lass m akes the blind
angle smaller. The curva ture mak es objects
look smaller, making it more difficult to
estimate how far away follow ing vehicles
are.
Interio r mirror
To adjust, swivel mirror housing .
S wivel lever on underside of m irror housing
to reduce dazzle from following v ehicles at
night.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
45
Electric win dows 3
9 Warning
Take care when operating the electric
windows. Risk of injury , especially for
children. Vehic le occupants should be
inform ed according ly .
If there are children on the rear seat,
switch on the child safety sy stem 3 for
the elec tric wind ow s.
Autom atic a nti-dazzle interior mir ror 3
Dazzle from following vehicles at night is
automatically reduced .
The sensor is located at the bottom of
the housing. In the c ase of vehic les with
a p osition memory for electrically opera ted
front seats 3 or a universal remote
control 3, the sensor is located at the
top right of the m irror g la ss.
The m irror d oes not reduce dazzle when:
z the ignition is switched off,
z reverse gear is engaged or selector lever
set to R,
z the interior lights a re on,
z a door is open.
K eep a close watch on the windows when
closing them. Ensure that nothing
becomes trapped in them as they move.
The electric windows can be used:
z with ignition on,
z within 10 m inutes of switching ignition
off,
z within 10 m inutes of opening or closing
the driver’s door,
z within 10 m inutes of inserting or
rem oving the ignition key.
Readiness for operation stops when the
vehicle is lock ed.
O peration via 2 rock er buttons in the
driver’s door. Additional rocker buttons in
the front passenger’ s d oor a nd the rear
doors 3.
To operate window in stages, tap switch.
For autom atic opening or closing, keep
switch pressed for slightly longer; to stop
window m ovement, tap switch ag ain.
46
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Vehicles with rea r electric wind ow s 3 have
a slide switch b etween the buttons in the
driver’s door
z Up:
The front w indows ca n be operated
using the b uttons.
z Down:
The rear wind ows can be operated using
the buttons.
Safety function
If the window glass encounters resistance
above the middle of the window during
automatic closing , it is immediately
stop ped and the window op ened again.
If the windows do not move easily (e.g. on
account of frost), keep pressing the switc h
for the window in question until the window
has been closed in stages.
Child sa fety system for r ear window s 3
Switch z in the driver’s door
z Press (switch z illuminates in red): rear
windows cannot be operated using the
buttons in the rear d oors,
z press again (switch z no longer
illuminates in red ): rear w indows ca n be
opera ted using the buttons in the rea r
doors.
C losi ng window s from outside using the
remot e cont rol 3
The wind ow s c an be closed from outside
using the rem ote control:
Depress the p button until the wind ow s
are closed.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
Autom atic c losi ng 3
See page 33.
Su nro of 3
9 Warnin g
O verload
If the wind ow s are rep eatedly operated at
short interv als, the power supp ly is briefly
cut off.
Caution when opera ting the sunroof. Risk
of injury, particula rly to children. Vehicle
passeng ers must be informed
accordingly.
The system is protected by fuses in the
fusebox – see page 246.
Keep a close watch on the sliding roof
when closing it. Ensure that nothing
becom es trapped as it moves.
Fault
If the windows cannot be opened a nd
closed automatically , activate the w indow
electronic s as follows:
1. Close doors.
2. Switch on ignition.
3. Window com pletely open.
47
The electric sunroof can be operated
Windo ws in rear doors
Turn crank 3 towards the front or rear.
z with ignition on,
z within 10 minutes of sw itc hing ignition
off,
4. Close window and press on button for at
least 3 seconds.
z within 10 minutes of opening or closing
the driver’s door,
5. Repeat for eac h wind ow .
z within 10 minutes of inserting or
removing the ignition k ey.
Readiness for operation stops when the
vehicle is locked.
48
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
To raise
Turn the rotary switc h to any position
between d and e. The sunroof w ill
autom atic ally m ov e to the d esired position.
When the rotary switch is in position e, the
sunroof is fully raised.
To lower
Turn rotary switch to d.
Posit ion memory
After the ignition has been switched on, the
sunroof c an be autom atic ally returned to
its last position b y briefly pressing the
rotary sw itc h.
O perated using rotary switch in the
overhead control panel.
To open
Turn the rotary switch to any position
between d a nd ü. The sunroof will
automatically move to the desired position.
When the switch is in position ü , the
sunroof is fully opened .
Com fort positi on
Set rotary switch to position f. With the
roof in this position, w ind noise is reduc ed.
To close:
Turn rotary sw itc h to d.
Safety func tion
If the sunroof encounters resistance during
autom atic closing, it is im med ia tely
stopped and opened again, as long as the
vehicle is stationary.
9 Warning
If when the vehicle is being driven the
sunroof encounters resistance during
automatic closing, because of the higher
closing forces inv olv ed the protectiv e
func tion ca nnot be guaranteed, a nd
there is a risk of injury.
If the sunroof mov ement is stiff, e.g. due to
frost, turn rota ry switch to d a nd keep it
pressed until the sunroof is closed.
C losi ng sunr oof from outside
To close the sunroof from outside with the
remote control: Press button p until the
sunroof is closed.
If the electric windows 3 are to be closed
from outside the vehicle, but the sunroof is
to be left op en, briefly press the rotary
switch before sw itc hing off the ignition.
Autom atic closing 3
S ee page 33.
Keys, doors, windows, sunroof
49
Sunshade
To red uce the sunlight in the interior with
the sliding roof closed or raised.
O pen or close sunshade as req uired.
When the sunroof is opened, the sunshade
is also op ened.
O verload
If the sy stem is overloaded, the power
sup ply is automatically c ut off for a short
time.
Fault
If the sunroof no longer assumes the
desired position automatically ,
programme sunroof electronics as follow s:
1. Switch on ignition.
2. Press the rotary switch until the sunroof is
shut, then k eep it pressed for a t least a
further 3 seconds.
3. Turn rotary switch to ü and keep it
depressed until the sunroof is open.
4. Turn rotary switch to d and keep it
depressed until the sunroof is c losed .
5. Turn rotary switch to e and leave there
until the sunroof is fully raised.
6. Turn rotary switch to d and keep it
depressed until the sunroof is c losed .
Electrically operated
rear window blind 3
Su nblinds for rear door windows 3
Reduces intensity of sunlig ht shining on to
rear seats. O peration w ith ignition
switched on.
Pull the blind upw ards using the grip and
eng age it at the top in the door frame.
To ra ise
To low er
=
=
Press N
Press N again
Do not operate blind if there are objects
lying in front of the rear w indow.
To reduc e sunlight a t the rear seats.
50
Seats, interior
Seats, interior
Manually a djustable front sea ts .. ..... .
Electrically a djustable front sea ts 3 . .
Head restraints .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Armrest 3 between the front sea ts... .
Rear seat armrest .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Travel Assistant 3 ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Lug gage compartment extension .... .
Lug gage compartment cover 3... ..... .
Safety net 3, Esta te. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Lashing eyes ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Reversible carpet 3 . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
FlexO rganizer 3... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Notes on loading the vehic le .... .... ..... .
Three-stage safety sy stem.... .... .... ..... .
Three-point seat belts .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Belt tensioners. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Using the seat belts. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Child restraint systems 3 . ..... .... .... ..... .
Airbag system . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ciga rette lig hter 3 ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Accessory sockets 3 ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ashtray .... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Stowage comp artm ents... ..... .... .... ..... .
Drink holders ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Sunvisors.. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
50
52
55
57
57
58
65
66
67
69
69
69
71
72
72
73
76
77
80
93
93
94
95
97
97
Manually adjustable front seats
9 Warning
Never adjust seats during driving, as they
can m ov e uncontrollab ly .
Imp ortant: Do not sit nea rer than
10 inches (25 cm) from the steering
wheel, to perm it safe airba g deploy ment.
Adjust seat longi tudinally
To adjust seat position, pull handle a t front
of seat, move seat and then release
ha ndle.
Ad just ing the bac krest
To adjust, turn sid e handwheel on the seat
while releasing the load on the b ackrest.
Move bac krest to suit sea ting position.
Seats, interior
Adj usti ng the seat hei ght 3
To adjust height of sea t, op erate rear lever
on outb oa rd sid e of seat.
Pump action of lever
Upwards:
S eat higher
Downwards:
S eat lower
To adjust seat incl ine 3
Pump action of lever
Upwards:
Seat steeper
Dow nwa rd s:
Seat flatter
51
Ad just ing the lumb ar support 3
To adjust, activa te the lever on the
bac krest, relieving pressure on the backrest
as you d o so.
Adjust lum bar sup port to suit personal
requirements.
52
Seats, interior
Electrically adju stable front
seats 3
9 Warnin g
Care must be ta ken when operating the
electric ally adjustable seats. There is a
risk of injury , partic ularly for children, and
a danger that articles could become
tra pped .
Keep a close watch on the seats when
adjusting them .
To adj ust thigh support 3 on the sports
sea ts 3
To adjust, press button in recessed grip
located in the centre benea th the adjusting
cushion and m ove the thigh support.
Seat positi on
Ad just driver’s seat such that with the
driver sitting upright the steering wheel is
held in the area of its upper spokes with the
driver’s arm s slightly bent.
Adjust thigh support to suit personal
req uirements.
Push front passenger’ s seat as fa r back as
possible.
The seat b ackrests must not be tilted too
fa r back (recommend ed m aximum tilting
angle ap prox . 25°).
9 Warning
Failure to observe the descriptions could
lead to injuries whic h could be fata l.
Vehicle passeng ers must be informed
accordingly before starting-off.
Vehic le pa ssengers m ust be inform ed
accordingly.
Ad just ment
The seat position can be a djusted by
means of switches on the outb oa rd side of
the seats.
Adjusting the inclination
Move switch 1 upwards/downwards at
front.
Seats, interior
Height adjustment
Move switch 1 upwards/downwards at rear
Electri cally operated lumba r support 3 on
driver’s seat
Ad just lumbar support using four-way
switch on outboard side of driver’s seat.
Seat back rest adjustm ent
Turn switch 2 forwards/bac kwards.
Ad just lumbar support to suit p ersonal
requirements.
O perate switch until desired sea t position is
rea ched. Seat position – see pa ge 52.
Moving support up and down: press button
up or down.
After ad justing the seat, adjust height of
seat b elt – see p age 76.
Increasing and decreasing sup port: press
button forwards or back wards.
Adjusting the longitudinal position
Move switch 1 forwards/backwards.
Thi gh sup port 3 on driver’s seat
See pag e 52.
53
Seat position
Adjust driver’s sea t such that with the
driver sitting upright the steering wheel is
held in the area of its upper spokes with the
driver’s arms slig htly bent.
Push front passeng er’s seat as far bac k as
possible.
The seat back rests m ust not be tilted too
far ba ck (recom mended max imum tilting
angle approx. 25°).
9 Warnin g
Failure to observe the descriptions could
lead to injuries which could be fatal.
Vehic le pa ssengers m ust be inform ed
accordingly before starting-off.
54
Seats, interior
Readiness for operation
z With ignition on,
z within 10 m inutes of switching ignition
off,
z within 10 m inutes of opening or closing
the driver’s door,
z within 10 m inutes of inserting or
rem oving the ignition key.
Readiness for operation stops when the
vehicle is lock ed.
Storing settings
1. Adjust seat.
Memory function 3 for el ect ricall y
adj ust able driv er’s seat and ext eri or
mi rrors
Three different seat a nd mirror settings can
be stored (e. g. for three drivers).
2. To adjust ex terior mirror - see pages 6,
43.
3. Press m emory button M and the position
button to be used (1, 2 or 3)
simulta neously, and stora ge is
ack nowledged by an acoustic signal.
Retriev ing settings
Keep position key 1, 2 or 3 pressed until the
stored sea t and mirror positions have b een
reached .
For reasons of safety, seat adjustm ent
stops immediately if the p osition button is
relea sed or one of the setting buttons is
op erated.
Ad justments may only be performed with
vehicle stationary.
S tore and activ ate the setting s using the
remote controls 3
When the vehicle is loc ked using the remote
control the current driv er’s seat a nd
exterior mirror positions are stored see page 28.
The seat adjusting proc edure can be
stopped immediately by operating a
setting button.
Front passenger-si de exterior m irror wit h
m irror par king a ssistanc e 3
S ee page 43.
O verload
If the seat setting is electrically overloaded,
the power supply is automatically cut off
for a short time.
The sy stem is protected by fuses in the
fusebox – see page 246.
Seats, interior
Head restraints
Adj usti ng the front sea t head restraint s
and t he out board rear seat head
restraints 3
To adjust height, press button on side a nd
adjust height.
In order to inc rease the size of the luggage
compartment or if they are not being used ,
push rear head restraints d ow n as fa r as
possible - see page 65.
When the seats a re occupied, ad just the
height ac cord ing to the body size of the
occupant.
To adjust the inc line, swivel the bottom
edge of the head restraint forwards or
backwards.
55
Ad just ing the rear head restraint s
integra ted in the rear seat ba ckrest 3
To adjust head restra ints, pull forwards
with both hands and slide up or down.
To increa se the size of the luggage
compa rtm ent or improve visibility, p ush
hea d restraint down as far as possible if
seat is unoccupied.
If seat is oc cup ied, pull head restraint
upwards.
56
Seats, interior
Head restrai nt position
The midd le of the head restraint should be
at eye lev el. I f this is not possible for
extremely tall persons, set to highest
position, and set to lowest position for
small persons.
Activ e head restra ints 3
In the event of a rear-impa ct, the a ctive
head restraints tilt slightly forwards. The
head is more effectiv ely supported by the
head restraint and the da nger of whiplash
in the neck area is reduced .
9 Warning
Ac tiv e hea d restra ints are identified by the
lettering AC TIVE on the head restra int
guid e sleeves.
Disreg arding the instructions can lea d to
injuries which could be fatal. Vehicle
passengers must b e informed
according ly before setting off.
Remov ing the head restraint s
Press and release the two catches. Pull and
remove the hea d restraint.
In order to increase the size of the luggage
compa rtm ent or if they are not being used,
push rear head restraints down as far as
possible - see pag e 65.
Not e
O nly approved objects or com ponents
should be attached to the head restraint of
the unoccupied front passenger’s seat.
Seats, interior
Armrest 3 between the front seats
The armrest can be pushed forwards. If the
armrest is not req uired, push it back and
fold it up.
The armrest c ontains a stowage
compartment: to open, slide a rm rest b ack,
press button at front and lift.
57
Rear seat armrest
The armrest can be folded down.
If the rear centre seat is being used or the
rear sea t ba ckrests are b eing folded down,
fold armrest up wards.
58
Seats, interior
Travel Assistant
3
The Trav el Assistant contains
z
z
z
z
z
z
Arm rest
Stowage compartments
Waste container
Drink holders
Acc essory sockets.
Connection console
e.g. for DVD p la yer 3
z Elec tric cool box
z Foldaway tables
z Tw in Audio (rear audio module) 3 or
stowage compartm ent.
The Trav el Assistant is installed on a
console above the c entre seat in the rear.
Installing the Travel Assistant
Swivel out retaining device on seat with
strap.
Insert the two rear retainers of the
connecting console in the retaining device
on the seat and engage.
S wivel open and hold cover of front
attachment points in floor in front of
console.
Seats, interior
Swiv el connecting console downwards and
enga ge in a ttac hm ent points.
Swivel the locking lever downwards.
Check the locking p osition of the Travel
Assistant: The red mark (see Fig. 17566 J
on next pa ge) must not be visib le.
Otherwise, lock using the key – see page
63, Fig. 17575 J.
Remove cap 3 from p lug at securing
bracket.
59
To lock, insert Travel Assistant into rec esses
in connecting console and slide ba ck as far
as possible.
60
Seats, interior
If it is correctly locked , the red m ark must
no long er be visible in the window,
otherwise the p rocedure must be rep eated.
9 Warning
If it is not c orrectly locked, the Travel
Assistant could be propelled forwards
with considerab le force when hard
braking occurs, risk of injury.
Dr ink holder a nd accessory sock ets
Open the drink holder by pressing the
marking.
Only a ccessories w ith maximum power
consumption of 120 Watts m ust be
connected to the accessory sockets. For
notes – see page 93.
St owage com partm ent s
The lower stowage comp artment is opened
by pressing the ma rk . The und ersid e of the
compa rtm ent has an opening through
which objects in the compartment can be
raised.
The up per stowage compartment is
located under the armrest. To open, press
the button and fold the armrest upwa rds.
Seats, interior
Connecting consol e for DVD pl ayer 3
When not in use, pull connecting console
upwards, press button and slide
downwards.
Swivel up the display holder, slide DVD
player display into brack et from below a nd
fix in position with brack et.
Maximum loa d: 1 kg.
61
Electric c ool box
To open, fold open the armrest together
with the stowage compa rtm ent.
62
Seats, interior
Switch on the cool box as needed.
Fold away tab les
Fold arm rest upwards (1).
S et required clearance b y adjusting
longitudinal position of folda way table (4).
Use recessed grip to p ull foldawa y table
up wards as fa r as it will go (1), swivel
foldaw ay table forwards (2) a nd fold
downwards (3).
S wivel a rm rest down.
Seats, interior
To fold away the tab le, swivel the armrest
up.
Push the table forwards as far as it w ill
go (1).
Fold the table upwards p ast the resistance
point (2), swiv el it downwards and insert in
the Travel Assista nt (3).
Swivel armrest down.
63
Disma nt ling the Trav el Assista nt
O pen catch using key , red mark appears in
window.
64
Seats, interior
Pull the Tra vel Assistant to the front on the
connecting console and remove.
Fit cap 3 to plug on securing bracket.
Press the locking lev er down, press the
button on the front of the connecting
console a nd sw iv el the locking lev er
up wards.
S wivel the connecting console upwards
and pull it from the retaining devic e on the
seat.
S wivel the retaining device back on the
seat.
Seats, interior
Luggage co mpartment extension
Fold dow n the cover behind the arm rest
Fold down the a rm rest on to the seat
cushion, pull the handle and tilt the cover
forwards.
The outer seats can continue to be used for
passengers.
9 Warning
The load must not obstruct operation of
the pedals, handbrake and gearshift, or
the freedom of movement of the driver.
Do not leave unsecured objects in the
interior. Note instruc tion on pag e 71.
Enga ge the cover behind the centre
armrest a udib ly in position.
65
Cover behind arm rest can be locked from
lugg age com partment 3: turn hand le 90°:
Folding d own the rear seat ba ckrests
Push the rear head restraints right down.
Locked
Unlock ed
Place the b elt buckles in storage pockets in
the seat cushions.
=
=
Ha ndle horizontal
Ha ndle vertical
S lid e front seat forwards slightly.
Remove Travel Assistant 3 - see page 60.
Unlock one or both rear sea t backrests by
depressing p ushbuttons and fold down on
to seat cushion.
Return front seat to desired position.
66
Seats, interior
Restoring ba ckrest to an up right posit ion
Audibly engage the rear seat ba ckrests.
There is a locking indicator on the release
lev er. If the rear seat ba ckrests ha ve b een
correctly locked the red indicator on the
release levers must not be visib le.
Fold ing down t he front passenger’s
seat 3
Push head restra int on front passenger’s
seat down as far as it will g o.
Luggage com partment cover 3
Slide front passenger’ s seat backw ards.
Pull cover from the side guides.
Fold front passenger’s seat forwards by
ra ising release lever.
Fitting
Eng age cover in side guides and fold down.
Attach reta ining straps to tailgate.
To restore, raise the release lever, restore
the front seat back rest to an upright
position and audibly engage.
Notes on loading
See pag e 71.
5-door Ha tch
Removing
Detach retaining stra ps from tailgate.
Seats, interior
Est ate
To close
Pull lug gage compartment cover toward s
rea r of vehicle using handle and hook into
side retainers.
Do not place any heavy or sharp-edged
objects on the cover.
To open
Remove luggag e compartment c ov er from
side b ra ckets. I t rolls up automatically .
Removing
Open luggage compartment cover.
Raise the release lever on the right of the
lugg age compartment c ov er. Remove
cover from the brackets by lifting first on
the right, then on the left.
Fitting
Fit the lug gage compartment cover in the
bracket on the left-hand side, fold up the
relea se lever on the right-ha nd side, fit the
lugg age compartment cover in the bracket
on the right-hand side, engage and press
the release lever closed.
67
Safety n et 3, Estate
The safety net can be fitted behind the rear
seats or, with the rear seat ba ckrests fold ed
down, behind the front seats.
Passengers must not be carried b ehind the
safety net.
Fitti ng behind the rear seats
Remove the luggage com partment cover see left c olumn.
Fit the ca ssette with rolled safety net into
the side brack ets and enga ge b y twisting .
68
Seats, interior
Ex tend the net from the cassette. The roof
frame houses two installation op enings. Fit
the net rod in the installation op ening on
one side and then the other and engage by
pushing forwards.
Fit the luggage compa rtm ent cover.
Removing
Remove the lug gage compartment cover.
Pull ea ch side hook from the cassette and
attach it to an eye 3 in the vehicle floor.
Detach the safety net rod from the
brackets in the roof frame.
Slide both latches inwards; push the
cassette with rolled net back wards in the
bracket, twist and rem ov e upw ards.
Extend the net from the cassette. The roof
frame houses tw o insta lla tion openings. Fit
the net rod in the installation opening on
one sid e and then the other and engag e by
pushing forwards.
Fit ting behind front seat s
Fold b oth rear seat b ackrests. Place the
rolled net on the floor behind the front
seats in such a wa y that the c og rail in the
slit on the net is to the rear.
Undo the side hooks from the eyes 3 in the
vehicle floor.
Removing
Detach the safety net rod from the
brack ets in the roof frame.
Seats, interior
Lashing eyes
In the luggage compartment, secure items
being transported against slipping b y
attaching lashing straps 3 or a luggage
net 3.
Reversible carpet 3
Fold ing floor covering with two different
surfaces. When transporting objec ts in the
luggage compartment, fold reversible
carpet with appropriate surface on top.
69
FlexOrganizer
The illustrations show some possible uses.
The components are housed in a stow age
compartment at the rear in the load floor see p age 96.
Varia ble part ition wa ll
S ee Fig. 17596 J . Press the rods of the
partition w all together slightly and engage
in the desired guid e rail opening s in the
side walls. The rods can be eng aged in
va rious positions.
3
Flexible sy stem for dividing the luggage
compartment or securing load s in an
Estate.
The system c onsists of:
z Variable partition net,
z Variable partition wa ll,
z Partition rod,
z Mesh pock ets for the side walls,
z Hooks.
The components can be mounted in the
two guide ra ils in the side walls of the
lugg age compartment.
Varia ble part ition net
S ee Fig. 17597 J. Push rods of partition net
together a little and insert into relev ant
openings in side wall guide rails. The rods
can b e engaged in various positions. The
partition net ca n be installed horizontally
or vertically at different heights.
70
Seats, interior
Hooks and m esh pockets for the side walls
See Fig. 17598 J . Enga ge the hook s in the
openings of the guide rails in the sid e walls
as indicated in the illustration and turn 90° .
The m esh pockets ca n be hung from the
hooks.
Rem oving
Press together the rods of the partition
wall/net or the telescopic rods and rem ov e
from the guide rails. Turn the hook s 90°
and rem ov e.
FlexOrga nizer stowa ge
The Flex Organizer components are housed
in a stowa ge c om partment a t the rear in
the load floor. To open, raise the ha nd le
and open the flap – see p age 96,
Fig. 17611 J .
To stow a way, pull partition rods, pa rtition
net rods a nd sepa ra te telescopic rod apart
in the middle and fold the tw o ha lv es
together - see Fig. 17599 J . Roll up partition
and p artition net and place in
compa rtm ent with other com ponents.
C lose lid.
Seats, interior
z Objects m ust not be stored in the a irb ag
inflation area, because they could cause
injury if the airbag inflates.
Notes on loading the vehicle
z Heav y objec ts in the lug gage
com partment should be placed against
the engaged rea r seat backrests or, if the
rear seat backrests are folded down,
against the front sea t backrests. If
ob jects are to be stacked, the heav ier
ob jects should be placed at the bottom.
Unsec ured objec ts in the lug gage
com partment would be thrown forwards
with great force in the event of heavy
braking, for example.
z Secure objects with lashing straps 3
atta ched to lashing ey es – see p age 69.
If heavy loads slip when the vehicle is
braked heavily or driven around a bend,
the hand ling of the v ehicle ma y change.
z Saloon / H atch: loose objects in the
lugga ge c om partment should be
secured ag ainst slipping using a
lugga ge net 3 – see page 69.
z Estate: mount the sa fety net 3 when
transporting objects in the luggag e
com partment - see page 67.
z Estate: Close luggage compartm ent
cov er - see p age 67.
z When transporting objects in the
lugga ge c om partment the rear seats
must be eng aged - see page 65.
71
z The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrak e or the
gears or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
z Do not drive with lugga ge compa rtm ent
open when tra nsporting bulky objects,
for exam ple, since toxic exhaust fumes
could penetra te the interior.
z Do not a llow the load to protrude ab ov e
the upp er edge of the rear seat
back rests, or above the upper ed ge of
the front seat b ackrests if the rear seat
back rests a re folded down.
z Weights, payload and roof loa d see page 293.
z The warning triangle 3 and first-aid kit 3
must alway s b e freely a ccessib le.
z Driv ing with a roof load see pages 184, 187, 218. A roof load
increases the sensitivity of the vehicle
to crosswinds and has a detrim ental
effect on v ehicle ha nd ling ow ing to the
vehicle’s hig her centre of gravity.
z Do not place any objects in front of the
rea r window or on the instrument pa nel.
They are reflected in the glass, obstruct
the driver’s view and will be thrown
through the vehicle, for insta nce in the
event of heavy b ra king.
Failure to observe these descrip tions can
lead to injuries which ma y be fatal.
Vehic le pa ssengers m ust be inform ed
accordingly.
9 Warnin g
72
Seats, interior
Three-stage safety system
Com prising:
z Three-point seat belts.
z Belt tensioners at the front seats.
z Airbag sy stems for driver, front
passenger and outboard rear seat
occ upa nts 3 .
The three stages are activated in sequence
depending on the sev erity of the accident:
z The automatic seat belt locking d evices
prevent the belt strap from b eing pulled
out and thus ensure that the vehicle
occ upa nts are retained in their seats.
z The front seat belts are pulled down at
the belt buckles. This mea ns the b elts fit
snugly, the occupants are d ecelerated
early with the vehic le and the body
load ing is reduced .
z The airbag systems are also triggered in
the event of serious a ccidents and form a
safety cushion for the occupa nts.
Depend ing on the severity of the
accident, the front airbags inflate in two
stages.
9 Warning
The airb ag systems serve to supplement
the three-point seat b elts and belt
tensioners. The seat b elts must therefore
alway s be w orn. Disreg ard of these
instructions m ay lead to injuries or
end ang er life. Vehicle p assengers must
be inform ed a ccord ingly .
Please read the instructions provided with
the child restraint system.
Three-point seat belts
The vehicle is equipped with three-point
seat belts with automatic retrac tors and
locking d evices, allowing full freedom of
body movement a lthough the spring
tensioned seat belts alway s ensure a snug
fit.
For information on correct seating
position – see pages 52, 77, 82.
The seat belts lock during heavy
acc eleration or deceleration.
Seats, interior
9 Warning
Alwa ys wea r your seat belt, and that
means a lso in urban traffic a nd when you
are a rear sea t passeng er. I t can save
your life.
Also, pregnant women must alwa ys wear
a seat belt – see pa ge 76.
In the event of an accident, persons not
wearing seat belts endanger their fellow
occupants and themselv es.
Control indicator X for the seat belt –
see page 101.
Seat b elts are only intended for one person.
They are not suitable for any one under
12 yea rs of age or under 150 cm tall.
For children up to 12 yea rs of ag e, w e
recom mend the Vaux hall child restraint
system – see page 77.
73
Belt force limi ter s
on the front seat belts reduce stresses on
the body by releasing the seat belt gently
during an impact. This allows the body to
move slightly in a nticipation of the impact.
Testing the seat b el ts
Check all parts of the b elt sy stem from time
to time for damage a nd to ensure function.
Replace dam aged parts. Following an
accident, have the seat belts and actuated
belt tensioners repla ced by a work shop.
Do not m ake alterations to the seat b elts,
their anchora ges, their automa tic
retractors and the belt buckles.
Do not d amage the seat belt with sharp
ob jects, and d o not g et it trapp ed.
Belt tensioners
The front seat belt systems are fitted with
belt tensioners. The seat belts are pulled
down and tensioned at the belt b uck les in
the event of frontal and rear collisions,
depending on the severity of the accident.
This tensions the sea t belts.
74
Seats, interior
Actua tion of belt t ensioners
Actuation of belt tensioners is indicated by
continuous illumination of control
indicator v - see nex t colum n.
9 Warnin g
Have the c ause of the fault elim inated
immediately by a workshop.
If the belt tensioners are triggered, they
must be replaced by a workshop.
The sy stem’s integrated self-diagnostics
allows faults to b e q uick ly rem edied.
Imp ortant information - see page 73.
If c ontrol indicator v in the instrument
cluster fails, for reasons of safety , the text
AI rbAG app ears on the odometer display.
Pressing the reset button will cause the text
to disappear. It then reapp ears on the
odometer display 10 sec onds later.
Control i nd icator v for bel t tensioners
The opera tion of the belt tensioners is
electronically monitored together with
the airbag sy stems and indicated on
the instrument cluster by the control
indica tor v. When the ignition is switched
on, the control ind icator illuminates for
approx. 4 seconds. If it does not illuminate,
does not go off after 4 seconds or
illuminates whilst driving, there is a fa ult in
the belt tensioner sy stem or the airbag
sy stems - see page 86. The belt tensioner
or the airbag sy stems may not a ctiv ate if
an accident oc curs.
Deploym ent of the belt tensioners is
indica ted b y continuous illum ination of v.
Seats, interior
Im portant
z Do not fit ac cessories not spec ifically
released for your vehicle type or store
ob jects in the belt tensioner operating
area (in the area of the belt b uc kles) d ue
to the risk of injury in the event the belt
tensioners are triggered.
z Do not m ake any modifications to the
com ponents of the belt tensioners, a s
this will render the vehicle unroadworthy .
9 Warning
Inc orrect handling (e.g. removal or fitting
of seat belts or belt buckles) can trigg er
the belt tensioners with risk of injury .
z The belt tensioner and airbag system
control electronics can be found in the
centre console area . In order to avoid
malfunctions, d o not store magnetic
objec ts in this area.
z When using the rea r seats, mak e sure
that the components of the front seat
belts are not damaged by shoes or other
objec ts. Do not a llow dirt to enter the
automatic sea t belt retractor.
75
z We recom mend that you have the front
seats removed by a w orkshop in the
event of actuation of the belt tensioners.
z The belt tensioners trigger once only,
ind ic ated b y the lighting of the control
ind ic ator v. Have a work shop replace
trig gered belt tensioners.
z When disposing of the vehicle, the sa fety
instructions given for this must be
observed . Ta ke the vehicle to a recycling
company for disposal.
76
Seats, interior
Using the seat belts
Fitting seat bel ts
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor and
place it across the body, mak ing sure it is
not twisted.
Insert the la tch plate into the buckle. The
front sea t b ackrest must not be tilted back
too far or the seat belt will not op erate
properly . The recommended angle of
inclina tion is 25° . Mak e sure that the lap
belt is not twisted and that it fits snugly
across the body. Tension the belt
frequently whilst d riv ing by tugging the
diagonal pa rt of the belt.
9 Warning
O n pregna nt women in particular, the lap
belt must be positioned a s low as
possible across the pelvis so as not to put
too much pressure on the abdomen.
Bulk y clothing will impede the snug fit of
the seat b elt. The seat belt must not be
placed over hard or break able ob jects in
the pockets of your clothing (e.g. p ens,
key s, spectacles) as this may cause injury .
Do not p lace any objects, such as
ha ndb ags or mobile telephones, between
the seat b elt and y our body.
Height adjustm ent
Height adjustm ent of upper anc horage
point for front seat belts:
1. Pull out the seat belt slightly.
2. Front seat belts: Push the button down or
push the belt g uide up.
Rear sea t belts: Press the belt guide and
push up or d ow n.
3. Set desired height.
4. Allow belt g uide to audibly engage.
Do not adjust height whilst driving.
Seats, interior
77
Child restrain t systems 3
When using a child restraint sy stem, follow
the instructions for installation and use.
The country in w hich y ou are trav elling
ma y not perm it the use of child restraint
systems on certain seats. Always comply
with the loc al or national regulations.
Adjust height such that the seat belt passes
over the wearer’s shoulder and rests
against the shoulder. It must not pass over
the neck or upper arm.
Rem oving t he b el t
To remove the seat belt , press the red
button on the catch; the seat belt retracts
by itself.
Selecti ng the right syst em
Y our child should travel facing backw ards
in the vehicle for as long as p ossible. A child
has a very weak cervical spinal colum n and
in the event of an accident is less likely to
suffer injury in a rea r-facing, semi-lying
position than if sea ted upright.
9 Warnin g
Never ca rry child restraint systems on
your lap, risk of fatal injury.
78
Seats, interior
Permissible opti ons for fi tting a child restrai nt1)
Weight and
age cl ass2 )
O n front p assenger’s
seat
O n outboard rear
seats
O n centre rea r sea t
Group 0:
up to 10 kg
or approx.
10 months
B 1, +
U, +
U
Group 0+:
up to 13 kg
or approx.
2 years
Group I :
9 to 18 k g
or approx.
8 months to
4 years
Group I I:
15 t o 25 kg
or approx.
3 to 7 years
2)
If the child restraint sy stem is being
secured using a three-point seat
belt, m ove seat height adjustment 3
to upperm ost position. Move front
passenger’s sea t as far back as
possible and move front passenger’s
seat b elt anchorage point to lowest
position.
B 2 = Limited, only with seat occupancy
recognition and Vauxhall child
restraint sy stem with transponders.
B 2, +
U, +
U
X
U
U
Group I II:
22 t o 36 kg
or approx.
6 to 12 y ears
1)
B 1 = Limited, only with seat occupancy
recognition and Vauxhall child
restraint sy stem with transponders.
For reas ons o f sa fety, w e recom mend tha t the child restraint be installed o n
one of th e o utboa rd rea r seats.
We reco mmen d the use of each system u ntil the child reaches the up per weight lim it.
If the child restraint sy stem is being
secured using a three-point seat
belt, m ove seat height adjustment 3
to upperm ost position. Move front
passenger’s sea t as far back as
possible so that vehicle sa fety b elt
runs from anchorage point towards
the front.
Seats, interior
U = Can b e used universally in
combination with a three-point
seat belt.
+
= Vehicle sea t available with IS OFIX
fixings. When using IS OFIX, only
ISO FI X child restra int system s
approved for the v ehicle may b e
used.
X = No child restraint system permitted
in this weight class.
Note
z C hildren under 12 y ears or under 150 cm
tall should only travel in an appropriate
child restraint.
z When transporting children, use the child
restraint systems suitable for the child’s
weight.
z Ensure tha t the child restraint system has
been correctly fitted - see instruc tions
provided with child restraint system.
z The covers of the Vauxhall child restraint
system can be wiped clean.
z Do not stic k anything on the child
restraint sy stems a nd do not cover them
with any other materia ls.
z O nly allow the c hild to enter and exit on
the side of the vehicle facing aw ay from
the road .
z A child restraint system whic h has been
sub jected to stress in an a ccident must
be rep la ced.
z Secure or remove child restra int systems
carried in the v ehicle when not in use.
79
Mounti ng brack ets 3 for IS OFIX child
restraint systems
The brackets located between the backrest
and seat cushion are used for mounting
IS OFIX child restraint sy stems.
Plea se follow the instructions
acc om panying the I SO FIX child restraint
system.
O nly ISO FIX child restraint sy stems
app rov ed for the vehicle may be used.
80
Seats, interior
Airbag system
The a irb ag system c onsists of several
separate systems.
Front airb ag system
The front airbag system will be triggered in
the event of a serious ac cident involving a
frontal impact and forms safety cushions
for the driver and front passenger. The
forward movement of the driver and front
passenger is checked and the risk of
injuries to the upper body a nd head are
thereby substantially reduced.
Side airb ag system 3
The sid e airbag is triggered in the event of
a side-on c ollision to form a safety cushion
for the driver or front passenger in the
respective door area. This substantially
reduces the risk of injury to the upp er body
and pelv is.
C ur tain ai rbag syst em 3
The curtain a irba g system triggers in the
event of a side-on collision and provides a
safety barrier in the head area on the
respective side of the v ehicle. This red uces
the risk of injury to the head considera bly in
the event of a side-on collision.
Seats, interior
81
Exception:
Front p assenger’s seat with seat
occupancy recognition system 3. The seat
occupancy recognition sy stem dea ctivates
the front and side airbags 3 on the front
passenger’ s side if the front passenger’s
seat is unoccupied or a Vauxhall child
restraint system w ith transponders 3 has
been fitted to the front passenger’s seat.
S eat occupancy recognition - see pag e 87.
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 - see page 78.
Airbag system
z seat occ upa ncy rec og nition 3,
Front airb ag
The front airbag system is identified by the
word AI RBAG on the steering wheel and
above the glov e c om partment.
z the control indicator for Va ux ha ll child
restraint systems y with tra nsponders 3
in the od om eter displa y.
The front airbag system comprises:
z an airbag with inflator in the steering
wheel a nd a second one behind the trim
panel ab ov e the glove compartment,
z control electronics w ith im pact sensors,
z control indicator for airbag systems v in
instrum ent cluster,
The front airb ag system will be trigg ered :
z depending on the severity of the
accident,
z depending on the type of impact,
z within the range shown in the illustration,
z indep endent of side airbag a nd curta in
airbag sy stem 3.
Examples of events triggering the front
airbag sy stem:
z Impact against a non-y ielding obstacle:
the front airbags are trigg ered at low
vehicle speed.
z Impact against a yield ing obstacle:
(such as another vehicle): the front
airbags are only triggered at a hig her
vehicle speed.
82
Seats, interior
When trigg ered , the front airbags inflate in
milliseconds to form a safety cushion for
the d riv er and front passenger. The
forward movement of the front seat
occupants is c hecked, thereby
sub stantially reducing the risk of injury to
the upp er body and hea d.
No im pairment of view will occur, because
the a irb ags inflate and deflate so quickly .
9 Warning
The front airbag sy stem provides
optimum p rotection when the seat,
back rest a nd head restraint are correctly
adjusted: Adjust the driver’s seat
according to the occupant’s height suc h
that with the driver sitting upright the
steering wheel is held in the a rea of its
upper sp ok es with the d riv er’s arms
slightly bent. The front passeng er’s seat
should b e as far b ack as possible, w ith
the backrest upright – see p ages 3, 52.
Do not place the head, b od y, hands or
feet on the c ov ers of the airbag sy stems.
Do not place any objects in the area in
which the airb ags inflate. Im portant
inform ation - see page 89.
9 Warnin g
The three-point seat belt must b e
correctly fitted – see pag e 76.
The front airbag sy stem will not be
triggered in the ev ent of:
z the ignition being switched off,
z minor frontal collisions,
z accidents in which the vehicle overturns,
z collisions involving a side or rear-imp act,
tha t is to say, if it w ould not b e of b enefit
to the occupants.
Seats, interior
83
9 Warning
Seat belts m ust therefore a lways be worn.
The front a irb ag system serv es to
supplement the three-point seat belts. If
you do not wea r your seat belt you risk
being seriously injured, or even thrown
from the vehic le, in the ev ent of an
accident.
In the event of an a ccident the seat belt
helps to keep y ou in the correct seating
position, so tha t the front airbag system
can provid e you with effective p rotection.
In add ition, the front a irb ag system w ill
not be trig gered for the front passenger’s
seat in model v ariants with seat occupancy
recognition 3 if:
z the front passenger’ s seat is unoccupied,
z there is a prop erly fitted Va ux ha ll child
restraint system with transponders 3 .
Seat oc cup ancy recognition – see
page 87. Vauxhall child restraint system
with transponders 3 – see page 77.
Side airb ag 3
The side a irb ag system is identified by the
word AIRBAG on the outb oa rd sides of the
front seat backrests.
The side airbag sy stem will be triggered:
z depending on the sev erity of the
accident,
The side a irb ag system c om prises:
z an airbag with infla tor in the back of the
driver’s and front passenger’s seat
respectively ,
z within the range shown in the illustration
on the centre d oor pillar of the driver’s or
front passenger’ s side,
z the control electronics,
z the side-impact sensors,
z control indicator for airb ag sy stems v in
instrument cluster,
z seat occ upa ncy rec og nition 3,
z the control indicator for Va ux ha ll child
restraint systems y with transponders 3
in the od om eter displa y.
z depending on the ty pe of im pact,
z ind epend ently of the front airbag
sy stem.
Exception:
Front p assenger’s seat with seat
occupancy recognition system 3. The seat
occupancy recognition sy stem dea ctivates
the front and side airbags 3 on the front
passenger’ s side if the front passenger’s
seat is unoccupied or a Vauxhall child
restraint system w ith transponders 3 has
been fitted to the front passenger’s seat.
S eat occupancy recognition - see pag e 87.
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 - see pag e 78.
84
Seats, interior
9 Warning
There must be no objects in the area in
which the airb ag inflates or in the a rea
between the ba ckrests and the v ehicle
body . Do not place the hand s or arms on
the covers of the airba g systems.
Imp ortant information – see page 89.
The three-point sea t b elt must a lw ays be
correctly fitted – see page 76.
When triggered, the side a irba g infla tes
within milliseconds to form a safety cushion
for the driver or front passeng er in the
respective door area. This substantially
red uces the risk of injury to the upper body
and pelvis in the event of a side-on
collision.
The side airba gs will not be triggered in the
event of:
z the ig nition being sw itched off,
z fronta l collisions,
z accidents in which the v ehicle overturns,
z collisions involving a rear-impact,
z collisions involving a side-impact outside
the passenger cell.
In ad dition, the sid e airbag sy stem will not
be triggered for the front pa ssenger’s seat
in model variants with seat occupancy
recognition 3 if:
z the front pa ssenger’s seat is unoccupied,
z there is a properly fitted Vauxhall child
restra int system with transponders 3.
S eat occup ancy recognition – see page 87.
Vauxhall child restraint system
with transponders 3 – see page 77.
Seats, interior
Curt ain airb ag 3
The c urtain airbag sy stem is identified by
the w ord AIRBAG on the roof pillar trim.
The curtain airbag system will be triggered:
z depending on the severity of the
accident,
The c urtain airbag sy stem comp rises:
z an airbag with inflator in the roof frame
on the driver’s and front p assenger’s sid e
respectively,
z depending on the type of impact,
z the control elec tronics,
z together with the side airbag system,
z the side-impa ct sensors,
z the control indica tor for airba g
system s v in the instrument.
z within the ra ng e shown in the illustration
on the c entre door p illar of the d riv er’s or
front passenger’s sid e,
z irrespectiv e of sea t occupancy
rec og nition,
z indep endently of the front airbag
system.
85
When the curtain a irb ag is triggered it
inflates within milliseconds and provides a
safety barrier in the head area on the
respective side of the v ehicle. This red uces
the risk of injury to the head considera bly in
the event of a side-imp act.
86
Seats, interior
9 Warning
9 Warnin g
There m ust be no objects in the area in
which the airbag inflates. Do not place
the hands or arms on the covers of the
airb ag systems. I mportant information –
see pa ge 89.
Have the c ause of the fault elim inated
immediately by a workshop.
The sy stem’s integrated self-diagnostics
allows faults to b e q uick ly rem edied.
The three-point seat belt m ust always be
correctly fitted – see page 76.
If c ontrol indicator v in the instrument
cluster fails, for reasons of safety , the text
AI rbAG app ears on the odometer display.
The curtain airbags will not be triggered in
the event of:
z the ignition b eing switched off,
z frontal collisions,
z accidents in whic h the vehicle overturns,
z collisions involving a rear-impa ct,
z collisions inv olv ing a side-impa ct outside
the passenger c ell.
Control i nd icator v for airbag systems
The opera tion of the airbag systems is
electronically monitored together with the
seat occupancy recognition system s 3
and the belt tensioners and indicated on
the instrument cluster by the control
indica tor v. When the ignition is switched
on, the control ind icator illuminates for
approx. 4 seconds. If it does not illuminate,
does not go off after 4 seconds or
illuminates whilst driving, there is a fa ult in
the airbag sy stems, the sea t occupancy
recognition system 3 or the b elt tensioners
- see page 74. The systems may not
activate if an accident occurs.
Deploym ent of the airba gs is indicated by
continuous illumination of v.
The text is ac knowledged by pressing the
reset button. It then disappears from the
odometer display 10 sec onds later.
Seats, interior
Seat oc cupancy recognition 3
The seat occupancy recognition system
deactivates the front and side airbags for
the front passenger’s sea t if the front
passenger’s sea t is not occupied or a
Vauxhall child restraint sy stem with
transponders 3 is fitted on the front
passenger’s sea t. The curtain airbag
system 3 rem ains activ ated.
The c ontrol indicator for seat occupancy
recognition y is located in the odometer
display. If control indicator y illuminates
for approx. 4 seconds when the ignition is
switched on, the vehicle is eq uipp ed w ith
seat occupancy recognition; see nex t
page, Fig. S 14742.
If a Vauxhall c hild restra int system with
transponders 3 is fitted, the control
indicator y illuminates continuously after
the ig nition is switched on as soon as the
system has detected the child restraint
system. Only then may the child restraint
system with transpond ers 3 be used on the
passenger’s sea t.
87
9 Warnin g
Only Vaux hall child restraint systems with
tra nsponders 3 can be fitted on the front
passeng er’s seat. Use of sy stems w ithout
tra nsponders poses a risk of fatal injury.
Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can b e identified by a
sticker.
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
can also b e identified by the stick er on the
side of the instrum ent panel - see
illustration a bove.
Vauxhall c hild restraint system s w ith
tra nsponders 3 are automatically
detected if correctly fitted to the front
passenger’s seat. When these child
restra int system s a re being used on the
front passenger’ s seat, the front and side
airbag systems for the front passenger’s
seat are dea ctiv ated. The curtain airbag
sy stem remains ac tiv ated. Pay attention to
control indicator seat y for occ upa nc y
recognition 3 - see page 88.
88
Seats, interior
Cont rol indica tor y for Vauxhall chi ld
restraint syst em s with t ransponders 3
The p resence of a Vaux hall child restraint
system w ith transponders 3 is indicated
after the ignition has been switched on by
continuous illumination of the c ontrol
indicator y in the od om eter disp la y, as
soon a s the seat occupancy recognition
system has detected the child restraint
system.
If the control indicator flashes when the
child restraint system with transponders 3
is c orrectly fitted, there is a fault with risk of
injury to the c hild. Fit the child restraint
system on the rear seat. Have the cause of
the fa ult eliminated by a workshop.
If no Vauxhall child restraint system w ith
transponders 3 is fitted, the control
indicator must not illum inate or flash, as
the front passenger’ s a irb ag systems
would not deploy. H ave the cause of the
fault elim inated by a workshop.
9 Warnin g
If control indicator y does not illum inate
whilst driving, the front and sid e airba gs
for the front p assenger’s seat are not
deactiv ated a nd there is a risk of fa ta l
injury to the child. Fit the child restraint
sy stems on the rear seat. Have the cause of
the fault eliminated by a workshop.
If the child restraint system is not correc tly
fitted or the transponders are defective,
the control indic ator flashes. C heck that
child restraint sy stem is correc tly fitted. For
fitting child restraint system with
tra nsponders 3 - see instructions provided
with child restraint system .
If the Vauxhall child restraint system with
tra nsponders 3 ha s b een fitted
according to the instructions, control
ind ic ator y for Vauxhall c hild restra int
sy stems with transponders must
illuminate in the odom eter display when
the ignition is switched on.
If the control indica tor does not illuminate
whilst driving, the front passeng er’s
airbag systems are not deactivated and
there is a risk of fatal injury. In this ca se fit
child restraint sy stems on the rea r seat.
Have the ca use of the fault eliminated by
a workshop .
Seats, interior
Im portant
z Do not fit accessories or place objects in
the ex pansion zone of the airbag
system s - risk of injury if a irb ags are
deployed.
z The airb ag systems and b elt tensioner
control electronics can be found in the
centre console area . In order to avoid
malfunctions, d o not store magnetic
objec ts in this area.
z Do not p la ce a ny objects between the
airb ag systems and the vehicle
occ upa nts; risk of injury .
z Do not stic k anything on the steering
wheel, instrum ent panel, front seat
back rests or roof frame in the v icinity of
the airb ags, or on the front passenger’s
seat cushion, or cover any of those areas
with other m aterials.
9 Warning
Nev er carry child restraint sy stems or
other objects on your lap - risk of fatal
injury.
z Use the hooks in the roof frame only to
hang up light articles of clothing or c oa t
hangers. Do not place any objects in the
pockets of the hanging items – risk of
injury.
z Use only a dry cloth or I nterior/
Upholstery C leaner to clean the steering
wheel, instrum ent panel, front seat
back rests, roof frame and seat cushion
of the front passenger’s seat. Do not use
any aggressiv e c leaning agents.
z O nly protective covers whic h are
approved for y our v ehicle with side
airbag 3 ma y be fitted on the front
seats. When fitting the protective covers,
mak e sure that the airbag units on the
outboard sides of the front seat
back rests a re not covered.
89
z The airbag sy stems are triggered
ind epend ently of each other based on
the severity of the ac cident and the type
of impa ct. The side airbag sy stem 3 and
the curtain airbag system 3 a re
trig gered together. See seat occupancy
recognition on page 87 for excep tions.
z Each a irb ag deploys once only. Have a
workshop replace dep loy ed airbags
immediately .
z The speeds, directions of movement and
deformation properties of the vehic les,
and the p roperties of the obstacle
conc erned, determ ine the severity of the
accident and triggering of the airbags.
The degree of dama ge to y our vehicle
and the resulting repair costs alone are
not indica tiv e that the criteria for
trig gering of the airb ags were met.
90
Seats, interior
z Do not p erform any a lterations on the
com ponents of the airbag sy stem, as this
would render the vehic le unroadworthy .
9 Warning
The systems can be triggered ab ruptly
and cause injury if they are handled
im properly.
z We recom mend hav ing the steering
wheel, the instrument p anel, all panelling
parts, the door seals, the hand les and
the seats rem ov ed by a workshop.
z When disposing of the vehicle, the safety
instruc tions given for this must be
ob served. Tak e the vehicle to a recycling
com pany for disposa l.
z Persons weighing less than 35 kg should
only tra vel on the rear seats. This does
not ap ply to children who are trav elling
in c hild restra int system s w ith
transponders 3.
z In v ehicles with seat occ upa ncy
rec og nition 3, do not place any heavy
objec ts on the front passenger’ s seat
otherwise the airbag system s for the
front p assenger’s seat may b e triggered
in the event of an accident.
z In v ehicles with seat occ upa ncy
rec og nition 3, to prev ent malfunctions
do not use protective c ov ers or extra seat
cushions on the front passeng er’s seat.
z In order to prev ent malfunctions when
using a Vaux hall child restraint sy stem
with transp onders 3 on the front
passenger’ s seat, no objects (e.g. plastic
sheet, stick ers or heated mats) may be
placed under the child restraint system.
9 Warning
C hild restraint system s a s well as other
objec ts m ust nev er be carried on the lap
of passengers; risk of fatal injury. I f
carried in this way, child restraint sy stems
with transponders 3 in v ehicles with seat
occupancy recognition 3 could lead to
front passenger’s airbag system s not
being triggered in the event of an
accident.
Use of child restra int systems 3 on t he
front p assenger’s seat in v ehic les w ith
ai rbag syst em s, but wi thout sea t
occup ancy recog nition 3
Seats, interior
91
9 Warning
Vehicles with front passenger’ s airbag
and no side airbag 3:
Child restraints facing the rear of the
vehicle must not be fitted to the front
passenger’s seat; risk of fatal injury.
Child restraints facing the front
(child restraints for weight ranges I, II and
III – see page 77) are permitted on the
front p assenger’s seat, providing that it is
pushed back as far as possible and the
backrest has been adjusted so that the
la p belt fits snug ly .
Vehicles with front passeng er’s airbag can
be recognised by the word AI RBAG above
the glove compartment and the warning
sticker on the sunvisor on the front
passenger’s sid e - see Fig. 17424 T on
previous pag e. In some m odel variants, the
warning sticker may be on the side of the
instrument panel - see Fig . 17118 T.
9 Warnin g
Vehic les with sid e airbag 3: No child
restra int system 3 m ay be fitted on the
front passenger’s seat; risk of fatal injury .
A v ehicle with side airbags can b e
identified by the word A IRBAG on the
outboard sides of the front seat b ackrests.
S eat occupancy recognition 3 –
see page 87.
92
Seats, interior
Use of child restrai nt systems 3 on front
passenger’s seat in vehicles wit h airbag
systems 3 and wit h seat occupancy
recogniti on 3
9 Warning
Only Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can b e fitted on the front
passenger’s seat. Use of sy stems without
transponders poses a risk of fatal injury.
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
can be identified by control ind icator y in
the odometer display. If the control
indica tor illuminates for a pprox. 4 second s
when the ignition is switc hed on, the vehicle
is equipped with seat occupancy
recognition - see page 87.
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
can also be id entified b y the sticker on
the side of the instrument p anel see Fig. 17625 J.
The seat occupa ncy recognition sy stem
detects Vauxhall child restraint systems
with tra nsponders 3 and sw itc hes off the
front and side a irb ag sy stems for the front
passenger’s seat. The curtain airbag
sy stem remains a ctiv ated. S eat occupancy
recognition – see page 87.
Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can b e identified by
a sticker or badge - see illustration.
Seats, interior
Cigarette lighter 3
Accessory soc kets 3
The c ig arette lighter is in the front centre
console.
The soc ket in the centre console and the
cigarette lighter socket can be used to
connect electrical accessories. The sockets
are ready for operation when the ignition is
switched on. If the eng ine is not running the
battery will be discharged. More acc essory
sockets 3 can be found in the centre
console beneath the rear air vents 3 and in
the Travel Assista nt 3.
Press in cigarette lighter with ignition
switched on. S witches off autom atically
when elem ent is glowing. Withdraw
cigarette lighter.
Estates have an additional accessory
socket 3 to the left in the luggage
compartment next to the lug gage
compartment lig hting.
93
Do not dam age the soc kets by using
unsuitable plugs.
The maximum power c onsumption of
electrical ac cessories m ust not ex ceed
120 w atts.
Do not connect any current-delivering
acc essories, e.g. electrical charging
devices or b atteries.
Electrical ac cessories connected to the
socket must c om ply with the
electromagnetic compatibility
requirements laid down in DIN VDE 40 839,
otherwise v ehicle malfunctions may oc cur.
Accessory sockets in the Travel
Assistant 3 – see page 60.
94
Seats, interior
Ashtray
To be used only for ash and not for
combustible rubbish.
9 Warning
Failure to observe these descriptions can
lead to injuries which may be fatal.
Vehicle passengers must be informed
according ly .
Front ashtray
The a sh tray is in the front c entre console
beneath a cov er.
The cover opens when pressed at the point
indicated .
To empty , grip b oth sides of the ashtray
insert a t the points illustrated and pull
up wards.
Rear a sht ray 3
The ash tray is in the rea r centre console.
The cover op ens when pressed a t the point
indicated.
To empty, open the ashtray, press the
spring (arrow ) and pull out the ashtray.
Seats, interior
Stowage c ompartmen ts
Glov e com part ment
To open, pull hand le upwards.
At the front of the opened cover there is a
pen holder.
The g lov e com partment should remain
closed w hilst driving.
Cooled glove compartment 3 –
see page 143.
Centre consol e stow age comp artm ent 3
Div ision of the stowage compartment can
be changed by moving the pa rtition in the
side guides.
95
St owage compa rtment in the r oof lining 3
To open, press the point indicated.
The maximum permitted load on the
stowage compartment is 0.4 kg .
The stowage com partment must be closed
whilst driving.
96
Seats, interior
Stow age com partm ents in t he l ug gage
com partm ent
To access press down b ar and open the
cover.
Warning triangle ¨ 3 and first-aid k it + 3
stow age – see page 234.
Stowing the sp are wheel – see page 236.
Jac k and v ehicle tools stow age –
see page 238.
Estates have an additional stowage
compartment in the load comp artm ent
floor.
To op en, pull the release lever a nd open
the flap.
When opening , ensure that the hinge a t the
fold is opened and that the entire floor
covering is not raised.
Seats, interior
97
Su nvisors
Use the sunvisor to protect from glare b y
pulling it d ow n and swivelling it to the side.
During driving, the mirrors 3 in the
sunv isors should be covered.
Drink holders
Drink hol ders, front 3
The d rink holder can be found between
the front seats in the centre console:
slid e cov er 3 open.
Dr inks holders, rear 3
The drink holder can be found beneath the
centre seat: pressing front edge moves
drink hold er out.
Drink holder in Travel Assistant 3 –
see p age 60.
98
In struments, controls
Instruments, controls
Control indic ators
The control indica tors described here are
not present in all vehic les. The descriptions
however, apply to all instrument versions.
The control indica tor colours mean:
z Red
z Y ellow
Danger, important rem ind er
Warning , note, fault
z Green
z Blue
O n confirmation
O n confirmation
O
Turn sig nal lig ht s
Control indica tor flashes green.
Control indicators .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Instrument display ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Information display . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Warning buzzers.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Wind screen wiper .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
98
105
108
126
126
The control indica tor flashes on the
respective side.
Both c ontrol indicators flash with the
ha zard warning lights on.
Rapid flashes: A turn sig nal lig ht or the
related fuse has failed, fa ilure of turn signal
lig ht on the caravan/trailer 3 .
Turn signal lights – see page 130.
Change bulb s - see page 252.
Fuses - see page 246.
I
Engine oil pressure
C ontrol indicator illuminates red.
It illuminates w hen the ignition is switched
on and extinguishes shortly after the
eng ine starts.
Illuminates when the eng ine is running:
Eng ine lubrication m ay be interrup ted. This
ma y result in damage to the engine and/or
locking of the drive wheels:
1. Move out of the flow of traffic a s quickly
as possible without impeding other
vehicles.
2. Depress clutch.
3. Shift manual transm ission or
Easytronic 3 into neutral; for a utomatic
tra nsmission 3 , set selector lever to N.
4. Switch off ignition.
9 Warnin g
When the eng ine is off, considerably
more force is needed to brake and steer.
Do not remove key until v ehicle has com e
to a standstill, otherw ise the steering
colum n lock could engage unexpectedly .
C heck oil level before contac ting a
workshop.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
99
p
Alt erna tor
C ontrol indic ator illuminates or flashes red.
It illuminates w hen the ignition is switched
on and extinguishes shortly after the
eng ine starts.
Flashes while starting:
Battery voltage too low. H ave electrica l
system tested b y a work shop.
R
Brak e system , clut ch system
Control indicator illuminates or flashes red.
It illuminates when the ignition is switched
on if the handbrak e is applied or if the
brake and c lutch fluid level is too low. For
further instructions – see pages 209, 276.
For vehicles with Ea sy tronic 3 , the c ontrol
indica tor flashes for a few seconds when
the ig nition is turned off if the handbrak e is
not a pplied.
9 Warning
Illuminate if the handbrake has been
released: stop vehicle and interrupt
journey im mediately. Contact a
workshop for assista nce.
Illuminates when the eng ine is running:
S top and switch engine off. Battery w ill not
be charged. Eng ine cooling may be
interrupted . Effec t of bra ke serv o unit may
stop in vehicles with diesel engines.
C heck d riv e b elt condition and tensioning
before contacting a w orkshop for
assistance.
v
Airb ag system s 3 , belt tensioners 3
C ontrol indicator illuminates red.
Illuminates when the eng ine is running:
Fault in the airbag sy stems, seat
occupancy recognition 3 or belt tensioners
- see pa ges 74, 86.
100
In struments, controls
(
Door open
C ontrol indicator illuminates red.
It illuminates w ith the doors open.
j
Easytronic 3, star ting the engine
C ontrol indicator illuminates yellow .
W
Coola nt temperat ure
Control indicator illum inates red.
Illuminates when the engine is running:
Stop a nd turn engine off, coolant
tem perature is too high. Risk of engine
dam age. For coola nt temp erature display see page 106. C heck coola nt level see page 275.
8
Exterior l ights
Control indicator illum inates green.
It is illuminated when the exterior lighting is
on – see pa ge 128.
1
SPORT mode of a ut omati c t ransmission 3
Control indica tor is illuminated in the
tra nsmission display if the SPO RT mode 3
is selected .
Further inform ation - see pages 178, 179.
T
Wi nt er program me of autom atic
transmission 3 or Easyt ronic 3
Control indica tor illuminates in
tra nsmission display with Winter
prog ra mme engaged.
Further inform ation – see pages 172, 180.
It illuminates if the footbrak e is not
depressed. The indicator ex ting uishes as
soon as the footb ra ke is depressed. The
eng ine can only b e started with the
footbrake dep ressed - see page 169.
t
Bulb rep lacement 3
C ontrol indicator illuminates red.
It illuminates if a bulb is defective. Check
the lights and replace any defective bulbs.
Replacing bulbs - see page 252.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
s
r
It illuminates with the lug gage
compartment open, to close luggage
compartment – see pa ge 34.
Fault in system. Contact a work shop for
help.
>
u
O pen l uggage com partm ent
Control indicator illum inates red.
Front fog lig hts 3
Control indicator illum inates green.
It is illuminated when the front fog lights
are on – see page 130.
C
Pa rking distance sensors 3
Control indica tor illuminates y ellow.
Pa rk ing distance sensors 3 – see page 202.
Continuous Damp ing Control 3, SPO RT
mode
Control indica tor illuminates y ellow.
Fault in system. Contact a work shop for
help.
Mai n bea m
Control indicator illum inates blue.
Further inform ation – see page 198.
It is illuminated when main beam is on and
during headlight flash – see pa ges 7, 128.
Seat belt 3
Control indica tor illuminates red.
r
Fog tail light
Control indicator illum inates yellow.
It is illuminated when the fog tail light is on
– see pa ge 131.
X
It illum ina tes onc e the ignition has been
switched on until the seat belt is applied.
A warning buzzer also sound s once the
vehicle has started moving.
Putting on a seat belt – see page 76.
101
A
Engine el ect ronics, transmi ssion
electronics 3 , diesel fuel fi lter 3,
im mobil iser
C ontrol indicator illuminates or flashes
y ellow.
It illuminates for a few sec onds when the
ignition is switched on.
Illuminates when the eng ine is running:
Fault in engine or gearbox electronic
system. Electronics have switched on
emergency running programme; fuel
consum ption m ay be increa sed and the
vehicle’s driveability reduced see page 192. Contact a workshop
imm ediately.
Diesel engines 1 ) Z 19 DTL, Z 19 DT,
Z 19 DTH: Hav e water drained from diesel
fuel filter - see page 274.
Flashes when the ig nition is on:
Fault in the electronic immobiliser system ;
the engine cannot be started see page 27.
1)
Sales des ig nation – see p ag e 284, 285.
102
In struments, controls
H
C ool ant level
C ontrol indicator illuminates yellow .
Illuminates when the eng ine is running:
C oolant fluid level too low. Stop, turn off
eng ine. C heck coolant fluid level see page 275.
u
Anti -lock Bra ke Syst em (ABS )
C ontrol indicator illuminates red.
!
Preheat ing for di esel engines 3,
diesel part icle filter 3
Control indicator illum inates or flashes
yellow.
Illuminates:
Preheating system active, switches on only
if outside tem perature is low.
Flashes:
(in v ehicles with diesel particle filter)
The driving situation is such that the diesel
particle filter self-cleaning function cannot
op erate autom atically. You may continue
to drive the vehic le normally. The vehicle
will not be d amaged and does not require
service.
The self-cleaning function will
autom atic ally operate whilst driving after
the engine has reached its norma l
op erating temperature. The control
indica tor ! will continue to flash until
the self-clea ning operation is c om plete.
This may take up to 20 minutes of driving.
The time will be shorter at higher vehicle
speeds.
Further inform ation – see page 194.
Illuminates whilst driving:
Fault in Anti-lock Bra ke System see page 210.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
p
y
Fault in elec tro-hydraulic p ow er assisted
steering system . The power assisted
steering may hav e failed. The vehicle can
be steered but considerably more force is
req uired. C ontact a workshop for
assistance.
Illum inates:
Sea t occupancy recognition has detected
a child restraint system with tra nsponders.
Airba g systems for the front passenger’s
seat are dea ctiv ated - see page 87.
Elec tro-hyd raulic pow er assisted steeri ng
Control indicator illum inates red.
v
Elec tronic St abili ty Progra mme
(ESP® P lu s) 3
Control indicator flashes or lights yellow.
Flashes w hilst driving:
Sy stem actively engaged - see page 196.
Illuminates whilst driving:
Sy stem switched off or fault in the
Electronic Stability Programm e see page 196.
Seat occup ancy r ecog ni tion 3
Control indica tor illuminates or flashes on
the odometer display.
Flashes:
Fault in the sy stem or child restraints with
tra nsponder fitted incorrectly see p age 87.
S
Engine oil l ev el 3
Control indica tor illuminates y ellow.
The engine oil lev el is check ed
autom atic ally.
Illum inates when the engine is running:
Engine oil level too low . Check engine oil
level and top up engine oil if necessa ry see p age 272.
103
m
C ruise cont rol 3
C ontrol indicator illuminates green.
It is illuminated when the sy stem is on –
see page 200.
Y
Fuel lev el
C ontrol indicator illuminates or flashes
y ellow.
Illuminates:
Low fuel level, fuel gauge in reserv e a rea.
Flashes:
Fuel supply exhausted, refuel immediately .
N ever let the tank run dry.
Erra tic fuel sup ply can c ause catalytic
converter to overheat - see pa ge 190.
Diesel engines: I f the tank is run dry, b leed
the fuel sy stem as desc rib ed on pa ge 228.
104
In struments, controls
B
Ad aptiv e Forwa rd Lighting (AFL) 3
C ontrol indicator flashes yellow.
Flashing:
Fault in sy stem. C ontac t a workshop for
help .
Flashing for 4 seconds when the ig nition is
switched on:
S ystem ad justed for d riv ing abroad.
AFL - see page 132.
Z
Exhaust ga ses 3
Control indicator illum inates or flashes
yellow.
It illuminates when the ignition is switched
on and extinguishes shortly after the
engine sta rts.
Illuminates when the engine is running:
Fault in emission control sy stem. The
permitted emissions may be exceed ed.
Contact a workshop im med ia tely.
If it flashes when the engine is running :
Fault that may cause dama ge to the
cataly tic converter – see page 192. Contact
a w orkshop for assistance im med ia tely.
w
Tyre pressure m oni toring system 3
Control indica tor illuminates red:
Ty re p ressure difference, chec k tyre
pressure at nex t opportunity.
Control indica tor flashes red :
Considerable pressure difference or direc t
loss of pressure, stop immediately and
check ty res and ty re pressure.
Control indica tor illuminates y ellow:
Fault in system. Contact a work shop for
help.
Ty re p ressure monitoring system –
see p age 204.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
105
O dometer
Records the miles (k ilometres) counted.
Display in the ev ent of airbag system
ma lfunction – see page 86.
Trip odometer
Display of m iles (kilom etres) covered since
reset.
To set to z ero, hold reset knob down for
app rox . 2 seconds with ignition switched
on.
Instrum ent display
In some model v ariants the pointers of the
tachometer, the speedometer, the coolant
tem perature gauge and the fuel gauge
briefly go to the end stop as a functionality
check .
Ta chometer
Indicates eng ine speed.
Warning zone: Max im um permissible
engine speed ex ceeded; d anger to engine.
Speedometer
Speed d isplay .
106
In struments, controls
For physical reasons, the engine
temperature gauge show s the coolant
temperature only if the coolant level is
adeq uate.
During operation the system is pressurised.
The temp erature ma y therefore rise briefly
to ov er 100 °C.
Coola nt temperat ure d isplay
Pointer in zone
= Engine operating
at left
temperature not yet
reached
Fuel gauge
Pointer in
left zone or
Y illumina ted
Pointer betw een
the z ones
=
Normal operating
temperature
Pointer in
warning zone at
right or W is
illuminated
=
Temperature too
high: Stop. S witch
off engine. Risk of
engine d amage.
Check coolant level
- see page 275.
Pointer in
left zone or
Y flashing
=
Reserve area
=
Refuelling see page 189
N ever let the tank run dry.
Diesel engines: I f the tank is run dry, b leed
the fuel sy stem as desc rib ed on pa ge 228.
Because of the fuel remaining in the tank,
the amount of fuel required to fill the tank
ma y be less than the spec ified tank
cap acity.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
107
For Easy tronic 3, the display flashes for a
few seconds if A, M or R is selected when
the engine is running but the footbrake is
not d epressed.
Transmission displ ay 3
Display of gear selected for automatic
transm ission 3 or current gear or m od e for
Ea sy tronic 3 .
P
Automatic transm ission park
position
R
N
Reverse gear
Neutral
A
M
Automatic mode on Ea sy tronic
Manual m od e on Easy tronic
D
Automatic mode on automatic
transm ission
1-5
Manual m od e, c urrent gear on
Easy tronic
1-5
Manual m od e, selected gear on
1-6 3 automatic
I nS P Service interv al displ ay 3
When InSP appea rs on the odometer
display, make an ap pointment with a
workshop for servicing as soon a s possible.
We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
S ervice, maintena nce – see page 268.
108
In struments, controls
12:01 17,0°C
FM 3 90,6 MHz
REG
AS
RDS
TP
11:25 }
21 .5°C
Timer
Tripl e I nformati on Di sp lay
Display of time, outside tempera ture and
date/Infotainment sy stem 3 (w hen it is on).
When the ignition is off, the time, date and
outside tem perature can be presented for
15 second s b y briefly pressing one of the
two buttons b elow the displa y.
Display F in the display indicates a fa ult.
Hav e the cause eliminated by a workshop.
19,5° 19:36
All values
Board Inform ation Displ ay 3
Display of time, outside temp erature a nd
date/Infotainment system 3 (when it is on).
Display F in the display indica tes a fault.
Have the cause elim inated by a w ork shop.
257.0
40
1
Ø
8
7.0
Ø 31.0
[ TP]
257miles
Information display
Board Computer
BC 2
Range
RDS
Ü
BC 1
miles
mph
gal.
miles/ gal.
Grap hical I nformat ion Disp lay 3,
C olour Informa tion Display 3
Display of time, outsid e tem perature, date/
Infotainment system 3 (when it is on) and
Electronic Clima te C ontrol 3.
The Gra phic al Inform ation Display
presents the information in monochrome.
The Colour Information Display p resents
the information in colour.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
The ty pe of information and how it is
displayed depends on the equipment
of the v ehicle and the I nfotainment
system 3, trip comp uter 3 and Elec tronic
Clim ate C ontrol 3 settings.
Some inform ation appea rs on the displa y
in an abb reviated form.
For Infotainm ent system - see Infotainment
system instructions.
:
8:56
-5 ,5° C
07.04.2004
For Elec tronic C limate Control 3 see page 156.
Display F in the display indicates a fa ult.
Hav e the cause eliminated by a workshop.
109
Slippery road
-2, 5°C
OK
Outside temperature
A fall in temp erature is indicated
immed iately and a rise in temperature
after a tim e delay.
If outside temp erature d rops to 3 °C , the
sy mbol : illuminates in the Triple
Information Display or the Board
Information Display 3 as a warning for icy
road surfaces. : rem ains illuminated until
temperatures reach a t least 5 °C .
In v ehicles with Graphical I nformation
Display 3 or C olour Inform ation Display 3 ,
an icy road surfac e wa rning m essage
app ears on the display. No m essag e
is displayed if the temperature is less
than -5 °C .
9 Warnin g
Caution: The road surface may already
be icy even though the d isplay indicates
a few deg rees ab ov e 0 °C .
110
In struments, controls
8:56
5 ,5°C
07.04.2 004
Triple Information Display
Set d ate and ti me
Infotainm ent system off: p ress Ö and ;
below the display as follows:
Press Ö for ap prox . 2 seconds:
Day flashes
;:
Set day
Ö:
;:
Month flashes
Set month
Ö:
;:
Year flashes
Set year
Ö:
;:
Hours flash
Set hours
Ö:
;:
Minutes flash
Set minutes
Ö:
Clock is started .
Correcting time 3
Some RDS transmitters do not send a
correct time sig nal. If the incorrect time is
continually displayed, deactiv ate
autom atic time sy nchronisation 3 - see
next column, and set the tim e m anually .
The automatic setting is indicated by } in
the display.
Deactivating/ac tiv ating autom atic time
synchronisation: Infota inm ent system off,
press Ö and ; below the display:
Hold down Ö for app rox . 2 sec., clock
display is now in setting m ode,
Press Ö twice (until year flashes).
Press Ö and hold down for approx.
3 seconds until } flashes in d isplay 3 a nd
text "RDS TIME" appears (yea rs flash
during this tim e),
Press ;; display shows:
RDS TIME 0 = O ff
Press ;; display shows:
RDS TIME 1 = O n
Press Ö three tim es.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
11:25}
111
21.5°C
Range
257miles
Board In formation Display 3,
selecting functio ns
Functions and settings of some
equipm ent 3 can be accessed via the
Board Information Disp la y.
This is done using the menus and the
buttons/four-way button on the
Infotainm ent system 3 or the left-hand
adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel.
The resp ective menu op tions are then
shown in the following lines on the disp lay.
If check control warning messages 3 are
displayed, the disp la y is blocked to other
displays. C onfirm the warning message. If
there are several warning messages,
confirm one after the other.
To select w ith four-wa y but ton:
Select options v ia the m enus and with the
buttons/four-w ay button on the
Infotainment sy stem 3.
To selec t using the left adj ust er w heel 3
on the steer ing wheel
S croll upw ards
Prev ious menu item.
S croll d ow nw ards
N ext m enu item .
Press
S elec tion of hig hlighted item, confirmation
of comm and s.
S ystem settings - see page 112.
Trip comp uter 3 – see page 114.
112
In struments, controls
The functions are displayed in the following
order:
11:25}
21.5°C
System
Board In formation Display 3,
System settings
Press the Sett ings button of the
Infotainm ent system. Menu item Audio or
System will app ear.
Press the lower button of the four-way
button to reach m enu item System . After
pressing the right-hand part of the fourway button, the first function of the System
menu is shown.
Some inform ation appea rs on the displa y
in an abb reviated form.
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
Time synchronisation,
Time, setting hours,
Time, setting minutes,
Date, setting day ,
Date, setting month,
Date, setting year,
Ignition logic,
Language selection,
Setting units of measure.
11:25}
21.5 °C
Clo ck Sync.On
C orrec ting ti me 3
S om e RDS transm itters do not send a
correc t time signal. I f the incorrect time is
continually displayed, deactivate
automatic time synchronisation 3 and set
the tim e m anua lly - see nex t page.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
113
The a utomatic setting is indicated by } in
the d isplay .
To correct time with the help of R DS, select
the m enu item for time synchronisation
from the Set tings menu.
Make the desired setting.
Setti ng date and time
Select the menu item for time and da te
setting from the Settings menu.
11:25 }
21 .5°C
English
11:25}
21.5 °C
Unit Europe- SI
Make the desired setting.
The setting is executed upon exit from the
menu item.
Ig ni tion logic 3
Adjustment - see Infotainm ent system
instructions.
Lang uage selecti on
You can select the d isplay language for
some func tions.
Sett ing units of measure
Y ou can select which units of mea sure are
to be used.
Select the menu item for language from the
Settings m enu and ma ke the desired
setting.
S elec t the menu item for units of measure
from the Settings m enu and ma ke the
desired setting.
114
In struments, controls
Board In formation Display 3,
trip computer 3
The trip computer p rov ides information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and evaluated electronically .
11:25 }
21 .5°C
Access trip computer vehicle data by
pressing the BC button on the Infotainment
system or the left ad juster w heel 3 on the
steering wheel.
Inst . Consumpt.
Some inform ation appea rs on the displa y
in an abb reviated form.
29.6 miles/gal.
O nce an audio function has been selected,
the subsequent rows of the trip computer
func tion are displayed.
The functions are displa yed in the following
order:
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
Instantaneous consumption,
Av erage consump tion,
Effective consump tion,
Av erage speed,
Distance tra velled,
Rang e,
Stop watch.
Instantaneous consumption
Display changes depending on speed:
Display in gal/h
Display in mpg
below 8 mph (13 k m/h)
above 8 mph (13 km/h)
Av era ge consum ption
Average consumption display.
Measurement m ay be reset to zero at any
time and restarted - see "Resetting the trip
computer information".
Effec tive consumpt ion
Fuel consum ption d isplay .
Measurement m ay be reset to zero at any
time and restarted - see "Resetting the trip
computer information".
Av era ge sp eed
Average speed disp lay.
Measurement m ay be reset to zero at any
time and restarted - see "Resetting the trip
computer information".
S topp ages in the journey with the ignition
off are not included in the c alcula tions.
Distanc e t ravelled
Distanc e trav elled disp la y.
Measurement m ay be reset to zero at any
time and restarted - see "Resetting the trip
computer information".
Instru men ts, c ontrols
11:25}
21.5°C
Range
257miles
Range
Range is calculated from current fuel tank
content and instanta neous consumption.
The d isplay shows average values.
After refuelling, the v ehicle up dates the
range autom atically after a brief delay .
If less than 30 miles (50 k m) can be driven
with the fuel rema ining in the tank, the
warning "Range" a ppears on the d isplay .
If less than 20 miles (30 k m) can be driven
with the fuel rema ining in the tank, the
warning "Refuel!" 3 appears on the
display.
Acknowled ge the menu item as desc rib ed
on page 111.
Resetting the trip c omputer inform ation
The follow ing trip computer information
can be reset (reset to zero and
measurements/calculations restarted):
z
z
z
z
Average consumption,
Effective consumption,
Average speed,
Distanc e travelled.
Select the desired trip computer
information.
Reset using the left wheel on the steering
wheel or the right/left button of the fourway b utton:
11:25}
115
21.5 °C
Stop Watch
01:22:32 h
z Press for more than 2 seconds:
C urrent value.
St op wa tch
O peration with the four-way button:
z Press for more than 4 seconds:
All values.
z Press right button: Sta rt/Stop.
z Press left button for more than
2 second s: Reset.
O perating using the left adjuster wheel 3
on the steering wheel:
z Press: Start/S top .
I nt err up tion of pow er supp ly
If the power supp ly has been interrupted or
if the battery voltage ha s dropped too low,
the values stored in the trip computer w ill
be lost.
116
FM
In struments, controls
[TP]
���
19,5°
C Din
90.6 MHz
19: 36
Graphical Info rmatio n D isplay 3
or Colour Information Display 3 ,
selecting functio ns
The functions and settings of some
equipm ent 3 can be accessed via the
Graphical Information Displa y or the
Colour Information Display .
Functions are selected and executed in the
menu on the display using the four-way
button, the m ulti-function k nob 3 on the
Infotainm ent system or the left wheel 3 on
the steering wheel.
If check control warning messages 3 are
displayed, the disp la y is blocked to other
displays. C onfirm the warning message. If
there are several warning messages,
confirm one after the other.
To select w ith four-wa y but ton:
Select menu items via menus and with the
buttons/four-w ay button of the
Infotainment sy stem.
To selec t using the mult i-function k nob :
Turn
Highlighting of menu options or
comm ands, selection of func tion ranges,
Press
S elec tion of highlighted option,
confirmation of commands.
To exit a m enu, turn the m ulti-func tion
knob left or right to Return or Mai n and
select.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
7
FM
[TP]
C Din
Settings
Time, Date
117
19,5° 19:36
19:36
Language
���
90.6 MHz
Units
10 . 07 . 2004
Contrast
Day / Night
19,5°
To sel ect usi ng the left adj uster w heel 3
on the steeri ng wheel
Scroll upwards
Previous menu item.
Scroll downward s
Next m enu item.
Press
Selection of highlighted item, confirmation
of comma nds.
19: 36
Functi on ranges
For each functional area there is a main
page (Main), which is selected at the
top edg e of the displa y (not with
Infotainment sy stem CD 30 without the
ha nds-free mobile phone system):
z
z
z
z
Audio,
Na vigation 3,
Telephone 3 ,
Trip comp uter 3.
For audio, nav igation 3 and telephone
functions 3 - see Infotainm ent system
instructions.
6 Ign. logic
System settings
The settings are accessed via the Setting s
menu.
Press the Ma in button 3 (not found on all
Infotainment sy stems) on the Infotainm ent
system (c all up main display).
Press the S ett ings button of the
Infotainment system. No m enu may be
selected with Infotainment System CD 30.
The Settings m enu is displa yed.
118
7
In struments, controls
Time, Date
Time
Date
19,5° 19:36
19:36
10 . 07 . 2004
6 Synchron. clock automatical.
Setti ng the date and time 3
Select menu item Time, Dat e from the
Setti ng s menu.
The m enu for Time, Date is displayed.
Select the menu items required:
Correcting time 3
For systems with GPS receiver 1 ), time and
date a re automatically set up on receipt of
a GPS satellite signal. If the display ed tim e
does not correspond to local time, time can
be m anua lly corrected in 30-m inute
increments or automatically corrected via
receipt of an RDS tim e signal2) 3.
Some RDS tra nsmitters do not send correct
tim e signals. If the incorrect time is
display ed often, deactivate autom atic
tim e synchronisation 3 a nd set the tim e
manually.
To correct tim e with the help of RDS, select
menu item Synchron. clock autom atica l.
from the Time, Da te menu.
The box in front of Synchron. clock
automat ical. will be ticked; see
Fig. 17340 T.
7
Settings
19,5° 19:36
Time, Date
Language
English
Units
German
Contrast
Español
Day / Night
Nederlands
6 Ign. logic
Français
Languag e selection
Y ou can select the display language for
some functions.
S elec t menu item Language from the
Sett ings menu.
The available languages are displayed.
Make the desired setting.
1)
2)
GPS = G lo ba l P os itioning System ,
Satellite system for wo rld-wid e pos itioning .
RDS = Rad io D ata S ys tem.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
7
13 Languages
19,5° 19:36
X English
7
Settings
Language
Español
Units
Nederlands
Contrast
F rançais
Day / Night
Italiano
6 Ign. logic
Selections are indicated by a 6 in front of
the m enu item .
In systems with voice output 3, w hen the
language setting of the displa y is changed
the system will ask whether the
announcement language should also be
changed – see Infotainment system
instructions.
7
Contrast
19,5° 19:36
Time, Date
German
Select the desired language.
19,5° 19:36
~
|
|
|
Europe-SI
Japan
12
Great Britain
USA
Setting unit s of m easur e
You can select which units of measure are
to be used .
Select menu item U ni ts from the
Settings menu.
The ava ilab le units are display ed.
Select the desired unit.
Selections are indicated by a o in front of
the menu item.
119
Ad just ing contra st 3
(Graphic al Inform ation Displ ay)
S elec t menu item Cont rast from the
Sett ings menu.
The menu for Contr ast is disp layed .
C onfirm the required setting .
120
In struments, controls
Setti ng displa y mod e 3
The displa y ca n be adjusted to suit the light
conditions, black or coloured tex t on a light
back ground or white or coloured text on a
dark background.
Select menu item Day / N ight from the
Setti ng s menu.
The options are display ed.
Autom atic: adapted based on vehicle
lighting .
Alw ays day design: black or coloured tex t
on light backg round.
Alw ays night desi gn: white or coloured
tex t on dark b ackground .
Selections are indicated by a o in front of
the m enu item .
Ig ni tion logic 3
Adjustment - see Infotainm ent system
instructions.
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
19,5° 19:36
All values
1
257.0
Ø 40
8
7.0
Ø 31.0
Tyres
Range
miles
mph
Aver. Consump.
Inst. consumpt.
257 miles
31.0 miles/gal.
29.6 miles/gal.
gal.
miles/ gal.
Graphic al Information Display 3
or Colour Information Display 3,
trip computer 3
The trip computers provide information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and ev alua ted electronically.
The trip computer main page (Main)
prov ides inform ation about ra ng e,
averag e fuel consumption 3 and
instantaneous consumption.
To display other trip com puter data,
press the BC button on the Infotainment
sy stem 3, select the trip computer menu
on the display or p ress the left adjuster
wheel 3 on the steering wheel.
19,5°
23°
5
Eco
x
19: 36
Ra ng e
Range is calculated from current fuel tank
content and instantaneous consumption.
The display shows av erage values.
After refuelling, the vehicle updates the
range automatically a fter a brief delay .
Instru men ts, c ontrols
Di st ance trav ell ed
Distance travelled display.
Measurement may be reset to zero at any
tim e and restarted - see " Resetting the trip
computer information" .
Ü
Average speed
Av erage speed display.
Measurement may be reset to zero at any
tim e and restarted - see " Resetting the trip
computer information" .
Range
2 9m iles
If less than 30 miles (50 k m) can be driven
with the fuel rema ining in the tank, the
warning "Range" a ppears on the d isplay .
If less than 20 miles (30 k m) can be driven
with the fuel rema ining in the tank, the
warning "Please refuel! " 3 appea rs on the
display. At that point "Please refuel! " 3 will
also be displa yed on the trip comp uter
main pa ge (Ma in) instead of "Range" .
Acknowled ge the menu item as desc rib ed
on page 116.
Instant aneous consump tion
Display changes depending on speed :
Display in gal/h
below 8 mph (13 km/h)
Display in mp g
ab ov e 8 m ph (13 km /h)
Effectiv e consum ption
Fuel consumption display.
Measurement may be reset to zero at any
tim e and restarted - see " Resetting the trip
computer information" .
Average consumpt ion
Av erage consump tion display .
Measurement may be reset to zero at any
tim e and restarted - see " Resetting the trip
computer information" .
19,5° 19:36
All values
BC 2
Timer
257.0
40
1
Ø
8
7.0
Ø 31.0
Tyres
Stoppages in the journey with the ignition
off are not includ ed in the calculations.
OK
Board Computer
BC 1
121
miles
mph
gal.
miles/ gal.
Reset ting t he tr ip comp uter informat ion
The following trip com puter inform ation
can b e reset (restart measurements):
z
z
z
z
Distance travelled,
Average speed,
Effective consum ption,
Average consum ption.
S elec t BC 1 or BC 2 from the trip computer
menu.
122
In struments, controls
Ü Reset BC 1
19,5° 19:36
Ø
257.0
40
7.0
Ø 31.0
Ü Reset BC 1
19,5° 19:36
All values
All values
m iles
m ph
gal.
m iles/gal.
The information from both trip computers
can be reset separately , mak ing it possible
to evaluate d ata over different time
periods.
Select the desired trip computer
inform ation.
The v alue for the selected function will b e
reset and reca lculated.
Ø
257.0
40
7.0
Ø 31.0
m iles
m ph
gal.
m iles/gal.
To reset all information of a trip computer,
select m enu item All v alues.
If trip computer information has been
selected, " - - -" is displayed after a reset.
The recalculated values are displayed a fter
a brief delay .
I nt err up tion of pow er supp ly
If the power supp ly has been interrupted or
if the battery voltage ha s dropped too low,
the values stored in the trip computer w ill
be lost.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
123
The desired stop watch display c an be
selected from the Opti ons menu 3:
Ü Board Computer
19,5° 19:36
BC 1
BC 2
00:00:00
Timer
Tyres
Start
Reset
Options
Stop wat ch
Select menu item Timer from the Board
Com puter menu.
The Tim er menu is displayed.
Dr iving Ti me excl. S tops
The time the v ehicle is in m otion is
recorded . Stationary tim e is not includ ed.
Dr iving Ti me incl. S tops
The time the v ehicle is in m otion is
recorded . The tim e the vehicle is sta tionary
with the key in the starter sw itc h is
included.
Tr avel Time
Measurement of the time from manual
activation via Sta rt to manual deactivation
via Reset .
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
Tyres
Display of current tyre pressure 3
S elec t menu item Tyr es from the Board
C omputer menu.
To start, selec t menu item St art.
The current pressure of eac h ty re is
displayed.
To reset, selec t menu item Reset .
Further information – see page 204.
124
In struments, controls
Check control 3
Check control monitors several fluid levels,
the ty re pressure 3, the remote control
batteries, Vauxhall alarm system 3 a nd the
main vehicle lighting systems, including the
cables and fuses. When towing , the
carava n/trailer lighting system is also
monitored.
O nce the ignition has been switched on, all
check control functions a re automatically
verified.
Warning messa ges appear on the display.
If there are severa l warning m essa ges, they
are disp layed one after the other.
Some inform ation appea rs on the displa y
in an abb reviated form.
Exa mples of warning messages for the
Gra phic al Inform ation Display 3 and
Colour Information Display 3 are shown.
On the Board Inform ation Display ,
messages appear in an abb reviated form.
Ac know ledge warning messages as
described on pages 111, 116.
Una cknowledged warning messages can
be re-displayed later.
Coolant level
ch eck
Warning messages:
Remote C ontrol
Bat ter y
check
Remote c ontrol battery voltage is too low –
see p age 29.
OK
Brakelig ht switch
chec k
Fault. Brake light not illum inating w hen
brak ing oc curs. H ave cause of fault
remedied by a workshop immediately .
Safeguard
chec k
Fault. Sy stem fault in Vaux hall alarm
system. Have the cause of the fault
rectified straight away by a workshop.
Instru men ts, c ontrols
If there is a fault in the v ehicle lighting
system, the respec tiv e location of the fault
is disp layed as tex t, e. g.:
Brakelight
check right
If brak e light is defective, the relev ant tail
light takes ov er the brake light function.
In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring
system 3, if tyre pressure is too low, the
display indicates which tyre to check, e.g .:
Tyre pressure
check rear
right
(v alue in bar)
Check ty re pressure at next opportunity
using suitable gauge. Tyre pressure
monitoring sy stem 3 – see page 204.
Checking tyre pressure – see p age 299.
In vehicles with tyre p ressure control
sy stem 3, if there is m ajor loss of pressure
in a tyre, the d isplay indicates the tyre at
fa ult, e.g .:
Att enti on!
Rear left t yre
pressure l oss
(val ue in b ar)
Stop immediately and check ty re and ty re
pressure. For ty re p ressure monitoring
sy stem 3 – see page 204.
125
Wa sher
Fluid Lev el
chec k
Fluid level in windscreen wash sy stem too
low. Topping up wash fluid – see page 279.
Rear window wash system and headlight
wash system 3 are dea ctiv ated if wash
fluid lev el is low.
Coolant lev el
chec k
Fluid level in eng ine cooling sy stem is low.
C heck c oolant level immed iately –
see page 274.
I nt err up tion of pow er supp ly
S tored warning messages appea r on the
display one after the other.
126
In struments, controls
Push stalk p ast resistance point and hold :
the wind screen wiper stages are run
throug h; an acoustic signal sound s a t
position §.
Warning buzzers
When sta rting t he engine or whil st
driv ing:
z If seat belt is not fastened 3.
Adjusta ble timed interv al wipe $ :
Adjuster wheel right = short interv als
Adjuster wheel left = long intervals
z When driving with a door open or the
lugga ge c om partment a ja r.
z Once you have reached a certain speed
if the handbrake is applied 3.
Press the stalk down from position §:
S ingle swipe.
z If a specified max imum speed is
exceed ed 3.
z In the case of Easy tronic 3 if A, M or R is
selected while the engine is running a nd
the driver’s door is opened but the
footbrake is not depressed.
When t he v ehi cle is park ed and the
driv er’s door is opened:
z When the key is in the starter switch 3 .
z With parking lig hts or dipped beam
switched on.
z In the case of Easytronic 3, if the
handb ra ke is not applied a nd no gear is
engaged when the engine is off.
Windscreen wiper
To activate, gently push stalk upward s.
§
$
%
&
=
=
=
=
Off
Ad justable timed interval wipe
Slow
Fast
The stalk alway s moves bac k to the
starting position. To select next higher or
low er stage: move stalk slig htly .
Instru men ts, c ontrols
Autom atic w iping with ra in sensor 3:
To activate, gently push stalk upwards.
§
$
=
=
Off
Autom atic wiping with rain sensor
The rain sensor detects the am ount of
water on the windscreen a nd automatically
controls the windscreen wiper. Adjust the
sensitiv ity of the system using the adjuster
wheel:
Adjuster wheel right =
Adjuster wheel left =
High sensitivity
Low sensitivity
Keep sensor area of rain sensor clean by
opera ting the windscreen wash system .
Wi nd sc reen wa sh syst em and headl ight
wash system 3
To activate, pull sta lk towards steering
wheel.
The wiper is switched on for severa l wipe
op erations. A single after-wipe occurs at
speeds of up to 80 mph (130 k m/h).
The head lig ht wash system 3 is rea dy for
op eration when the headlights are
switched on. Wash fluid is sprayed onto the
headlights once. Then the head lig ht wash
sy stem is disa bled for 2 m inutes.
On vehicles fitted w ith ra in sensor 3, keep
the sensor area c lean by operating the
wash system regularly.
127
Rear w indow w iper 3 a nd rear wi nd ow
w ash system s 3
Push stalk forwards to switch on.
The rear window w iper swipes in timed
interva l mode.
The tailgate w ip er switches on
automatically when the wind screen wiper
is switched on and reverse gear is
eng aged.
Push stalk forwards aga in to switch off.
The rear window w ash system will rem ain
on for as long as the stalk is held in the
forward position.
The rear window w ash system is
deactivated when the fluid level is low.
128
Ligh ting
Lighting
Model variants with daytim e running
lights 3: Parking lig hts are on when the
ignition is switched on and the light switch
is set to 7 or AUTO. Dipped bea m is on
when the engine is running.
The day time running lights switch off when
the ignition is switched off.
Ex terior lights .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Main beam, headlight flash . .... .... ..... .
Autom atic dipped b eam ac tiv ation 3
Turn signal lights . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Front fog lights > 3 ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Fog tail light r .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Reversing lights.... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Haza rd warning lights.. .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Headlight range adjustment ? .... ..... .
Adaptive Forw ard Lighting (AFL) 3 . .
Door-to-door lighting 3 ... ..... .... .... ..... .
Parking lights .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Instrument illum ination k,
information display illumination ..... .
Courtesy lig ht .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Battery discharge p rotection.... .... ..... .
Light covers. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Headlights w hen driving abroad . ..... .
128
129
129
130
130
131
131
131
131
132
133
134
134
134
136
136
136
Follow the regula tions of the country in
which you are driving w hen using da ytime
running lig hts and front fog lights 3.
Exterior lights
Turn light switch:
7
8
9
=
=
=
Off
Park ing lights
Dip ped or main beam
In positions 8 and 9, the tail lights a nd
numb er plate lights are also on.
Control indica tor 8 – see page 100.
If the ignition is switched off with the
dipped bea m or main b eam on, the
parking lights illuminate 3.
The rear lights of the Estate automatically
switch themselv es off after 10 minutes if
the luggag e compa rtm ent is open and the
vehicle is stationary .
Driving ab road – see pag e 136.
Lightin g
129
To activate the hea dlight fla sh, pull stalk
tow ards steering wheel. Ma in beam is
engaged for the d uration of activation.
The blue control ind ic ator C is illuminated
when main b eam or headlight flash is on.
Main beam, headlight flash
To switch from dipped to main b eam, press
stalk forwards.
To switch to dipped beam, p ush stalk
forwards again or pull towards steering
wheel.
Automatic dipped beam
activation 3
Light sw itch to AUTO: Dip ped beam
switches on or off autom atically when the
eng ine is running based on outside light
conditions.
The exterior lights are turned off by
removing the ignition key.
For reasons of safety , the lig ht switch
should always rem ain in the AUTO
position.
In poor v isibility such as fog, turn the light
switch to 9.
130
Ligh ting
After operation, the turn signal stalk
returns to its sta rting p osition.
If the stalk is moved pa st the resistance
point, the turn signal lig ht remains on.
When the steering wheel moves ba ck
tow ards the straig ht-ahead position, the
turn signal light is autom atically
deactiv ated.
Ta p signa l: Move sta lk to resista nce point
and release to activ ate three flashes from
the turn signals when c ha nging lanes or the
lik e.
Turn signal lights
To activate, press stalk up or down.
Stalk up
=
Stalk down =
R ig ht
Left
Move the stalk to the resistance point and
hold for the turn signals to flash longer.
Switch the turn signal off manually by
moving the stalk slightly.
Front fog lights > 3
The front fog lights can only be switched on
when both the ignition and lights a re on.
On
=
O ff
=
Press >, > illuminates in
instrum ent cluster
Press > aga in or switch off
ig nition or light.
Lightin g
131
Fog tail light
r
The fog ta il light can only be sw itc hed on
when the ig nition is on and dipp ed bea m or
parking lights a re on or if the light switch is
in the A UTO 3 position and dipped beam
is active.
On
=
O ff
=
Press >, > illuminates in
instrument cluster
Press > again or switch off
ignition or light.
The fog ta il light on the vehicle is
deactivated when towing a caravan/
trailer.
Reversin g lights
Illuminate when rev erse gear is enga ged
and ignition is switched on.
Hazard warning lights
To ac tiv ate, p ress button ¨, to deac tiv ate
press button ¨ again.
To aid location of the pushb utton, the red
surface is illuminated when the ignition is
switched on. When the button is pressed,
its control indicator flashes in time with the
ha zard warning lights.
The hazard warning lig hts switch on
autom atic ally when the airbags are
trigg ered , and the central locking unlocks
all doors. Switch off hazard wa rning lights
with button ¨ .
Headlight range adjustment
?
Ma nua l hea dlight range adj ustm ent 3
With dipped beam switched on, adjust
hea dlight range in four steps to suit vehic le
load. Turn wheel a gainst resistance a nd
click it to the required position.
C orrect adjustm ent of the headlight range
reduc es dazz le for other road users.
Automatic level control system 3 see page 204.
6
132
Ligh ting
Vehicles without autom atic lev el control
system
0 =
1 =
2 =
3 =
Front seats occupied
All seats occupied
All seats occupied a nd lug gage
compartment loa d
Driv er’s seat oc cup ied and lug gage
compartment loa d
Vehicles with automatic level control
system 3
0 =
1 =
1 =
2 =
Front seats occupied
All seats occupied
All seats occupied a nd lug gage
compartment loa d
Driv er’s seat oc cup ied and lug gage
compartment loa d
Autom atic headlight ra ng e adj ust ment 3
O n vehicles w ith Xenon headlights, the
range of the head lig hts is adjusted
automatically based on vehicle load.
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) 3
On vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlights, AFL
improves illumination of:
z C urves (curv e lighting),
z Intersec tions and tight turns
(turn lig hting).
Curve lig hting
The Xenon light bea m pivots based on
steering wheel position a nd speed (from
approx. 6 m ph / 10 km /h).
The head lig hts shine at an a ngle of up
to 15° to the right or left of the direction of
tra vel.
Turn lig hting
An add itional light illuminates at certain
steering w heel settings (a fter approx. 90°),
turn signal settings and speeds (up to
app rox . 25 mph / 40 k m/h).
The lig ht shines approx. 90° to the left or
right of the v ehicle and approx. 30 m etres
to the front.
Mot or way lighti ng
At higher speeds and continuous straight
ahead travel, the dipped bea m
automatically raises slightly, thereby
increa sing hea dlight rang e.
Lightin g
133
If the d riv er’s d oor is left op en, the lights will
go out after two minutes.
The lig ht is switched off im media tely b y
inserting the key into the ignition or pulling
the turn signal stalk aga in with the driv er’s
door open.
Cont rol indica tor B
Flashing: Fault in sy stem. The sy stem is not
rea dy for opera tion.
If the curv e lighting swivelling device fails,
the relev ant dipped bea m is sw itc hed off.
The c orresponding fog light is
automatically switched on for reasons of
safety.
Contact a workshop.
Flashing of control indicator B for approx .
4 seconds after switching on the ignition
rem inds you that the head lights hav e been
adjusted - see " Head lig hts when driving
abroad" on page 136.
Door-to-door ligh ting 3
The dipped beam a nd the reversing lights
illuminate for app rox . 30 seconds after the
driver has exited the vehicle and closed his
door.
To activ ate
1. Sw itch off ignition.
2. Remove ignition key.
3. O pen driv er’s door.
4. Pull turn signal stalk towards steering
wheel.
5. C lose driver’s door.
134
Ligh ting
Parking lights
The front p arking lig ht and tail light of one
side of the vehicle can be activ ated w hen
parking:
1. Set light switch to 7 or AUTO 3 .
2. Ignition off.
3. Move turn signal sta lk all the way up
(right parking light) or down (left parking
lig ht).
An acoustic signal sound s a nd control
indicator O illuminates briefly in the
instrument cluster to indica te activ ation.
Remove the ignition key b efore lea ving the
vehic le.
To switch it off, sw itch on the ignition or
move the turn signal sta lk in the opposite
direc tion.
In strument illumination k,
information display illum ination
Brig htness can be adjusted when the
exterior lights are on:
Press to release knob k and then turn it
cloc kwise or anticlockwise and hold until
the desired brightness is obtained.
Display mode 3 – see page 120.
Courtesy light
Front courtesy l ight
Illuminates automatically when the vehicle
is unlocked with the remote control, when a
door is opened or when the key is removed
from the starter sw itch a fter the ignition is
switched off.
Extinguishes a utomatica lly with d elay after
the doors are closed or im mediately w hen
the ig nition is switched on or the doors are
locked.
Front courtesy l ight
Manual operation from inside with doors
closed:
On
O ff
=
=
Press button c
Press button c again
Lightin g
135
Entry l ighting 3
After unlocking the v ehicle, the instrument
and switch illumination as well as the
courtesy lig hts illuminate for a few seconds.
I lluminat ed mirror i n the sunvi sors 3
The lig hting switches on when the cover is
opened.
Glov e c ompar tment lig ht ing
Glove compartment is illuminated when lid
is open a nd ignition on.
C igarette lig hter and ashtra y
ill uminati on 3
Illuminates when ignition is switched on.
Front reading l ights 3
Left and right reading lights are
individually operable. With ignition on:
On
O ff
=
=
Press button
Press button
a.
a a gain
Courtesy lig hts and rear read ing light s 3
Centre sw itc h position: The rear courtesy
lig ht illum ina tes together with the front one
when a d oor is opened.
The rear reading lights on the left and right
can be switched on separately. With
ignition on:
On
Off
=
=
Switch position I
Switch position 0
Luggag e c ompart ment light ing 3
Illuminates when the luggage
compa rtm ent/tailga te is opened.
Autom atica lly reg ul ated centre console
lig hting 3
S potlight in housing of interior m irror.
Day lig ht-dependent, automatically
regula ted centre console lighting with
ignition switched on.
136
Ligh ting
Vehicles w ith Adap tive For ward Light ing
(AFL) 3
1. Open fusebox cover in engine
compartment - see page 250.
Battery discharge protectio n
Headlights when driving abroad
To prevent the battery from bec om ing
discharged, the courtesy light, reading
lights, lug gage compartment lighting a nd
glove compartment lighting switch off
automatically 5 minutes after the ignition is
switched off.
The asymm etrical dipped b eam increases
the field of v ision on the p assenger sid e of
the lane.
This c auses glare for oncoming tra ffic if the
vehicle is driven in countries where traffic
drives on the opp osite side of the road.
2. Insert any fuse (max i-fuse) 3 in slot 37.
Fuse a ssignment – see page 251.
Light covers
Do as follows to prevent glare:
4. Switch on ignition.
The inside of the light covers ma y become
misted up for a short period during
unfa vourab le weather conditions, heavy
rain or after washing the vehicle. The
misting disa ppears automatically after a
short time, b ut c an be speeded up by
switching the lights on.
Vehicles wit h halogen - headlig ht system
or Xenon headlig ht system w ithout
Adapt ive For ward Lig ht ing (AFL) 3
Have the workshop c onvert the headlights.
3. Close fusebox.
Then the AFL control ind icator B flashes
for 4 seconds whenev er the ignition is
switched on.
C ontrol indicator B - see pages 104, 133.
Info tainment system
Infotainment system
137
Radio reception
3
Vehicle radio reception differs from
domestic radio reception:
As the v ehicle antenna is relatively near the
ground, the broadcasting compa nies
cannot g uarantee the sa me quality of
reception a s obtained with a d om estic
ra dio using an ov erhead antenna.
Radio reception 3 .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Infotainm ent system 3 . .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Remote control on steering wheel 3 . .
Twin Audio 3 .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
AUX input 3 .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Electronic data ac quisition at toll
sy stems 3.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Mobile telephones a nd radio
equipment 3. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
137
137
137
138
138
138
139
z C hanges in distance from the
transm itter,
z multi-path rec eption due to reflection
and
z sha dowing
may c ause hissing , noise, distortion or loss
of reception a ltogether.
In fotain men t system 3
The Infotainm ent system is operated as
described in the operating instructions.
Remo te control o n steering
wheel 3
The functions of the Infotainment system 3
and the informa tion display can be
operated w ith the adjuster wheels and
buttons on the steering wheel.
Further information – see pages 111, 116
and the relevant opera ting instruc tions.
138
In fotain men t system
Twin Audio
3
Twin Audio provides rear seat occupa nts
with the opportunity to listen to a different
audio source than the one selected by the
driver on the Infotainment system 3.
O nly an audio source that is not currently
active on the I nfotainment system can be
controlled using Twin Audio.
Two headphone connections are availab le,
with separate volume controls.
AUX inpu t 3
The AUX input is in the stowa ge
compartment in the centre console.
An externa l audio source such as a
porta ble C D player can be connected via
the AUX input using a 3.5 m m jack.
Keep AUX inp ut clean and dry at all times.
Further inform ation is av ailable in the
Infotainment sy stem opera ting
instructions.
Electronic data acquisition at toll
systems 3
In v ehicles with hea t-reflecting
windscreen 1) 3 attach chipcard 3 for
electronic da ta record ing and fee pay ment
in black area of windscreen on left or righthand side behind the interior mirror see arrows in illustration. Attaching the
chipcard outside this area ma y cause data
record ing malfunctions.
Further information is available in the
Infotainm ent system operating
instructions.
1)
Sola r Reflect.
Info tainment system
Mobile telephones and radio
equipment 3
The Vauxhall installa tion instructions and
the operating guidelines p rov id ed by the
telephone manufa cturer m ust be observed
when fitting and operating a m ob ile
telephone. Failure to d o so could invalida te
the vehicle’s operating perm it (EU Directiv e
95/54/EG).
Recommended prerequisites for fault-free
opera tion:
z Professionally installed exterior a ntenna
to ob ta in the max imum range possible.
z Maximum transmission power 10 Watt.
z Installation of the telephone in a suitab le
spot (see informa tion on pag e 89).
O btain advice on pred eterm ined
installation locations for the ex ternal
antenna and equipment holder and w ays
of using devices with transmission power of
more tha n 10 Watts. We recommend that
you consult y our Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will ha ve brackets and
various installation kits available as
accessories and w ill install them in
accordance with reg ulations.
A hand s-free attachment without an
externa l antenna in mobile phone
standards GS M 900/1800/1900 and UMTS
must only be operated if the ma ximum
tra nsmission power of the mobile phone
does not exceed 2 Watts w ith GSM 900 a nd
1 Watt in other cases. The operating
regulations stipulated by the manufa cturer
of the telephone and the hands-free
attachment must be complied with.
139
For reasons of safety, we recommend that
y ou d o not use the phone whilst driving.
Even use of a hands-free set can be a
distraction whilst driving. Be sure to
observe any country-spec ific regulations.
9 Warnin g
Mobile phones and ra dio equip ment may
cause malfunctions in the vehicle
electronics if they are op erated in the
vehicle without the ex ternal antenna
unless the above-m entioned regulations
are c om plied with.
Mobile p hones that do not com ply with
the abov e-mentioned mobile phone
standard and radio equipment must only
be op erated using an antenna tha t is
attached to the exterior of the v ehicle.
140
Climate c ontrol
Climate control
Heating and ventila tion system, air
cond itioning system 3 ... ..... .... .... ..... .
Autom atic air conditioning sy stem 3
Electronic Climate Control 3 . .... .... ..... .
Air vents .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Cooled glove compartment 3 .. .... ..... .
Heated rear window, heated ex terior
mirrors ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Heated front seats 3 .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Heated rear seats 3 ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Driver’ s seat with climate control 3 .. .
Heating and ventila tion system ... ..... .
Air conditioning system 3 ..... .... .... ..... .
Autom atic air conditioning sy stem 3
Electronic Climate Control 3 . .... .... ..... .
Auxiliary heating /ventilation 3 .... ..... .
Air intake . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Air outlet.. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Pollen filter .. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Note .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Maintenance ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
140
141
141
142
143
143
144
144
144
145
148
150
156
163
166
166
166
166
167
Heating and ventilation system,
air conditioning system 3
Ventilation, heating and cooling 3 a re
combined into one unit that is d esigned to
prov ide com fort regardless of the season,
weather or outside temperature.
When cooling 3 is activated, the air is
cooled and dried.
The heating unit heats the air a s required in
all operating m od es depending on the
position of the tempera ture rotary knob.
The air supply ca n be adjusted to suit
requirements by means of the fan.
Vehicles without a n air conditioning system
do not have buttons for cooling n,
air recircula tion 4 or dem isting and
defrosting V.
Air conditioning system 3 – see page 148.
Climate control
141
The set values ap pear on the information
display.
Electronic Clima te C ontrol 3 –
see page 156.
Automatic air conditioning
system 3
Provides a comfortab le interior regardless
of the w eather, outside temperature or
season.
When an interior temperature is set with
the temperature control, the temperature
and am ount of inflowing air are
automatically regulated. A uniform,
comfortable climate in the vehic le is
thereby automatically obtained b ased on
outside climate conditions.
Autom atic air conditioning sy stem 3 –
see page 150.
Electronic Climate Control 3
Offers the g reatest comfort in the vehicle
interior regardless of the c onditions
outside.
To ensure a uniform and comfortable
climate in the vehic le, the tem perature of
inflowing air, air-flow rate and a ir
distribution are a utomatica lly adapted
based on the climate cond itions outside
the vehicle and the current tem perature of
the vehicle interior.
142
Climate c ontrol
Air vents
Pleasant ventilation to the head area
controlled by the position of the
tem perature rotary knob.
To increase the air supply, set the fan to a
higher speed a nd set the a ir distribution
rotary knob to M.
Centre and sid e air vents (1)
To open air vent: Turn vertical adjuster
wheel up.
Adjust the direction of airflow by turning
the horiz ontal and v ertical adjuster wheels.
To close the air v ents, turn the adjustm ent
wheel fully downwards.
Wi nd sc reen defroster nozzles (2)
Air distribution rotary knob to l or J: Air
flows onto windsc reen a nd door windows.
Addit ional air vents
Ad ditional air vents ca n be found b eneath
the wind screen and the door windows, a nd
also in the footwell.
Rear a ir vents 3
To open air vent: Turn v ertical ad juster
wheel all the way up.
Adjust quantity of air by rotating the
control wheel.
The airflow can be directed as desired by
tilting and swivelling the slats.
To close the air vents turn the a djustment
wheel fully downward s.
If the rear seats are unoccupied close the
rear noz zles to increase the air supply at
the front.
Climate control
143
Heating takes place with the engine
running and is switched off autom atically
after approximately 15 minutes.
The heated rear w indow autom atically
switches on if the diesel particle filter 3
is being cleaned.
Cooled glove c ompartmen t 3
Cooled air is fed into the glove
compartment through a noz zle.
If glove compa rtm ent cooling is not
needed , turn the wheel downwards.
Heated rear window,
heated exterio r mirrors
With the ignition on, the rear w indow and
exterior mirror heating is sw itched on by
pressing b utton Ü:
LED in the button Ü illuminated:
Rear w indow and ex terior mirror heating
turned on.
LED in the button Ü extinguished:
Rear w indow and ex terior mirror heating
turned off.
144
Climate c ontrol
Heated front seats 3
Heated rear seats 3
Two knurled wheels beneath the centre air
vent for the left a nd right-hand seats.
Tw o buttons at rear of centre console in
front of the rear seats.
Turn relevant wheel to set required heating
lev el.
When the ignition is switched on, the
heating of the corresponding seat is
activated by pressing the button ß.
Control indica tor above adjustm ent wheel.
We d o not recommend prolong ed use of
the highest level for people with sensitive
skin.
To switch off, set wheel to 0.
Seat hea ting is operational when the
ignition is on.
Driver’s seat with c limate
con trol 3
K nurled wheel at driver’s side below centre
air v ents.
Move knurled wheel to required ventilation
or hea ting setting as per requirements.
LED in the button ß on: Seat heating on.
C ontrol ind icator ab ov e adjustm ent wheel.
LED in the button ß off: Seat heating off.
We do not recomm end prolonged use of
the highest heating lev el for people w ith
sensitiv e skin.
The outboard rea r seats are heated.
To switch off, set wheel to 0.
Function only av ailable with ignition
switched on.
Climate control
Heatin g and ventilation system
Air d istributi on
Setting with the left rotary knob.
L
M
l
J
K
To head area via adjustable air
v ents, to footw ell
To head area via adjustable air
v ents
To w indscreen and front door
w indows
To windscreen, front d oor windows
a nd footwell
To footwell
O pen the air v ents w hen the rotary knob is
set to L or M.
Tem per ature
Setting with the central rotary knob .
Airfl ow
S etting with the right rotary knob .
Red area
Blue area
Four fan speeds:
=
=
Warm
Cold
x
1-4
145
Off
Selected fan sp eed
The ra te of airflow is determined by the
fan. The fan should therefore also be
switched on d uring a journey .
146
Climate c ontrol
Hea ting
The amount of heat is dependent on the
coolant temperature and is thus not fully
attained until the engine is warm.
The c om fort and general well-being of the
vehicle occupants are to a large extent
dependent on a suitab le v entilation a nd
hea ting setting.
For rapid warming of the p assenger
compartment:
z Set a ir distrib ution rotary knob to desired
position, preferab ly position J see page 145.
To obtain tem perature stratification in the
vehicle w ith a pleasant "cool head and
warm feet" effect, mov e the rotary air
distribution rotary knob to K or J , move
the temperature rotary knob to the central
position a nd open the centre air vents.
z Turn the temperature rota ry knob
clockwise as far as it will go (warm).
z Set the fan to speed 3.
Vent ilation
z For max imum ventilation in head area:
Set air distribution rota ry knob to M,
op en all v ents.
z For ventila tion to footwell: Set air
distribution rotary knob to K.
z For simultaneous ventilation to the hea d
area and the footwell: set air distrib ution
rotary knob to L.
z Set the tem perature to the desired
setting.
z Switch fan on, adjust fan setting as
desired.
z O pen air vents.
Vehicles with Quickheat 3:
Depend ing on the outside tem perature
and engine temp erature, the passenger
compartment can be heated more quick ly
by m eans of supplementary electrical
heating.
The auxiliary electric heater switches itself
on a utoma tica lly .
Climate control
147
z Turn the temp erature rotary knob
clockwise as far as it w ill go (warm).
z Set the fan rotary k nob to 3 or 4.
z Activate heated rear w indow Ü.
z Open sid e air vents as required and
direct them towards the d oor w indows.
Heating the foot well
z Set air distribution rota ry knob to K .
z Set the tem perature rotary knob to the
red zone.
z Switch on fan.
Wi nd ow demi st ing and d efrosting
9 Warning
Disregard of the instructions could lead
to misting or icing of the w indows and
sub sequent accidents due to imp aired
visibility.
Misted or icy windows, such as in dam p
weather, from wet clothes or when outsid e
temperatures are low :
z Move air distribution rotary knob to l.
z For simultaneous warming of the
footwell, set air distrib ution rotary k nob
to J .
148
Climate c ontrol
Air conditioning system
3
As a supplement to the heating and
ventilation system, the air c onditioning
system c ools and dehumidifies (dries)
inflowing air.
If cooling or dehum id ification is not
desired, switch off cooling in order to sa ve
fuel.
Cooling switches off autom atically at low
outside tem peratures.
Cooling n
Operation only with engine running and
fa n switched off:
On
=
Press n
Off
=
Press n a gain
Air rec irculati on system 4
The air recirculation button 4 is used to
set the ventilation system in a ir
recirc ulation mode (control indica tor in
the button).
Control indica tor in the button.
If fumes or unpleasa nt od ours penetrate
from outside: temporarily switch on air
recirc ulation system 4.
Climate control
149
The switched -on a ir recirculation sy stem
red uces air repla cement. The humidity
increases and the windows may mist up.
The q uality of the interior air d eteriorates
over time, which may cause drowsiness.
Comfort sett ing
z Set cooling n as desired.
z Air rec irculation system 4 off.
Ma xim um cooling
O pen w indows and sunroof 3 briefly so
that warm air can esca pe rap idly.
z Set air distribution rotary knob to M or
L.
z Cooling n on.
z Set air distribution rotary knob to M.
z Set tem perature rotary knob as desired.
z Turn the temp erature rotary knob
antic lock wise as far as it will go (c old).
z Sw itch on fan a t desired speed
z O pen air vents as required .
Temperature rotary k nob in centre of
adjustment range: warmer air will flow into
the footwell and cooler air into the upper
zone, with warm er air coming from the side
air vents and cooler air from the centre air
vents.
z Set fa n rotary knob to 4.
z Open all air v ents.
The sy stem will switch automatically to a ir
recirc ulation mode.
150
Climate c ontrol
z C ooling n on, the air conditioning
compressor autom atically switches itself
off at low outsid e tempera tures (icing).
z Press button V: The fan w ill
automatically switch to 4, air distribution
directed on to the windsc reen.
z Turn the temperature rota ry knob
clockwise.
z O pen side air vents as required and
direct them towa rd s d oor w indows.
z Sw itch on heated rear window Ü.
Window dem isting a nd defrosting
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to m isted or icy windows a nd
accidents stemming from impaired
visibility.
Misted or ic y windows, such as in damp
weather, from wet clothes or w hen outside
tem peratures are low:
To switch off, press button V aga in; the
air c onditioning w ill operate at the settings
selected previously.
Automatic air co nditio ning
system 3
Provides a uniformly comfortab le interior
regardless of the weather, outside
temperature or season.
To ensure a constant and com fortable
climate in the vehicle, the temperature of
the inflowing air and the air-flow rate are
changed automatically based on clima te
conditions outsid e the vehicle.
Temperature changes due to ex ternal
influences, such as direct sunlight, are
automatically compensated .
Climate control
Autom atic m ode
Basic setting for max imum comfort:
z Set fan rotary knob to A.
z Set air d istribution rota ry k nob to desired
position – see nex t column.
z Use rotary knob to set temperature to
22 °C (a higher or lower tem perature can
be set as desired).
z Air conditioning compressor activation –
see pa ge 152.
z All front air vents op en. If d esired, the
rear air v ents also 3.
Dea ctivation of the air conditioning
compressor ca n reduce the level of comfort
and safety – see pag e 152.
Air distri bution
Setting with the left rotary k nob.
L
To head area via adjustable air
vents, to footwell
M
To head area via adjustable air
vents
l
To windscreen and front d oor
windows
J
To windsc reen, front door windows
and footwell
K
To footw ell
Intermediate settings are possible.
Open the air vents w hen the air distribution
rotary knob is set to L or M.
151
Temperat ur e p reset
S etting with the centre rotary knob .
S et the rotary knob to a value between
17 °C and 27 ° C. Intermed iate settings are
possible.
The selected tem perature is m ainta ined.
For reasons of com fort, temperature can
only be changed in small increments.
There is no temperature control for setting s
below 17 °C (all the way left) or above
27 °C (a ll the way right). The air
conditioning sy stem works at ma ximum
cooling or heating.
152
Climate c ontrol
When the cooling (air conditioning
compressor) is ac tiv e, the air is cooled and
dehum idified. I f cooling or
dehum idifica tion is not desired , switch off
cooling in order to sav e fuel.
C ooling switches off automatically a t low
outside temperatures.
Airflow
Setting with the right rotary k nob.
1 - 4 M anual fan speed setting,
interm ediate settings are p ossib le
A
Automatic fan speed c ontrol
x
Fan off
To activ ate/dea ctiv ate air c ond itioning
compressor (c ooling) n
Operation only with engine running and
fa n switched off:
On
=
Press n
Off
=
Press n again
The fan sp eed regulates the rate of airflow
that is needed to maintain the preselected
tem perature.
Control indica tor in the button.
Select automatic m ode for the hig hest lev el
of comfort.
When the fan is off, the air conditioning
compressor is also off.
Climate control
153
The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air
recirculation mode. The quality of the
passenger compa rtm ent air deteriorates
whic h may c ause the v ehicle occ upa nts to
feel drow sy . In operation w ithout cooling ,
the air humidity increases, so the windows
may mist up. Consequently, manual air
recirculation should only be run for short
periods of time.
To deactiv ate m anual air recirculation:
Press button 4 ag ain. The control
indica tor in the button extinguishes.
Manual air recirc ulation m ode
The a ir recirculation sy stem minimises the
entry of outside air and the air in the
passenger com partment is circulated .
Ventilati on
z For m aximum v entilation in head area:
set air distrib ution rotary knob to M and
open all a ir vents.
Press button 4 , control indica tor in
button.
z For v entilation to footwell: Set air
distribution rota ry knob to K .
z For sim ultaneous ventilation to the head
area and the footwell: set a ir distribution
rotary knob to L .
z Set desired temperature.
z Set fa n rotary knob to A. The fan can
also be ma nually set: Set the rotary knob
to position 1 - 4. Interm ediate settings
are a lso possible.
154
Climate c ontrol
Heating
The a mount of heat is dependent on the
coolant temp erature a nd is thus not fully
attained until the engine is w arm.
For ra pid warming of the passenger
compartment:
z Set the air distribution rotary knob to the
desired p osition – see page 145.
z Set the centre rotary knob to the desired
temperature. We recommend a value of
about 22 °C .
z Set fan rotary knob to A. The fan can
also be manually set: Set the rotary knob
to position 1 - 4. Intermediate settings
are also possible.
Vehicles with Quickheat 3:
Depend ing on the outside tem perature
and engine temp erature, the passenger
compartment can be heated more quick ly
by m eans of supplementary electrical
heating.
The auxiliary electric heater switches itself
on a utoma tica lly .
The comfort and general well-b eing of the
vehicle occupants a re to a large extent
dependent on a suitable ventilation and
heating setting.
To ob ta in temperature stratification in the
vehicle with a pleasa nt "cool head and
warm feet" effect, move the rotary air
distribution rotary knob to K or J, m ov e
the rotary tempera ture rotary knob to
approx. 22° and open the centre air vents.
Ma xim um cooling for very hot interior
O pen w indows and sunroof 3 briefly so
that warm air can esca pe rap idly.
z Cooling n on.
z Set air distribution rotary knob to M.
z Set the temperature rota ry knob to the
desired temperature.
z Set fa n rotary knob to A.
z Open all air v ents.
Climate control
155
z Press b utton V: In fan rota ry knob
position A, the fan automatically
switches to the highest sp eed and air is
directed to the wind screen.
The a utomatic air conditioning system
provides max imum cooling down to the set
value.
At settings below 17 °C (rotary knob all the
way to the left), the system continually runs
with max imum cooling. When the air
conditioning c om pressor is running, air
recirculation is autom atically switched on.
z Set temperature to m aximum heating ,
i.e. turn the centre rota ry knob all the
way to the right (28 °C ).
z Switch on heated rear window Ü.
To switch off, press button V again; the
automatic a ir cond itioning system w ill
operate at the settings selected previously .
Dem ist ing and defr ost ing the window s
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impa ired
visibility.
Misted or icy windows, such as in dam p
weather, from wet clothes or when outsid e
temperatures are low :
z C ooling n on - the AC compressor
deactivates a utomatically when outside
temperatures are low (icing).
156
Climate c ontrol
Electronic Climate Control
3
Provides the greatest amount of comfort in
the interior regardless of the weather,
outside tem perature or season.
FM
To ensure constant and comfortable
climate in the v ehicle, the tempera ture of
the inflowing air, the air-flow rate a nd the
air distrib ution are cha nged automatically
according to clim atic conditions outside
the v ehicle.
The a ir is a utomatica lly regulated in
accordance with the settings personally
selected for the driver’ s a nd front
passenger’s sides.
Tem perature cha ng es due to externa l
influences, such as direct sunlig ht, are
automatically compensated.
Data is show n on the informa tion display .
Setting modifications are briefly shown in
the information display, superim posed
over the currently display ed menu.
The display can vary ac cord ing to the type
of presentation – see p age 108.
Electronic Climate Control settings are
stored in the vehicle key when the vehicle is
locked - see "S toring c ustom vehicle
settings in the vehicle key" - see page 28.
[TP]
���
Different settings are stored for each
remote control. Use of a remote c ontrol will
activate the settings associated with it.
Manua l settings e.g. operating without
cooling and a ir distrib ution c an be selected
using the menu - see pag e 158.
When cooling (air conditioning
compressor) is active, a ir is cooled and
dehumidified.
The pollen filter removes d ust, soot, pollen
and spores from the inflowing outside air.
C Din
90.6
MHz
The autom atic air rec irculation system 3
has an air quality sensor 3 to detect
harmful a mbient gases, in which case it will
switch automatically to a ir recirculation.
When set to automa tic mode, Electronic
C lim ate C ontrol p rov id es the optima l
settings for almost all conditions. If
nec essary , Electronic Climate C ontrol
settings can be modified manually.
The Elec tronic C limate Control is only
operational w hen the engine is running.
C ooling (air conditioning compressor)
switches off autom atically at low outside
temperatures.
Climate control
The temperature c an be set higher or lower
as desired.
Different tem peratures can b e set for the
driver’s and front passenger’ s sides.
Switching off the air conditioning
compressor (Eco app ears on the display)
can have a detrimental effect on comfort
and safety - see page 160.
All air vents (ex cept the rea r air vents 3 )
are controlled automa tic ally in automatic
mode. The front air vents should therefore
always be open.
Autom atic m ode
Basic setting for max imum comfort:
z Press AUTO button.
z Open all front a ir vents. If d esired, the
rear air v ents also 3.
z Air conditioning compressor activation –
see pa ge 160.
z Ind ividually set temperature for the
driv er’s and front passenger’s side to
22 °C using the outer knobs.
157
Autom atic air recircul ation system 3
The ventilation sy stem is set to air
recirc ulation mode and interior a ir is
recirc ulated.
The automatic air recircula tion system has
an air qua lity sensor to d etect harmful
gases in the outside air, in whic h case it will
switch automatically to a ir recirculation.
At low outsid e temperatures and with the
cooling (air conditioning c om pressor)
switched off, automa tic air recirculation
operation w ill be d isabled. This prev ents
the wind ow s from misting up. Switch
ma nually to air recirculation as necessary.
Activating/deac tiv ating autom atic air
recirc ulation system – see page 161.
Manual air recirculation m ode –
see page 162.
158
Climate c ontrol
Temperature pr eset
Using the outer k nobs, temperatures can
be indiv id ua lly set to va lues between 16 °C
and 28 °C.
For reasons of comfort, tempera ture can
only be changed in sm all increments.
FM
[TP]
���
C Din
90.6 MHz
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
Vehicles with Q uic kheat 3 :
Dep ending on the outside temperature
and engine temperature, the p assenger
compartment can be heated more quickly
by mea ns of supplementary electrical
heating.
The a ux ilia ry electric hea ter switches itself
on automatically.
If a temperature below 16 °C is set,
Lo appears on the display: the Electronic
Clim ate C ontrol system runs constantly at
max imum cooling power. The temperature
is not regulated .
If a temperature ab ov e 28 °C is set,
Hi appea rs on the display : the Electronic
Clim ate C ontrol runs constantly at
max imum heating power. The temp erature
is not regulated .
Tem perature settings are stored when the
ignition is switched off.
Common tempera ture setting
Press the knob for the driver’s sid e. The
temperature for both the driver’ s and front
passenger’s side can be set together using
the knob on the driver’s side.
Ma nua l set tings
Under certain circumstances (e.g. iced or
misted windows), the func tions of the
Electronic Climate C ontrol can be m od ified
ma nually.
Individual tem perature settings
Press the knob for the front passenger’s
side. Tempera tures c an be set
independ ently of each other using the
knob s on the driver’ s and front p assenger’s
sides.
Electronic Clima te C ontrol system settings
can b e changed via the centre knob, the
buttons a nd the menus shown on the
display.
The tem perature on both the driver’s and
front passenger’ s side are shown in the
display .
For reasons of comfort, the tempera tures
cannot d iffer by m ore than 2 °C .
Press the centre knob to call up the m enu.
The menu for manual Electronic Clima te
C ontrol system settings app ears on the
display.
Climate control
Air distribut.
FM
[TP]
���
C Din
90.6 MHz
The a irflow can be increased or decreased
by turning the central k nob.
To return to automatic m ode: press
button V or AUTO .
Heated rear w indow - see page 143.
Auxiliary heating 3 - see page 163.
The individ ual menu items are highlighted
by rota ting the centre knob and selected
by pressing it. Selecting certain menus by
pressing the knob will open a submenu.
To ex it a m enu, turn the centre knob left or
right to Return or Ma in and select.
Manual settings are stored when the
ignition is switched off.
Wi nd ow demi st ing and d efrosting
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impa ired
visibility.
Misted or icy windows, such as in dam p
weather, from wet clothes or when outsid e
temperatures are low :
Press button V, c ontrol indicator in
button.
Temperature and a ir distribution setting s
are m ade autom atically, the fan runs at a
high speed (fan speed is indicated on the
display ) and the wind ow s a re quickly
cleared of moisture and ice.
159
160
Climate c ontrol
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
Air conditioning
on / off
Inflowing air is neither cooled nor
dehumidified. This restricts the level of
comfort provided by the Electronic C limate
Control system . This may cause the
wind ow s to m ist up, for exa mple.
Air distribut.
To activate cooling: Select m enu item AC
from the manual settings menu and press
to activate cooling.
Acti vati ng and d eac tiva ting ai r
condit ioning com pressor
If no cooling or dehumidification is
req uired, switch the a ir cond itioning
compressor off (max im um energy sav ing s):
Highlight menu item AC from the manua l
settings menu and select by pressing the
knob. Eco a ppears on the d isplay .
Air distribut ion
S elec t menu item Air d istribut. from the
ma nual settings menu.
Mak e the desired setting s in the Air
di st ribut. menu:
Up
Midd le
Down
Air distribution towards
windscreen and front door
windows
Air distribution to v ehicle
occupants via a djustable air
vents a t front
Air distribution towards footwell
Return to a utomatic air distribution:
deactivate relevant setting or press
button AUTO.
Climate control
FM
[TP]
���
C Din
90.6 MHz
Automatic blower
Strong
Normal
Weak
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
161
Automatic
recirculation
air control at
bad outside air
Airflow
Turn the centre rotary knob c lock wise or
anticlockwise (if no menu for m anua l
settings is d isplay ed). The selec ted fan
lev el is indicated by x and numbers in the
display.
Fan c ont rol in autom atic mode 3
Fan regulation in a utomatic mode can be
modified.
Select menu item A ut omati c blow er from
the manual settings menu a nd select the
desired fan control.
Sw itching autom atic air rec irculati on 3 on
or off
The automatic air recircula tion system has
an air qua lity sensor to d etect harmful
gases in the outside air, in whic h case it will
switch automatically to a ir recirculation.
At speed 0 both the fan a nd cooling (a ir
conditioning c om pressor) are switc hed off.
Depend ing on the setting, the maxim um
airflow, and thereby the noise level, will
increase.
S elec t menu item Auto. r eci rc from the
ma nual settings menu and switc h it on or
off by pressing.
To return to automatic mode: Press AUTO
button.
S witc h to manual air rec irculation as
nec essary .
162
Climate c ontrol
The air conditioning will operate for a
limited period of tim e.
Residual air conditioning on
If necessa ry, the auxiliary heating 3 also
automatically switches on. Observ e notes
on page 163.
To cancel air conditioning, press the A UTO
button.
Manual air recirc ulation m ode
The a ir recirculation sy stem minimises the
entry of outside air and the air in the
passenger com partment is circulated .
Press button 4 , control indica tor in
button.
The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air
recirculation mode. The quality of the
passenger com partment a ir deteriorates
which may cause the vehicle occupants to
feel drowsy. I n op eration without c ooling,
the a ir humid ity increases, so the wind ow s
may mist up. C onseq uently , m anual air
recirculation should only be run for short
periods of time.
To deactivate manual air recirc ulation:
Press button 4 again. The control
indicator in the b utton exting uishes.
Air condit ioning wi th the eng ine not
runni ng
When the vehicle is stop ped and the
ignition is off, the heat or cooling power still
in the sy stem can b e used to condition the
passenger compa rtm ent, for example
when stop ped at a level crossing.
Press AUTO button with the ignition off.
Resid ua l air c onditioning on will appear
briefly in the disp lay.
Climate control
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
Parking heater
The air is direc ted to the windsc reen a nd
the front door wind ow s if the V button is
pressed before switching the ignition off.
9 Warning
Do not switch aux iliary heater on in filling
stations or closed spaces – risk of fire or
injury .
163
Parking heater
Start 1
Start 2
Start 3
On
Setting
Auxiliary heating/ventilation
3
If the engine is switched off, the interior is
heated or ventilated d epending on the
values that hav e been set and the interior
tem perature.
Direct a ctiv ation
For immediate activation with the ignition
on, select menu item Par king heater and
then m enu item On from the manual
settings menu.
The regulation is in ac corda nc e with the
most recent temp erature settings in the
Electronic Climate Control system –
see page 158. When the sy stem is sw itched
on, the temperature setting can b e v aried
using the outer rotary k nobs.
When the sy stem is activated, the control
indicator in the AUTO button will
illuminate.
The sy stem switches itself off automatically
after a maximum of 60 minutes, depending
on the values that have been set and the
interior temperature.
For early dea ctiv ation, press the AUTO
button or select menu item Pa rking heater
and then menu item O n onc e ag ain.
164
Climate c ontrol
Parking heater
Setting
Start 1
Start 1
Start 1
Start 2
Start 2
Start 2
Start 3
Start 3
Start 3
On
On
Setting
Setting
Parking heater
Sw itching on a t a pr ogramm ed tim e
Three programm ed times can be stored for
switching on.
For safety reasons only one program med
time for switching on can b e activ e at any
one time. After the heating cycle has been
completed, the next req uired time for
switching on m ust be activa ted a fresh.
To store a programm ed time for activation,
select menu item Park ing heater from the
manual settings menu.
After m enu item Pa rking heat er the
current status will b e shown.
To set a time, select menu item S et ting.
Then select menu item Sta rt 1, Sta rt 2
or Start 3 a nd set the d esired time.
S elec t the required time for programmed
switching on.
When the sy stem is activated, the control
indicator in the AUTO button will
illuminate.
The sy stem switches itself off automatically
after a ma ximum of 60 m inutes depending
on the values that have been set and the
interior temperature.
To cancel air conditioning, press the A UTO
button.
To perform setting s, the Park ing heater
menu can be called up within 2 hours of
switching the ignition off by pressing on the
central rotary knob.
Climate control
165
The remote control has a ra nge of approx.
600 m. The range can be reduced by
ob structions between the sender and
receiver (e.g. walls) and by low power in the
battery.
The system switches itself off automatically
after a maximum of 60 minutes depend ing
on the values that hav e been set and the
interior temperature.
The auxiliary heating can be switched off
at any time by pressing the button §.
Deactivating a n activated sw itc h-on time:
Remote contr ol
The sy stem c an also be switched on and off
direc tly using the rem ote control:
On
=
O ff
=
Press button b, the control
indicator in the remote
control will illum ina te.
Press button §, the control
indicator in the remote
control will illum ina te
1. Press button §.
2. Dela y of at least 3 second s.
3. Press button § again.
If required , up to three add itional remote
control units c an be prog rammed. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
C ha nging the remote cont rol batt ery
Replace the battery imm ediately if the
range of the remote control sta rts to
become reduced.
Insert a pointed object into the opening in
the und erside of the remote control and flip
open the cover. Replace batteries
observing installation position. For battery
typ e – see page 307.
Whilst the control indicator is illum ina ted,
no further signal can be sent.
Alway s exchange a ll b atteries at the same
time.
When the system is activated, the control
indicator in the AUTO button will
illuminate.
Mak e sure that you dispose of old batteries
in accordance with env ironmental
protec tion regulations.
166
Climate c ontrol
Air outlet
Note
Do not c ov er the air outlets when storing
items in the lug gage compa rtm ent storage
compartments.
If the windsc reen is misted due to damp
weather, temporarily set the system as
desc ribed under "Wind ow dem isting and
defrosting" - see pa ges 147, 150, 159.
Pollen filter
The pollen filter cleans dust, soot, pollen
and spores from the air entering from
outside. The activ e ca rb on lay er 3
eliminates m ost odours and harmful
ambient g ases from the air.
Air intake
The air intakes in front of the wind screen on
the far right a nd left sides of the engine
compartment must be kept clear to a llow
air intak e. Rem ove any leav es, d irt or snow.
Have the pollen filter repla ced b y a
work shop at the rep la cement intervals
specified in the Service Book let.
The cooling system 3 operates most
effectively with the windows and sunroof 3
closed. If the p assenger compartment has
hea ted up c onsiderab ly a fter a long period
in direct sunlight, briefly open the windows
and sunroof 3 so that the hot air can
esca pe q uick ly .
Climate control
When cooling 3 (air c onditioning
compressor) is switched on, condensation
forms, which is ex pelled from the underside
of the v ehicle.
At lea st one air vent must b e open while
cooling 3 (air conditioning compressor) is
on in order to prevent the evaporator from
icing up due to lack of air movement.
Cooling switches off autom atically at low
outside tem peratures.
When the aux iliary hea ting/auxiliary
ventilation 3 is switched on, the Vauxhall
alarm system monitoring of the vehicle
interior 3 is deactivated.
Auxiliary heating 3 consumes fuel (a pprox.
0.3 litres per heating process on average).
When the aux iliary hea ting 3 is sw itched
on, there may briefly be some smoke and
noise.
The auxiliary heating 3 only switches itself
on at outside temperatures of less than
approx. 20 °C and a t coolant temperatures
of less than approx. 80 °C .
In order to im prov e heating power and
ensure that the engine operating
temperature is rea ched quickly , auxiliary
heating 3 also switches on automatically
when driving if the outside temp erature is
less than ap prox . 8 °C . This occurs
irresp ective of stored auxiliary heating
switch-on tim es. Aux iliary heating switches
itself off automatically when the engine is
switched off, while the combustion air fa n
continues running for ap prox . 2 minutes
(humming noise).
167
Maintenance
In order to ensure consistently good
operation, the air conditioning
compressor 3 m ust be switched on for
sev eral minutes once per m onth
irrespective of the w eather or time of yea r.
If the vehicle has an Electronic Climate
C ontrol system, this is done automa tic ally
during travel. O peration with cooling (air
conditioning compressor) is not possible
when outside temperatures are low . Ev ery
6 m onths, the auxiliary heating 3 should be
operated for a few m inutes a t a preset
temperature above 22 ° C.
O n faults, c ontact a workshop.
168
Drivin g and operatio n
Driving and operation
Easytronic
3
The automatic Easy tronic transmission
permits manual (Manua l mode) or
autom atic gearshifting (Automa tic m ode),
both with automa tic clutch control.
9 Warning
Ea sy tronic 3 .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Autom atic transm ission 3 .... .... .... ..... .
Driving hints .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Sav ing fuel, protecting the
environment . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Fuels, refuelling .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ca ta lytic converter, exhaust g ases... .
Drive Control System s .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Brake system ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Anti-lock Brake Sy stem (ABS u ).. ..... .
Wheels, ty res ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Roof racks 3 .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Towing eq uipm ent 3 .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Towing eq uipm ent with removable
coup ling ball bar 3 , Sa loon /
Hatch 3 . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Towing eq uipm ent with pivoting
coup ling ball bar 3 .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ca ra van/trailer tow ing . .... ..... .... .... ..... .
168
176
184
186
188
190
196
208
210
211
218
219
219
222
223
Disregard of these instructions m ay lead
to injuries or endanger life.
Transmi ssion di sp lay
S hows the mode or current gear.
Driving and o peration
169
It is not necessary to select the neutral
position before starting. If no gear is
engaged, the transmission automatically
shifts into neutral p osition (N) before
starting the engine. This can lead to a
slight delay w hen starting.
Sta rting t he engine
Dep ress footbrake when starting the
engine. The engine ca n only be started
with the footbrake depressed. "N" ap pears
on the transmission display. If the
footb rake is not depressed the control
indicator j illuminates in the instrum ent
cluster, and "N " flashes in the transmission
display - the eng ine cannot be started.
Also the vehic le cannot be sta rted if all
brake lights ha ve fa iled.
Easytronic op era tion v ia the selector lever
Alway s m ove the selec tor lever in the
app ropriate direc tion as far a s it w ill go.
Upon release, it automatically returns to
the centre position. Pay heed to the
gear/m od e indicator in the tra nsmission
display.
Mov e selector lev er t oward s N
N eutral.
170
Drivin g and operatio n
It is also p ossible to start-off without
depressing the footbrake if the a ccelerator
pedal is operated directly after mov ing
the selector lever. If there is no immediate
acceleration or the footbrake is not
depressed , no gear is engaged and " A"
flashes. After a few seconds, the display
reverts to "N". Repeat p reviously d escribed
starting procedure.
In Automa tic mode, selection of other
gears is automatic irrespectiv e of d riv ing
conditions.
Sta rting-off
Dep ress the footbra ke, release the
handbrake, mov e the selector lever to A,
+ or - . Easytronic is in Automatic mode and
first g ear is eng aged (second gear if the
Winter programme is active). "A" appears
on the transmission display.
The v ehicle begins to "creep" when the
footb rake is released .
Move sel ect or lever towa rds A
Switch between Automa tic and Manual
mode.
Manua l gearshifting is possib le in Manual
mode. The currently engaged gear
appea rs on the displa y.
If the engine speed is too low the Easytronic
will automatically shift to a lower g ear even
in Manua l mode. This prevents the engine
from stalling.
Mov e selector lev er t oward s + or + Shift to a higher gear
Shift to a lower gea r
If a hig her gear is selected when the
running speed is too low, or a lower gear
when the speed is too high, no shift is
effected. This p revents the engine from
running at too low or too hig h revs.
Gears can be sk ip ped by m ov ing the
selector lever repeatedly a t short intervals.
Driving and o peration
If the vehicle is in Automatic mode, on
movement of the selec tor lever to + or Ea sy tronic shifts to Manual m od e and
changes up or d ow n. The transmission
display shows the currently selected gear.
Mov e selector lever tow ards R
Reverse gear. Engage only when vehicle is
stationary.
Dep ress the footbra ke, release the
handbrake and m ov e the selector lever to
R. Rev erse gea r is eng aged. "R" ap pears on
the transmission display.
The v ehicle begins to "creep" when the
footb rake is released .
It is also p ossible to start-off in reverse
without depressing the footbrake if the
accelerator pedal is opera ted directly after
moving the selector lev er. If there is no
immed iate acceleration or the footbrake is
not depressed, no gear is enga ged and "R"
flashes. After a few seconds, the display
reverts to "N". Repeat p reviously d escribed
starting procedure.
171
Electronical ly cont rolled driv ing
pr og ramm es
z By m eans of delay ed gear cha nging
(higher engine speed s) following a cold
start, the opera ting temperature
programme in Autom atic mode quickly
and automatically brings the catalytic
conv erter to the tem perature required
for optim um polluta nt reduction.
z Adaptive programmes autom atically
adapt gearshifting in Automatic mode
to suit the driving conditions, such as if
the vehicle is towing a caravan/trailer,
ha s a high pa yload, or is being driven on
inclines.
z Winter programme: Press button T –
see next pa ge.
172
Drivin g and operatio n
If the v ehicle is switched to Manua l mode
while the Winter prog ra mme is active, the
Winter prog ra mme is interrupted. The
Winter programm e resumes upon return to
Automatic mode.
Winter progr amme T
In the event of diffic ulties starting-off on
slip pery road s, p ress button T ("A" and T
appear in the tra nsmission display).
Ea sy tronic switches to Automatic mode
and the vehicle sets off in second gea r.
The Winter p rogram me is switched off by:
z Pressing button T again.
z Turning off the ignition.
In order to protect the Easytronic the
Winter programme autom atically switches
itself off at extremely high clutch
tem peratures.
Kick down
Depress accelerator past resistance point:
transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on engine speed. Full engine
power is available for acceleration.
During k ickdown no ma nual gearshifting is
possible.
Driving and o peration
When the engine speed a pproaches its
upper limit, the transmission shifts to a
higher gear during kick down even in
Manual mode.
Without kick down this automatic shift is
not effec ted in Ma nual m ode.
Eng ine braki ng
Autom atic mode:
When driv ing downhill, Easytronic d oes not
shift into higher gears until a fairly high
engine sp eed has been reac hed. When
braking, Easytronic shifts down in good
time.
Manual mode:
To utilise the engine braking effect, select a
lower gear in g ood time w hen driving
downhill.
173
"Rock ing" t he v ehic le
If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole,
move the selector lever between R and A
(or + or -) in a repeat pattern while app ly ing
lig ht p ressure to the accelerator pedal. Do
not rac e the engine and avoid sudden
acceleration.
This applies only to the exceptional
circum stances mentioned a bove.
Ma noeuvr ing the vehicle
To ma noeuv re the vehicle back and forth
during attempts to park or in ga ra ge
entrances the creeping m ov ement can be
utilised by releasing the footb ra ke.
N ever actuate accelerator and brake
pedals sim ultaneously.
To prevent d amage, Easy tronic
disengag es the " creep function" a t
extrem ely high a utomatic clutch
temperatures.
174
Drivin g and operatio n
Stop ping t he v ehic le
In Automatic or Manual m od e, when the
vehic le has stopp ed first gear (with Winter
mode enga ged, second gear) is engaged
automatically and the clutch relea sed. In R
rev erse remains engaged.
When the engine is running, a gear is
enga ged and the footbrake is not
depressed, a wa rning buzzer sounds w hen
the d riv er’s door is opened and the gea r
shown in the transmission d isplay flashes
at a rapid rate. If the hand brake is not
applied, the vehicle creeps. Move the
selector lever to N a nd apply the
handbrake.
When stop ping on gradients, app ly the
handbrake or depress the brake pedal. To
prevent overheating of the clutch, do not
increase engine speed to ensure smooth
idling when in gear.
In order to prev ent dama ge to the
Ea sy tronic the clutc h is automatically
enga ged at ex tremely high clutch
tem peratures.
Switch off eng ine if stop ping for a lengthy
period, e. g. in traffic jams or at level
crossings.
Vehicle storag e
Before leaving the vehicle:
z Apply hand brake,
z Remove ignition key.
The most recently engaged gear (ind icator
in transmission display) remains engaged.
With N , no gea r is engaged.
When the ignition is switched off the
Easytronic no longer responds to
movem ent of the selector lev er.
Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the battery
may become discharged if the vehicle is
parked for long periods.
If the handbrak e has not been ap plied, the
control indicator R flashes for a few
second s a fter the ignition is switched off.
With the engine off a nd the handbrak e not
applied, when the driver’s door is opened a
warning buzzer sounds and the control
indica tor R flashes; switch on ignition,
engage gear, switch off ignition and apply
ha ndb ra ke.
Fault
C ontrol indicator A illuminates in the
event of a fa ult in the Easytronic sy stem. In
the event of serious faults, "F" a lso appears
on the transmission display.
It is possib le to continue driving if only
control ind icator A illuminates. M anual
mode can then no longer be selected.
If " F" also appea rs on the tra nsmission
display, continued driving is not possible.
Hav e the cause of the fault elim ina ted by a
workshop. The self-d ia gnosis integrated
into the system allows rapid fault
identification.
Driving and o peration
If the cause of the power failure is not a
discharged battery , conta ct a workshop. If
the vehicle m ust be rem ov ed from flowing
tra ffic, relea se the c lutch as follows:
1. Apply handbrak e and switch off ignition.
2. O pening and p ropp ing up the bonnet see page 228.
3. C lean Easy tronic around the cap
(see Fig. 17925 J) so that no d irt c an get
into the opening when the cap is
rem oved.
Interrup tion of power suppl y
The c lutch is not disengaged if the vehicle
battery is discharged and a gear has been
selected. The vehicle ca nnot move.
If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using
jump leads – see pag e 230.
4. Rotate cap to slacken and remove by
lifting upwards – see illustration.
5. Turn the a djusting screw clockwise using
a flat-head screwdriver (v ehicle tools 3 –
see page 238) until clear resistance can
be felt. The clutch has now been
disengaged.
Do not turn beyond the resista nce, since
this can damag e the Easytronic.
175
6. Fit cleaned cap ag ain. The cap must be
in full contact w ith the housing.
Towing the vehic le and starting the eng ine
is not perm itted when the clutch has been
released in this way , although the vehicle
can b e m ov ed a short distance.
C ontact a workshop immediately.
176
Drivin g and operatio n
Automatic transmission
3
The a utomatic tra nsmission allows
automatic shifting (Autom atic mode) or
manual shifting (Ma nua l mode) to tak e
place.
The engine ca n only be started with the
selector lever in P or N. When starting in N,
depress the footbrake or apply the
handbrake. After the engine has started ,
depress the footbrake before engaging a
gear. Do not accelerate while selecting a
gear. O nc e a gear is engaged and the
footb rake is released, the vehicle "creeps".
Never depress the footbrak e and the
accelerator pedal simultaneously . The
selected g ear is shown in the transmission
display - see end column.
9 Warning
Disregard of these instructions m ay lead
to injuries or endanger life.
Selecting D puts the transmission in
Automatic mode.
If the selec tor lever is m oved to the left from
the D position, Manual mode is activated .
Gear changes can then be ma de manually
by moving the selec tor lever towards + or -.
Transmi ssion di sp lay
Display of selector lev er setting, g ear and
mode.
P
Pa rk position
R
Reverse gear
N
Neutral
D
Automatic mode
1-6
Manua l mode showing the gear
selected
Driving and o peration
177
The selector lever can only be mov ed out of
position P or N w ith the ig nition switched on
and the footbrake depressed (selector
lever lock). In selector lev er position N the
selector lever lock is activa ted after a delay
and only if the vehicle is stationary.
In positions P or N, the control indicator j
illuminates red in the selector lever
indica tor, the selector lever is blocked see Fig. S 12547.
To engage P or R , press button on selector
lever.
Selector l ev er setti ng s P, R, N and D
(Automat ic mod e)
P
Park position, front wheels blocked.
O nly select with vehicle sta tionary
and handbrake app lied. " P" appears
on the transmission display.
The engine can only b e started with lever in
position P or N . When position N is selected,
depress footbrak e or ap ply handbrake
before starting.
R
Reverse gear. Only select when
vehic le is stationary . "R" appears on
the transmission display.
N
Neutra l or idling position. " N"
appears on the transm ission display .
D
Drive position for norma l driving in 1st
to highest gear. "D" appears on the
transm ission display .
If the transmission fluid tempera ture is less
than -25 °C, the selector lever cannot be
mov ed until the fluid tempera ture reac hes
-25 °C with the engine running (P or N
flashes in the transmission disp la y for as
long as the selector lever is locked).
Do not accelerate during the selection
procedure.
178
Drivin g and operatio n
If the engine speed is too slow, the
tra nsmission a utomatica lly shifts to a lower
gear, but not if the gear was selected
below a certain speed.
If a higher gear is selected below a certain
speed a downshift does not ta ke p lace.
When engine speed is high, there is no
autom atic shift to a higher gea r.
For reasons of safety, k ickdown also
functions in Manual mode – see page 180.
The selected g ear is shown in the
tra nsmission display – see page 176.
Acti veSelect (Manual m ode)
Shift the selector lev er from D first to the left
and then forwards or ba ckwards.
+
-
Shift to a higher g ear
Shift to a lower gear
If a higher gear is selected at too low a
speed or a lower gear selected at too high
a speed, there is no change. This avoids
rev s that a re too low or too high.
Electronical ly cont rolled driv ing
pr og ramm es
z With adaptive prog ra mmes, shifting into
other gears is handled automatically
based on the driving style, e. g.:
–
Economical driving sty le: at slow er
engine speeds.
–
Adaptation to specia l driving
conditions still takes pla ce, such as:
driving up a nd down hills, tow ing a
carav an/trailer, and with a heavy
load.
Driving and o peration
z Automatic neutra l shift function
automa tic ally sets the transm ission to N
to reduce fuel consumption, e.g. at
traffic lights.
The automatic neutral shift function is
activated when the following occurs
simultaneously:
–
The selector lever is in Autom atic or
Manual mode.
–
The footbrake is depressed.
–
The v ehicle is stationa ry .
–
The ac celera tor p edal is not
actuated.
–
The transmission fluid temperature
is above 0 °C.
As soon as the footbrake is released and
the accelerator pedal is depressed, the
vehicle starts off in the usua l manner.
179
z After a cold start, the operating
temperature programme ensures that
the correct gear (inc reased engine
speed) is selected to quickly bring the
cataly tic converter to the temperature
req uired for optimum pollutant
red uc tion.
z If the Continuous Da mping Control is set
to SPORT mode 3, the shift times are
reduced and gear changes occ ur a t
hig her engine sp eeds (not when cruise
control is active). The control indicator 1
also illuminates in the transmission
displa y - see pag e 176.
Continuous Damping C ontrol, S PO RT
mode 3 - see pag e 198.
z Winter programme: Press button T.
Control indica tor T appears on the
tra nsmission display - see next page and
page 176.
180
Drivin g and operatio n
To deactiv ate
The Winter programme is switched off by :
z pressing button T again,
z switching off the ignition,
z switching to Manua l mode.
To protect aga inst dam age, the startingoff aid autom atically cuts out at very high
tra nsmission fluid tem peratures.
Winter progr amme T
Press b utton T if you are having problems
starting-off on a slippery road surfac e.
To activate
The Winter programme can be switched in
Autom atic mode (T illuminates in the
transm ission display - see page 176). The
vehic le shifts to 4th gea r.
Kick down
Depress accelerator past resistance point:
transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on engine speed. Full engine
power is available for acceleration.
For safety reasons, k ickdown is available in
both Automatic mode and M anual mode.
Driving and o peration
Eng ine braki ng
The a utomatic tra nsmission automatically
selects the driving programm e w ith
optimal engine brak ing effect.
As needed, lower gears can also be
selected in M anual mode to increase
engine braking effect. 1st gear has the
greatest braking effect.
181
"Rock ing" t he v ehic le
If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole,
move the selector lever from D to R in a
repeat pattern w hile sim ultaneously
applying light pressure to the accelerator
pedal. Do not race the engine and av oid
sudden acceleration.
This applies only to the exceptional
circum stances mentioned a bove.
Ma noeuvr ing the vehicle
To ma noeuv re the vehicle back and forth
during attempts to park or in ga ra ge
entrances, the v ehicle’ s creeping
mov ement can be utilised by releasing the
footbrake.
N ever actuate accelerator and brake
pedals sim ultaneously.
182
Drivin g and operatio n
Stop ping t he v ehic le
The selector lever can be left in the chosen
gear with the engine running.
When stop ping on gradients apply
handbrake or depress brake peda l. To
prevent overheating of the transmission,
do not increase engine revolutions to
ensure smooth idling while standing if a
gear has been selected.
Switch off eng ine if stop ping for a lengthy
period, e. g. in traffic jams or at level
crossings.
Before leav ing the vehicle, apply
handbrake, then p la ce selector lev er in
position P and remove ignition key .
The ignition key can only be removed when
the selector lever is in position P.
If the selector lever is not in the P position
when the ig nition is sw itched off, control
indica tor j in the selec tor lever ind icator
strip flashes – see pa ge 177, Fig. S 12547.
Shift the selector lever to P.
If the ignition key is not removed, the
battery m ay be discharged if the vehicle is
then left to stand for a lengthy period of
tim e.
Fault
In the ev ent of a fault in the automa tic
transmission, control indica tor A
illuminates. The transmission no longer
shifts automatically. Driving can be
continued.
In Manual mode, 2nd gear and the highest
gear ca n be engag ed. For some faults, only
the highest gear is av ailable.
O nly the highest gear is ava ila ble in D in
Automatic mode.
Driving and o peration
183
Illumination of control indicator A can
also indicate a fault in the engine
electronic s – see page 192.
For diesel engines 1) Z 19 DTL, Z 19 DT,
Z 19 DTH illum ina tion of control
indicator A c ould a lso indicate that the
diesel fuel filter must be d ra ined of water see page 274.
Hav e the cause of the fault elim inated by a
workshop.
Interruption of p ower supply
If the v ehicle b attery is flat, the selector
lever cannot be moved out of position P
or N.
If the ba ttery is flat, start the v ehicle using
jump lead s – see page 230.
If the cause is not a discharged battery,
unlock selector lev er:
1. Apply hand brake.
2. Remove the ashtray – see page 94.
3. Pull out ashtray socket upwards.
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ge 28 4, 285.
4. Press the yellow catch downwards w ith a
screwdriver and move the selector lever
out of P.
5. Refit ashtra y socket in centre console
and latch into position.
6. Refit ashtra y.
S elec ting P or N again effects lock ing
aga in. Have the c ause of the interruption
of power supp ly rectified by a workshop .
184
Drivin g and operatio n
Driving hints
The first 600 mil es (1000 k m)
Drive your vehicle at v arious speeds. Do
not use full throttle. Never allow the eng ine
to labour at low revs.
Make good use of all gea rs. Depress the
accelerator pedal a maximum of around
three quarters of the ava ila ble ped al travel
in all gears.
Do not drive faster than three quarters of
max imum speed.
Do not brake unnecessarily hard for the
first 125 miles (200 km ).
Never coa st with engine not running
Many units will not function in this situation
(e. g. brak e serv o unit, elec tro-hydraulic
power steering). Driving in this manner is a
danger to yourself and others.
Brak e servo unit
When the engine is not running, the brake
servo unit is no longer effective once the
footb rake has been depressed onc e or
twice. Braking effect is not reduced, b ut
significantly greater force is required for
braking.
Electro-hydrauli c power assisted st eering
If the power-assisted steering fails when
being towed with the engine switched off,
the vehicle can still be steered, but
considera bly more forc e is req uired.
Dr iving in mountainous terrai n or with a
carav an/trailer
The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its
cooling p ow er is therefore independent of
the engine speed.
Since a considerable amount of heat is
genera ted at high engine speeds and less
at slower speeds, do not shift d ow n when
climbing hills whilst the v ehicle is still coping
with the gradient in the higher g ear.
Diesel engines: O n rising gradients of 10%
or more, do not drive fa ster tha n 20 mph
(30 km/h) in 1st gear or 30 mph (50 k m/h)
in 2nd g ear; with automa tic
tra nsmission 3, do not ex ceed 25 mph
(40 km/h) in position 1.
Dr iving with a roof load
Do not exceed the permissible roof load –
see p ages 218, 293. For reasons of safety,
distribute the load evenly and secure it
prop erly w ith retaining straps. Adjust the
tyre pressure to the load conditions. Do not
drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h). Check
and retighten the strap s frequently.
Observ e country-specific regula tions.
Sw itching off the engi ne
When y ou switch off, fans in the eng ine
compa rtm ent may continue running for a
time to cool the engine.
If the engine temperature is very high, e.g.
after driving in mountainous terrain: allow
the engine to id le for approx im ately two
minutes in order to prevent heat
acc um ulation.
Vehicles with turbocharged engine 3
After running at high eng ine speeds or high
eng ine loads, operate the engine briefly
at a low load or run in neutral for approx.
30 seconds before switching off in order
to protec t the turbocharger.
Sa ve energy – m ore miles / kilom et res
Plea se observe the running-in hints on the
previous pa ge a nd the tips for energy
saving on the following pag es.
Good, technically correc t and ec onomical
driving ensures m aximum d urab ility and
performa nc e for your vehicle.
Driving and o peration
O verrun
The fuel supply is autom atically shut off
during overrun, e.g. when the vehicle is
being driven down long gradients or when
braking. To enable the overrun cut-off to
take effect, do not acc elerate during
overrun and, if in manual transm ission
mode, do not depress clutch ped al. To
prevent damage to the catalytic converter,
overrun cut-off is temporarily d eactiva ted
when the catalytic conv erter temperature
is high.
Vehicles with turbocharged engine 3
Flow -g enerated noises may be aud ible if
the a ccelerator is released quickly on
account of airflow in the turbocharger.
Eng ine sp eed
Drive in a low engine speed range for each
gear as much as possible.
Warmi ng up
Allow the engine to warm up w hilst driv ing .
Do not w arm it up by letting it run at idling
speed. Do not app ly full throttle until the
engine has reached operating
tem perature.
After a cold sta rt, the automatic
transm ission 3 or Easytronic 3 in
Autom atic mode shifts into higher gears at
higher rpm . This a llows the catalytic
converter to quickly reach the temperature
req uired for optimum pollutant reduction.
Correct g ear selection
Tra nsmission in neutral and without
revving in the lower gears. S top-a nd -g o
tra ffic a nd driving at a speed too hig h for
the selected g ear or transmission ratio
increases wear and fuel consum ption.
Change dow n
When decreasing speed, shift down into
the next lowest gear. Do not slip the clutch
with a high-revving engine. This is
especially important when hill climb ing.
Clutch op era tion
Alw ays dep ress the clutch ped al hard to
the floor to prev ent shifting difficulties and
tra nsmission dam age.
When driving do not use the pedal as a
footrest; this will cause substantial clutch
wear.
185
C ool ing fan
The cooling fan is controlled v ia a
therm oswitch and therefore only runs if
nec essary .
The cooling fan a utomatica lly switches on
when the diesel particle filter 3 is being
cleaned depending on the eng ine.
Pedals
Do not place any ob jects in the footwell
which could slip under the ped als and
inhibit the pedal trav el.
To ensure the pedal travel is uninhibited,
there must be no mats in the area of the
pedals.
Bat tery ca re
When driving slowly or when the v ehicle is
stationary , e.g. in slow urban traffic, stopand-go traffic or traffic jams, turn off all
unnecessary electrical load s w here
possible (e. g. heated rear window, heated
seats 3 ).
Depress clutch pedal when sta rting in order
to relieve the strain on the starter and the
battery.
186
Drivin g and operatio n
Saving fuel, protecting th e
environment
Trend-set ting technology
In the dev elopment and manufacture of
your vehicle, environment-friendly and in
the m ain recy clable materials were used.
The p roduction method s used to make
your vehicle are likewise env ironmentally compatible.
Recycling of production wastes keeps the
circulation of material closed. Reduction of
energy a nd water requirements a lso help s
to conserve natural resources.
A highly adv anced design mea ns that your
vehic le can be easily disassembled at the
end of its working life, and the individual
materials separated for subsequent re-use.
Materia ls such as asbestos and cadmium
are not used . The refrigerant in the air
conditioning system 3 is C FC -free.
New painting techniques employ water as
a solvent.
End-of-li fe v ehi cle rec overy
For detailed information on Va ux ha ll’ s
on-going comm itment to achieving an
environmentally susta inab le future,
including; design for recycling, take back of
End-of-Life Vehicle’s (ELVs) and the
recycling of ELVs, view
www.va ux ha ll. co.uk/recycling for details.
Warm ing up
z Full throttle and w arming up at idle
speed increase w ear, fuel consumption,
ex haust em ission, the am ount of
pollutant in the exhaust and the am ount
of noise.
Energy and environm ent-c onsci ous
drivi ng
z High noise levels and exhaust em issions
are often a result of driving w ithout due
attention to saving energy and
protecting the environment.
Uniform speed
z Hectic driving significantly increases fuel
consumption, the ex haust emissions, the
proportion of pollutant in the exhaust
gas and the noise level.
z Y ou should therefore drive with energy in
mind "more m iles / k ilom etres – less fuel".
Reduce the noise level and exhaust
emissions b y adopting an environmentconsc ious driving style. This is ex tremely
worthwhile and im proves the quality of
life.
Fuel consum ption d epend s to a great
extent on your own personal d riv ing
style. The following hints are intended to
help you consume fuel at a rate that is as
close as possible to the specified levels –
see page 287.
C heck y our v ehicle’ s fuel consumption
every time you refuel. This facilitates
early detection of any irregula rities
causing increased fuel consumption.
z Driv e off as soon as possible a fter
starting.
z Do not accelerate a nd brake
unnecessarily . Drive at uniform speed,
watching the road.
Avoid freq uent starting-off and stopping
e.g . at traffic lights, in short distance
tra ffic and in queues of traffic by m eans
of clever planning . Select road s w ith
good traffic flow .
I dling
z The eng ine also consumes fuel when
idling .
z If you have to wait for more than one
minute, it is worthwhile switching off the
engine. Fiv e m inutes of idling
corresponds to ap prox imately 0.6 miles
(1 k m) of driving.
Driving and o peration
O verrun
z The fuel supply is automatically shut off
during ov errun, e. g. when the vehicle is
being driven down long gradients or
when braking – see page 185.
z To enable the overrun cut-off to come
into action and sav e fuel, do not
accelerate or d epress clutch pedal
during ov errun.
Corr ect gear sel ec tion
z High revs increase engine w ear and fuel
consumption.
z Do not race your engine. Avoid d riv ing at
high engine speeds.
Making use of the tachom eter helps to
save fuel. Drive in a low engine speed
ra nge for each gear as much a s possible
with uniform engine speeds. Drive as
often as possible in top gear, select the
next higher gear a s soon as possible,
and only chang e down when the engine
is no longer running perfectly smoothly .
High speed
z The higher the speed , the higher the
consumption and the noise level. At top
speed, you consume a great deal of fuel
and produce excessive noise and
exhaust em issions.
z Slightly relea sing the accelerator ped al
results in distinct fuel savings with no
major loss of speed.
Drive at no more tha n around three
quarters of max imum speed and you will
use up to 50% less fuel, without losing a
great deal of time.
Tyre pressure
z Inadequate ty re p ressure, leading to
higher road resistance, costs m oney in
two wa ys: for more fuel and increased
tyre wear.
z Regular checks (every 14 d ays) pay off.
Electri cal loa ds
z The power consum ption of electrical
equip ment increa ses fuel consumption.
z Sw itch off all aux iliary electrical loads
(e. g. air c onditioning 3, heated rear
window) when not needed.
Roof rack s, sk i-holders
z Due to air resistance, a roof load
can increase fuel consum ption by
approx . 3.5 gal./1000 miles (1 l/100km ).
z Remove them if they are not being used.
187
Repai r and m aintenance
z Improper repairs or adjustm ent and
maintenance work can increase fuel
consumption. Do not carry out w ork on
the eng ine yourself.
You may out of ignorance infringe
environmental law s b y not disposing of
materials properly.
Appropriate parts might not b e recycled.
Contact with some of the materia ls
inv olv ed may p ose a hea lth haz ard.
z We recom mend that repair and
maintenance be entrusted to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Extr em e d riving conditions
z Going up steep slopes, cornering, driving
on poor road s a nd winter driving a ll
increase fuel consumption.
Fuel consumption increa ses dramatically
in urba n tra ffic a nd at winter
temperatures, especially on short trip s
when the engine operating tempera ture
is not reached.
z Follow the hints given above to keep
consumption to a m inimum under suc h
cond itions.
188
Drivin g and operatio n
Fuels, refu elling
Fuel c onsum ption
Fuel consump tion is determined und er
specific driv ing cond itions – see page 287.
Special equipment increases the weight of
the v ehicle. As a result, they can increase
fuel consump tion and reduce the specified
max imum speed.
For the first few thousand m iles /
kilometres, friction between the engine and
transm ission com ponents is higher. This
increases fuel consumption.
Fuel for petrol engines
Normal c om mercial high-quality fuels with
a m aximum ethanol content of 5% in
accordance with DIN EN 228 are suitable
(for catalytic converter see pag e 190, for
octane numbers - see pages 284, 285). The
quality thereof has considerable effect on
the p erformance, running and serv ice life
of the engine. The additives mix ed with the
fuel are extremely im portant. For this
rea son you must only refuel with highquality fuels containing additives.
Fuels with ethanol c ontent greater than 5%
do not comply with DIN EN 228 and must
not be used unless the vehicle has been
specifically dev eloped and app rov ed for
these fuels.
Fuel with too low an octane number can
cause pinking. Vauxhall cannot be held
lia ble for resulting dama ge.
Petrol with a higher octane number can
always be used.
The use of 91 octane fuel is not permitted
in v ehicles with the Z 22 YH1 ) engine or the
Vectra VXR.
The ignition tim ing adjusts automatically
to the grade of fuel used (octane
numb er) – see pa ges 284, 285.
Use of petrol w ith a n oc ta ne rating of 95
will ensure economica l driving.
Fuel with 95 RO N w ill result in less power
and torque with the Vectra VXR.
Fuel for di esel engines
Diesel engines must be operated only on
commerc ia lly available diesel fuel meeting
the specifications of DIN EN 590.
Since J anuary 2004, some oil companies
ha ve m ixed their diesel fuel with up to 5%
Bio fuel (FAME = Fatty Acid Methy l Esters)
lik e RM E (Rape-Oil Methyl Ester). This is in
accordance with the current DIN EN 590
and does not harm the fuel/injec tion
sy stem. The characteristic s of a diesel fuel
mixed up with 5% Bio fuel (FAME) do not
differ from conv entional d iesel fuel and do
not influence the vehicle’s driveability.
1)
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ge 284, 285 .
I mporta nt: Diesel fuel m ixed with 5% FAM E
acc ording to DI N EN 590 m ust not be
confused with 100% Bio Diesel, which is not
to be used in Vauxhall eng ines.
The flow and filterability of diesel fuel a re
temperature-dependent.
Diesel fuels w ith improved low temp erature
properties are therefore a vailable on the
ma rk et during the winter months. Make
sure that y ou fill the tank with winter fuel
before the start of the cold weather
season.
Additives can be used with diesel fuels with
winter prop erties that are guaranteed by
the manufa cturer and when using diesel
fuel filters that are heated depending on
the outside temperature.
Diesel fuels must not be diluted with fuels
that are intended for petrol eng ines.
Fuel filler cap
When replacing the fuel filler cap, be sure
to use a genuine fuel filler cap for y our
model to ensure full functionality. Dieseleng ined vehicles have special fuel filler
cap s.
Driving and o peration
189
9 Warning
Fuel is flammab le and explosive. When
handling fuel or in the immediate vicinity,
avoid na ked fla mes or sparks. Do not
smoke. This a lso app lies where the
presenc e of fuel is revea led b y its
characteristic smell. If fuel odours occur in
the vehicle, have a workshop elim inate
the fault im mediately.
Fuel filler neck at right rear side of vehicle.
The tank flap is locked together with the
doors – see page 30.
Refuel ling
9 Warning
Care must b e tak en when ha ndling fuel.
Before refuelling, turn off engine and also
shut off external heaters with combustion
cha mbers (identified by stickers on tank
flap ). Switch off mobile phones.
The tank disp la y updates more quickly if
the ig nition is switched off during
refuelling.
Open the tank flap .
Unscrew the fuel filler cap, remove and
suspend from the tank flap.
The fuel tank has a limiting sy stem which
prevents ov erfilling of the tank.
C orrect filling depends to a large extent on
proper operation of the fuel disp ensing
pump:
1. Fully insert the pump nozz le and switch it
on.
2. After a n automatic shut-off, the nominal
capacity of the fuel tank is reached by
mea ns of two m etered top-ups. Insert
fuel dispensing p um p as fa r as it w ill g o.
To close, position the fuel filler cap a nd
rotate past the resistanc e until the ca p
audibly clicks over the reta iner.
C lose fuel tank flap.
Wipe off a ny ov erflowing fuel immediately .
190
Drivin g and operatio n
Damage to the ca talytic converter or the
vehicle may result if the follow ing points
are not observed:
z O n ignition faults, uneven running after
cold start, a clear d rop-off in eng ine
power or other unusual opera ting
symptoms which could indica te a fault in
the ig nition system, contac t a workshop
immediately. C ontinue driving if
necessary for a short time at low speed
and low revs.
Catalytic converter, exhaust
gases
Ca talytic conv er ter for petrol engines
Leaded fuel will damage the catalytic
converter and parts of the elec tronic
system, rendering them inoperative.
Use of high-quality fuels other than those
specified on page 188 (e. g. LRP 1) ) c ould
dam age the catalytic conv erter.
1)
LRP = L ea d Replacement P etrol.
Irregular engine running and a loss of
eng ine power when the Electronic
Stab ility Program me (ESP® Pl us 3) comes
into action are the result of operating
conditions and are therefore of no
significance – see p age 196.
z If unb urned fuel enters the cataly tic
conv erter, this may result in overheating
and irreparable damage to the c atalytic
conv erter.
You should therefore av oid
unnecessarily long use of the starter
when starting-off, running the tank d ry
(an irregular fuel supply w ill lead to
overhea ting) and starting the engine by
pushing or towing.
Driving and o peration
z If the control ind icator Z for exhaust
gases fla shes, slow down until the
flashing stops and the control indica tor
illuminates. Contact a w orkshop for
assistance immediately . C ontrol
indica tor Z for exhaust gases –
see pa ge 192.
191
Cata lyti c converter for d iesel engines
Damage to the ca talytic converter or the
vehicle may result if the follow ing points
are not observed:
z O n uneven running , a c lear drop-off in
eng ine power or other unusual operating
symptoms, c ontact a workshop
immediately. C ontinue driving if
necessary for a short time at low speed
and low revs.
Irregular engine running and a loss of
eng ine power when the Electronic
Stab ility Program me (ESP® Pl us 3) comes
into action are the result of operating
conditions and are therefore of no
significance – see p age 196.
C ont rolling exhaust em ission
S om e of the damaging substances
in the exhaust such a s ca rb on
monoxide (CO ), hydrocarbons (HC)
and nitrous ox ides (NO x) are reduced
to a minim um by making structural
changes – mainly in the injection sy stem
and the ignition system in conjunction
with the catalytic converter.
192
Drivin g and operatio n
Flashing with the engine running indicates
a fault which could lead to catalytic
conv erter damage. Y ou may c ontinue
driving without d amage if you bac k off
until flashing stops and the control
indica tor illuminates. Contact a w orkshop
immed iately.
Control indicator Z for ex haust
Illuminates when the ignition is switched on
and during the start attemp t. Ex tinguishes
shortly after the engine starts running.
Illuminated with the eng ine running
indicates a fa ult in the ex haust gas
cleaning system . The permitted em issions
may be ex ceeded . Contact a workshop
immediately .
C ontrol indicator A for engine elec tronics
Illuminates for a few seconds after the
ignition is switched on.
If it illuminates when the eng ine is running,
there is a fault in engine or transmission
electronics. The electronic sy stem switches
to an emergency running p rogram me. Fuel
consum ption m ay be increa sed and the
driveability of the vehicle m ay be impaired.
Driving and o peration
In some c ases, faults can be eliminated by
switching off the engine and restarting . If
the c ontrol indicator illuminates again
when the engine is running, contact a
workshop to eliminate the ca use of the
fault.
If it illuminates briefly, but does not recur, it
is of no significance.
If A illuminates, this may also mean water
in the diesel fuel filter in the engines 1)
Z 19 DTL, Z 19 DT and Z 19 DTH. Where
necessary, have the fuel filter insp ected by
a workshop for any residual water.
If it flashes after the ignition is switched on,
there is a fa ult in the immobiliser system.
The engine cannot be started.
See pag e 27.
193
Exhaust g ases
9 Warnin g
Engine exhaust gases contain poisonous
carbon monoxide, w hich is colourless and
odourless and c ould b e fatal if inhaled.
If ex haust gases p enetrate the v ehicle
interior, open a window and contact a
workshop.
Avoid driving with an open luggage
compartment. Otherw ise, exhaust g ases
could penetra te the interior.
During the first drive sm ok e m ay develop
because of wax and oil ev aporating on the
exhaust system . Park the vehicle in the
open for a while a fter the first drive and
av oid inhaling the fum es.
1)
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ge 284, 285 .
194
Drivin g and operatio n
Diesel p artic le fi lter 3
The d iesel pa rticle filter system removes
polluting soot particles out of the engine
exhaust ga ses. The system includes a selfcleaning function tha t operates
automatically whilst driving. The filter is
cleaned by burning the trapped soot
particles at a high temperature. There ma y
be an increase in fuel consumption,
exhaust smell, and engine cooling fan
opera tion 3 during the self-clea ning
opera tion.
The self-c leaning function will
automatically operate whilst d riv ing after
the engine has reached its normal
operating temperature. The control
indicator ! will continue to flash until the
self-cleaning op eration is complete. This
ma y take up to 20 minutes of driving. The
time will be shorter at higher v ehicle
speeds. If the vehicle is not moving for
more than a few minutes, then the selfcleaning function will not operate.
O peration will continue when driving
resumes.
The self-cleaning function cannot operate
autom atic ally during certa in driv ing
situations where the engine does not rea ch
its normal operating tem perature. An
exa mple of this would be driving only short
distances in cold weather. If the filter needs
cleaning and recent d riv ing situations did
not a llow the func tion to automatically
op erate, then the control indicator ! will
flash. If this occurs, then you may continue
to drive the vehic le normally. The vehicle
will not be d amaged and does not require
service.
Driving and o peration
We recommend that you do not turn the
ignition off until the self-cleaning opera tion
is comp lete. If you m ust turn the ig nition off
before the operation is com plete, then the
opera tion will a utomatica lly resume when
driving the next tim e and after the engine
has reached its norm al operating
tem perature.
The control indica tor ! extinguishes as
soon as the self-cleaning operation is
complete.
195
Ma intena nce
Hav e a ll maintenance work carried out at
the intervals sp ecified. We recommend
that you entrust this w ork to y our Vauxhall
Authorised Repa irer, who has proper
equipment and tra ined personnel
av ailable. Electronic testing systems permit
rapid diagnosis and remedy of faults. This
way you can b e certain that all
components of the vehicle’s electrica l,
injection and ignition systems operate
correc tly , that your vehicle has a low level
of pollutant emission and that the catalytic
converter system will ha ve a long service
life.
Y ou are thereby making an im portant
contribution towards keeping the air clean
and comp lia nce with em issions legislation.
C hecking and adjustment of the fuelinjection and ignition systems is part of the
scope of inspec tion. For this reason you
should hav e a ll maintenance work carried
out a t the intervals specified in your Serv ice
Booklet.
196
Drivin g and operatio n
Drive Control Systems
Interac tive Driv ing System (IDS+) 3
The IDS + combines the sensors a nd control
units of the Electronic S tability Prog ramme
(ES P®P lu s ), the Anti-lock Brake Sy stem
(ABS) and C ontinuous Da mping Control
(CDC ). This provides both excellent driv ing
dynam ics and greater safety.
Electronic Stab ility Program me
(ESP® Pl us ) 3
ESP® P lu s im proves driving stability when
necessary in any driving situation
regardless of the ty pe of road surface or
tyre g rip . It also prevents the d riv e wheels
from spinning.
The system m onitors vehicle movements.
As soon as the vehicle starts to swerve
(understeers/oversteers) engine output is
reduced (the sound of the engine cha ng es)
and individual wheels are specifically
braked . This considerab ly improves the
driving stability of the vehicle on snow and
ice and on wet or slippery road surfa ces.
ESP® Pl us is ready for operation as soon as
the ignition is switched on and c ontrol
indicator v ex ting uishes.
C ontrol indicator v fla shes when ES P®P lu s
is in action.
The vehicle is now in a critical situa tion;
ESP® Pl us allows you to keep control of the
vehicle a nd reminds you to m atch your
speed to the road conditions.
9 Warnin g
Do not let this special safety feature
tempt you into ta king risk s w hen driving.
Tra ffic safety can only b e ac hieved by
adopting a responsible d riv ing sty le.
Driving and o peration
197
Illum inates whilst driving:
The system is switched off or a fault has
oc curred. The vehicle can continue to be
driven. However, driv ing stability may
worsen depending on the nature of the
road surface.
Switch on ES P®P lu s again, or hav e the
cause of the fault rectified by a workshop.
The system’s integ ra ted self-diagnostics
allow s faults to be quickly remedied.
Control indicator v
Illuminates for a few seconds when the
ignition is switched on. The system is now
rea dy for opera tion.
Flashing during driving:
This shows the system has com e into
action. The engine output may be reduced
(the sound of the engine cha nges) a nd the
vehic le ma y be braked automatically to a
small degree.
S witc hing off 3
ESP® Pl us can b e deactivated by pressing
button v 3.
Deactivation is only possible up to a speed
of 40 mph (60 k m/h) and is indicated by
illumination of control indicator v in the
instrument cluster.
Pressing the v button again or turning on
the ignition switches ES P®P lu s on again.
198
Drivin g and operatio n
Cont inuous Dam ping C ontrol 3 (CDC )
Normal mode
CDC automatically adapts vehicle
dam ping to the current driv ing situation
and road conditions.
The sy stem continually monitors w heel and
vehic le mov ements and immediately
modifies the damping of each shock
absorber. Chassis calibration is optimally
adap ted to the driving situation and road
conditions.
Continuous Damping Control is alwa ys in
normal mode with the ig nition is sw itc hed
on. If d esired, the system c an be switched
to SPO RT mode.
SPORT mode
When driving in SPO RT mode, the
damping, steering 3 (not for engines
Z 28 N EL/NET) 1), throttle application and for automatic transmissions 3 - the shifting
points are changed.
Damping and steering 3 b ecome more
direct and provide better contac t with the
road surface. The engine reacts more
quic kly to ac celera tor m ovem ents.
With automatic transmission 3 the shift
tim es are reduced and g ear changes occur
at higher eng ine speeds (not w hen cruise
control 3 is a ctive).
In S PO RT mode, the damping c ontrol is
adap ted to a sportier driving sty le, a mong
other things. This ad aptation results in a
"harder" suspension setting.
Activating S PORT m od e
Press the S PO RT button. The LED in the
button illum inates.
In v ehicles with automatic transmission 3
the control indicator 1 also illuminates in
the tra nsmission display.
If the Winter programme 3 has been
switched on (v ehicles with automatic
transmission 3) SPO RT mode
cannot be activated.
Winter programm e - see p age 180.
1)
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
Driving and o peration
Dea ctivating SPO RT mode
Briefly press the SPO RT button a gain. The
LED in the button extinguishes. The
Continuous Damping Control system
resumes N orm al mode.
199
The sy stem’s integrated self-diagnostics
allows faults to b e q uick ly rem edied.
SPO RT mode is switched off by switching
off the ignition or switching off the Winter
programme 3 (v ehicles with automatic
transm ission 3).
Winter programme - see pa ge 180.
Control indica tor u for C ontinuous
Damping C ontrol or SPO RT mode fault
Illum inates for a few second s a fter the
ignition is switc hed on. I f the control
indica tor does not go out, or if it illum ina tes
whilst driving, there is a fa ult in the
Continuous Damping C ontrol system or
SPORT mode. The system is not ready for
op eration. Hav e the cause of the fault
rectified by a workshop.
200
Drivin g and operatio n
Crui se control 3
Cruise control can store and maintain
speeds of approx. 20 to 125 m ph
(30 to 200 km /h). Deviation from the saved
speed is possible on uphill or d ownhill
inclines.
For safety reasons the cruise control
cannot be activated until the footb rake
has been depressed once.
Cruise control is operated with
buttons m , g, and § on the turn
signa l stalk .
Do not use the c ruise control if it is not
adv isable to maintain a c onstant sp eed
(e. g. in situations presenting a danger to
yourself and other road users, in heavy
traffic or on winding , slippery or greasy
roads).
With automatic transmission 3, only use
cruise control in D or in Automatic mode
with Easytronic 3.
When the cruise control is active, reaction
tim es ma y b e increased due to the d ifferent
position of the feet.
9 Warning
Even with cruise c ontrol activated, the
driver has full resp onsibility for
maintaining an app ropriate speed.
Disregard of these instructions could lead
to injury or danger to life.
C ontrol indicator m
Illuminates for a few seconds when the
ignition is switched on. The system is now
ready for operation.
When driving, control indicator m will
illuminate as soon as the system is switched
on.
Driving and o peration
Decelerate
With cruise control active, hold down
button g or briefly press it repeatedly :
speed is reduced continuously or in steps
of 1.2 m ph (2 k m/h).
When button g is released the current
speed is stored and maintained.
201
To deactivate
Briefly press button §: C ruise control is
switched off, control indicator m
extinguishes and the vehic le slowly
decelerates. To continue driving, dep ress
the ac celerator pedal in the usual ma nner.
For reasons of safety , cruise control
deactivates under certain d riv ing
conditions.
For ex ample:
z if the vehicle’s speed drops below
approx. 20 mp h (30 km/h), or
z if the brak e pedal is depressed, or
To activate
Briefly p ress button m: the c urrent speed is
stored and m ainta ined. The accelerator
pedal can be released.
Vehicle speed can be increased by
depressing the accelerator pedal. When
the a ccelerator peda l is released, the
previously stored speed is resum ed.
Increa se
With cruise control activ e, hold down
button m or briefly press it repea tedly:
speed is increased continuously or in steps
of 1.2 mph (2 km/h) without using the
accelerator pedal.
When button m is released the current
speed is stored and m aintained.
z if the clutch pedal is dep ressed, or
z if the selector lever of automatic
tra nsmission 3 or Easytronic 3 is in N.
Resuming the stored speed
Briefly press button g at a sp eed above
20 mph (30 km/h): the speed selected
before the cruise control w as switc hed off is
resumed.
The stored speed va lue is deleted when the
ignition is switched on.
202
Drivin g and operatio n
Park ing dista nc e sensors 3
The parking distance sensors mak e reverse
parking easier by measuring the distance
between the vehicle a nd an obsta cle, and
giving a n acoustic signal in the p assenger
compartment.
The sy stem registers distance b y means of
four sensors in each of the front and rear
bumpers.
To activa te
With the ignition switched on, the front and
rear parking distance sensors are
automatically activa ted when reverse g ear
is engag ed.
The parking distance sensors c an also be
activa ted a t speed s of less than 15 mph
(25 km/h) b y pressing the r button on
the instrument panel.
An illumina ted LED a nd an acoustic signal
indicate that it is ready for operation.
Driving and o peration
C aravan/trailer towing equipm ent 3,
carav an/trailer towing
The sy stem automatically detects if a
towbar is properly fitted to the vehicle.
If the vehicle approaches a n ob stacle to
the front or rea r, a series of signals is
audible in the vehicle interior. The interval
between the signals becomes shorter a s
the d istance is reduced. If the dista nce is
less than 30 cm , the signal will b e
continuous.
When towing, inserting the c aravan/trailer
plug in the sock et automatically sw itches
off the p arking dista nce sensors for the
rear.
9 Warning
Und er certain circum stances, various
reflective surfaces on objects or clothing
as w ell as external noise sourc es may
cause the system to fail to detect
ob stacles. For this reason, care must be
ta ken when reversing even if the pa rk ing
distance sensors are operational. This is
of p artic ular im porta nce when in the
vicinity of ped estria ns.
To deactivate
To d eactiva te the sy stem, press button r
again, the LED in the button w ill go dark.
The sy stem switches itself off autom atically
when the forwards speed exceeds approx.
15 mph (25 k m/h).
203
Fitting rear load ra cks 3
Rear load rack s, e.g . bicy cle rack s, fitted
nea r the sensors could disrupt the system .
Control indica tor r
Illum inates:
Fault in system. The system is not
op erational. Have cause of fault remed ied
by a workshop. The system’s integ ra ted
self diagnostics allows faults to b e quickly
remedied.
Flashes:
The fault is d ue to sensors obstructed with
snow or ice. The sensors must be
undam aged a nd free of d irt, snow and ic e.
Interference due to ex ternal sources of
ultra sound (e.g . pneum atic drills, rota ry
machines). Once the source of interference
is removed, the sy stem will operate
normally .
204
Drivin g and operatio n
The vehic le is automatically ra ised at the
rear, increasing the spring tra vel and
ground c learance.
The automatic level control system is
activated after ap prox . 2 miles (3 k m),
depending on the vehicle load ing and the
na ture of the road surface.
Head lig ht range adjustment –
see p age 131.
Do not use full load in the event of faults.
Have the ca use of the fault rectified
straight awa y by a workshop.
Autom atic l ev el control 3
Autom atic level control makes it possible to
keep the height of the vehicle constant
when subjected to different loads in the
rea r (e.g. when towing a caravan/trailer).
This significantly improves driving
conditions.
Tyre p ressure monitori ng system 3
The tyre p ressure monitoring system
continuously monitors the pressure of all
four tyres while the vehicle is being driven.
A pressure sensor is integrated in each
wheel. O nce each m inute, the pressure of
each tyre is sent to a control unit for
compa rison. if the sy stem detects one or
more pressure differenc es, control
indicator w illum inates or fla shes red. I n
vehicles with check control 3, the ex act
pressure of the ty re in question appears on
the information display.
In v ehicles with Graphical I nformation
Display 3 or Colour Inform ation Display 3
and trip c om puter 3, current tyre pressures
can b e shown in the inform ation display .
For the system to be operational, all wheels
must be eq uipped with pressure sensors
and a ll tyres must be inflated to the
prescribed pressure. The tyre pressure
monitoring sy stem automatically detects
if the vehicle is being d riv en with a load of
up to 3 persons or a full load.
Driving and o peration
O nce the ignition is switched on, the sy stem
is operational and w ill continuously
monitor the tyre pressures at speeds of
approx. 20 m ph (30 km /h) and a bove.
205
Ü Board Computer
9 Warning
BC 1
The tyre pressure monitoring system does
not replace manual check s with a
suitable gauge.
Timer
BC 2
Tyres
Check tyre pressures a t least ev ery
14 day s and prior to any long journey;
the tyres should be checked when cold.
Don’t forget to check the spare 3.
Tyre pressure – see pa ges 213, 299.
Display of current tyre pressure 3
Select menu item Tyres from the Board
Comp ut er menu.
The current pressure of each tyre is
display ed.
C ontrol indicator w in red a s w arning
message
Illumination in red whilst driving indicates
deviating tyre pressure.
Indicator illuminates red:
Minor tyre pressure differenc e; slow down.
C heck ty re pressure a t next opp ortunity
with a suitable gauge and correct if
nec essary .
Indicator flashes red:
C onsiderab le pressure d ifference or direct
loss of pressure. Stop imm ediately and
check tyre and ty re pressure. Fit spare
wheel if necessary - see pages 236, 238.
206
Drivin g and operatio n
Warning messages in the
Graphical Information Displa y 3 or
Colour Information Display 3
In the model variant with check control 3
differing tyre pressures whilst d riv ing are
indicated by m essa ges on the information
display. The message appears in
abbreviated form depending on the model
variant.
For exa mple, the following messages c an
be displayed:
Navi active
Navi active
Tyre pressure
Attention!
C heck rea r
left tyre
(value in bar)
F ron t left tyre
pressure loss
(va lu e in b ar)
OK
A graphic 3 indica ting the left rear tyre is
shown together with the current ty re
pressure: S light pressure deviation. Reduce
speed. Chec k pressure at nex t op portunity
with appropriate g auge a nd correct if
necessary.
On the Colour Information Display this
report will app ear in y ellow.
OK
A dia gram 3 appears at the same time,
ma rk ing the front left ty re and showing the
current ty re pressure: Considerable
pressure difference or direct loss of
pressure. Exit flow of traffic as soon
as possible without obstructing other
vehicles, stop and check tyre and ty re
pressure. Fit spare wheel if necessary see pages 236, 238.
O n the C olour Information Display this
report will appear in red.
Acknowledgem ent of warnings –
see page 116.
Driving and o peration
General information
The tyre pressure monitoring system is not
ready for operation if the em ergenc y/spare
wheel is used and is not fitted with a
pressure sensor; the control indica tor w
illuminates yellow. The tyre pressure
monitoring sy stem rema ins operational for
the other three wheels.
Control indicator w in yellow as fault
message
If control indicator w illuminates y ellow
whilst driving , there is a fault in the ty re
pressure m onitoring system. Fitting a wheel
without a pressure sensor (e.g. the spare
wheel 3) w ill also generate a fault in the
system. Have the ca use of the fault
rem edied by a workshop. The system ’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
If you use a complete set of wheels which
are not fitted with sensors for the tyre
pressure monitoring system, e. g. four
winter tyres or a ftermarket tyres of a
different size, no fault messa ge w ill be
display ed. The ty re pressure m onitoring
sy stem is not ready for operation.
Sensors for the tyre pressure monitoring
sy stem can be retro-fitted by a workshop
up on request.
207
When m anually chec king tyre pressure with
a pressure gauge, sc rew the adapter onto
the valve. Tyre pressure – see p age 213.
Every time a tyre is changed, the va lv e
inserts and tyre pressure monitoring
system sealing ring s m ust be rep laced
by a workshop.
The use of commerc ially ava ila ble liquid
filled run-flat systems or repair kits can
impa ir the function of the sy stem.
Vauxhall-approved systems can be used.
Rad io transmitters (e.g. radio headphones,
walk ie-talkies) operated in the area could
cause interference in the ty re pressure
monitoring sy stem.
208
Drivin g and operatio n
Footbrak e
The footbrake comprises two independ ent
brak e circuits.
Brake system
The effectiveness of the brakes is a n
important factor for traffic safety.
If one brake circuit faults, the vehicle can
still be braked with the other brake circuit.
However the brak ing effect will occur at a
lower ped al position and considerably
more forc e is required. The braking
distance is longer. Contact a work shop
before continuing to d riv e.
To improve effectiveness, do not b ra ke
unnecessarily hard for the first 125 miles
(200 km) after new brake pads have been
fitted.
Brake pad wear must not exceed a
specified limit. Regular maintenance as
detailed in the Service Book let is therefore
of the utm ost importance for traffic safety.
Hav e worn brak e pa ds replaced by a
workshop.
Pads tha t hav e been tested and approved
guarantee optimum bra ke p erformance.
Brake assist
If the brak e p edal is slammed on, the
vehicle is autom atically brak ed w ith
maximum brake force am plifica tion in
order to achieve the shortest possib le
braking distance w hen full-on brak ing
oc curs (braking a ssist).
Mainta in steady p ressure on the brake
pedal for a s long a s full-on braking is to
continue. When the brak e pedal is
relea sed, the maxim um brake forc e
amplification is tak en awa y.
Adapt ive brak e light
During full-on braking, all three b ra ke
lig hts flash for the duration of ABS control.
To ensure that full pedal travel – can be
utilised, particularly if there is a fault in one
of the b ra ke circuits, there m ust be no ma ts
in the pedal area - see page 185.
When the engine is not running, the
assistance of the brake servo unit
disappears once the brak e pedal ha s been
depressed once or twice. Braking effect is
not red uced, but braking req uires
significa ntly greater force. This is especially
important to bear in mind w hen towing.
Driving and o peration
209
Check the brake lights b efore starting out
on a journey. On v ehicles with check
control 3 the brake lights are check ed
automatically – see page 124.
Shortly after starting each journey the
effectiveness of the b ra ke system should
be tested at low speed and without
inconv eniencing other tra ffic, especia lly if
the b ra kes are wet, e. g. after the vehicle
has been washed.
The b ra ke fluid level should be check ed
reg ularly . If the brake fluid level is too low
and the hand brake is not ap plied, control
indicator R in the instrum ent cluster
illuminates – see pa ge 99.
Handbra ke
Alw ays app ly the handbrake firmly without
actuating the relea se button; to do this fold
up the armrest 3. Apply as fully as possible
on uphill or downhill inclines.
The mechanic al handbrake acts on the
brakes on the rear wheels. It engages
autom atic ally when applied.
To release the handbrake pull the lev er up
slightly, press the ratchet knob , and fully
low er the lever.
To reduce the operating forces of the
ha ndb ra ke, dep ress the footbrak e a t the
sam e time.
Brak e system control indicat or R
The control indicator illuminates when the
ignition is switched on if the handbrake is
app lied or if the b ra ke or clutch fluid level is
too low. B ra ke fluid – see page 276.
9 Warnin g
If the control indicator illum ina tes when
the handbrake is released, stop driving
immediately. Contact a workshop.
210
Drivin g and operatio n
Fault
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS u )
ABS continually monitors the brake system
and prevents the wheels from locking
reg ardless of the type of road surfac e or
tyre grip.
It starts to regulate the braking p ressure as
soon as a w heel shows a tendency to lock.
The v ehicle remains steera ble, even in the
event of very heavy braking, for instance
on bends or when sw erving to av oid an
obstacle. Even in the ca se of full-on
braking, the ABS makes it p ossible to drive
round an obsta cle without releasing the
brakes.
ABS control is made app arent through a
pulse in the brake peda l and the noise of
the regulation proc ess.
9 Warning
For optimum b ra king, keep the brak e
pedal fully depressed throughout the
braking p rocess, despite the fac t that the
pedal is pulsating. Do not red uce the
pressure on the pedal.
Do not let this special safety feature
tempt y ou into taking risks when driving.
Traffic safety can only be achieved by
adopting a responsib le driving style.
9 Warnin g
If there is a fault in ABS, the wheels may
be subject to locking due to braking that
is heavier tha n normal. The ad vantages
of AB S are no longer opera tional.
Y ou can continue driving, provided y ou
drive with care and anticipation.
Control i nd icator u for ABS
It illum ina tes for a few seconds after the
ignition is turned on. The sy stem is read y
for operation when the control indicator
extinguishes.
If the control indicator does not go out
after a few seconds, or if it illuminates
whilst driving, there is a fa ult in the ABS.
The brake system remains operational
without ABS regulation.
Self-check
Each time the ignition is turned on and the
engine started , after moving away from a
speed of around 2 mph (3 k m/h) the system
performs a self-check which may be
audible.
Hav e the cause of the fault elim ina ted by a
workshop. The self-d ia gnosis integrated
into the system allows rapid fault
identification.
Driving and o peration
Wheels, tyres
See page 297 for suitable tyres a nd
restrictions.
Tyres fitted in the factory are a dapted to
the c hassis a nd provide optimum driving
comfort and safety .
Changing tyre/wheel typ e
Before c hanging to other tyres or wheels,
note the necessa ry changes.
If tyres of a different size than those fitted
at the factory are used, the electronic
speedom eter may require reprogramming
to ensure that the correct sp eed is
display ed.
9 Warning
Use of unsuitab le tyres or wheels m ay
lead to accidents and render the vehicle
unroa dworthy .
211
Vehicles with ty re pressure m onitoring
system 3
If y ou ha ve winter tyres or a ftermarket
tyres of a different size fitted, sensors for
the tyre pressure monitoring system can b e
retro-fitted by a workshop upon request.
O therwise the sy stem will not display ty re
pressure deviations.
Tyre pressure monitoring sy stem 3 –
see page 204.
212
Drivin g and operatio n
Fitting new tyres
Fit tyres in pairs or in sets, which is ev en
better. Ensure that tyres on one a xle are:
z the same size,
z the same design,
z the same make,
z and have the same tread pattern.
Fit direc tional tyres such that they roll in the
direc tion of travel. The rolling d irection is
indicated by a symbol (e.g. a n arrow) on
the sidewall.
Tyres fitted opposing the rolling direction
(e. g. when a tyre is chang ed) should be
refitted a s soon as possible. This is the only
way to obtain full benefit from the design
properties of the tyre.
Some b ra nd s of tyres have a b eaded ed ge
for a lloy wheels to protect against
damage. If wheel trim is used on steel
wheels with beaded-edg e ty res, the
following procedure must be followed:
z Use wheel trims and ty res tha t are
approved by Vauxhall for the vehicle in
question a nd therefore meet all the
requirem ents pertaining to the
respective wheel/ty re c om bina tion.
z If the wheel trims and tyres used a re not
Vauxhall-app rov ed, the tyres must not
ha ve a beaded edg e.
9 Warnin g
Use of unsuitable tyres or wheel trims
could lead to sudden loss of air and
thereby accidents.
Driving and o peration
Tyre pr essure
Check ty re pressures, including the spare
wheel, at least ev ery 14 day s and prior to
any long journey; the ty res should be
check ed when cold. Don’t forget to check
the spare.
In vehicles with tyre p ressure monitoring
sy stem 3 there is an ad apter in the valve
cap key. Screw adapter to valv e before
attaching tyre pressure gauge see p age 204.
Use the v alve cap key to make unscrewing
the valve caps easier. The key is located on
the inside of the tank flap.
Do not reduce ty re pressure when the tyres
are wa rm. O therwise the pressure may
drop b elow the perm issible minimum when
the tyres cool down.
Ty re p ressure - see page 299.
After having chec ked the tyre pressures,
tig hten the va lv e ca ps using the v alve cap
key .
213
Incorrect tyre p ressures will im pair sa fety,
vehicle handling, c om fort a nd fuel
econom y and w ill increase tyre wear.
If the pressure is too low , this can result in
consid erable tyre warm-up and interna l
dam age, lead ing to tread separation and
even to ty re blow-out at high speeds.
Hidd en tyre dama ge is not elim inated by
adjusting the tyre pressure.
9 Warnin g
Incorrect ty re pressure could lead to a flat
tyre.
214
Drivin g and operatio n
Check tyres regularly for dama ge
(p enetrated foreign bodies, punctures,
cuts, c ra cks, bulges in side walls). Chec k
wheels for dam age. If dam age or unusual
wear is found, contact a work shop.
9 Warning
Dama ge m ay lead to ty re blow-out.
Tyre cond ition, w heel condi tion
Drive over edges slowly and at a rig ht
angle if p ossible. Driving ov er sha rp edges
can lead to hidden ty re damage a nd wheel
dam age which is only noticed later on.
Tread d ep th
C heck tread depth regularly.
When pa rk ing, ensure that the tyres a re not
pressed against the ed ge of the kerb .
C orrect tyre pressure.
If w ear in the front is greater than that in
the rear, m ov e the rear wheels to the front
ax le and vice versa.
For reasons of safety , tyres should be
replaced when their tread depth has worn
down to 2 to 3 mm (winter tyres: 4 mm).
Driving and o peration
General i nformati on
z The danger of aq uap laning is greater if
the ty res are worn.
z Tyres age, even if they a re used only very
little or not at all. A spare wheel which
has not b een used for six years should be
used w ith ca re.
z Never fit used tyres the prev ious history
and use of w hich y ou do not know.
z So as not to im pair brake cooling , use
only wheel trims app rov ed for use on
your vehicle.
The legally permissible minimum tread
depth (1.6 m m) has been reached when
the tread has worn down as far as one of
the w ear indicators (TWI 1 )). A number of
wear indicators a re spaced at equal
intervals around the ty re within the tread.
Their position is indicated by markings on
the ty re sidewall.
1)
TWI = T read We ar Ind ica to r.
215
Tyre d esigna tions
Meaning s:
e.g. 195/65 R 15 91 H
195 = Tyre width in mm
65 = Cross-section ratio
(ty re height to width) in %
R
= Belt ty pe: Radial
15
91
H
= Wheel d ia meter in inch
= Load ind ex e.g. 91 c orresponds
to 618 kg
= Speed cod e letter
S peed code letters:
Q
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
S
T
up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H
V
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
up to 150 mph (240 km/h)
W
up to 168 mph (270 km/h)
216
Drivin g and operatio n
Winter tyres 3
For notes on fitting new tyres –
see page 212.
See page 299 for restric tions.
Winter tyres im prove safety at
tem peratures below 7 °C and should
therefore be fitted on all the wheels.
The d esign of summ er tyres mea ns they
have limited qualities for winter driving.
If the m aximum p ermissible speed for the
winter tyres is less than that of the vehicle,
a notic e indicating the maxim um
permissib le speed for the tyres must be
affix ed within the driver’s field of vision 1 ).
If you use the spare wheel when it is fitted
with a sum mer ty re, the vehic le’s
driveab ility may b e affected, esp ecially on
slippery road surfaces. O btain a
replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as
possible, and have the w heel balanced
and fitted to the vehicle.
1)
Va ries from cou ntry to co untry on a ccou nt o f
na tion al reg ulations.
Wheel trims 3
If the wheel trims and tyres used are not
Vauxhall-approved, ma ke sure that the
tyres do not have a beaded edg e see page 212.
Driving and o peration
Wheel trim on steel w heels could com e into
contact with parts of the chain and be
damaged. R emove the wheel trim –
see p age 239.
Ty re chains may only be used a t speeds up
to 30 m ph (50 km/h) 1 ) and, when travelling
on roads that are free of snow, they may be
used for brief periods only since they are
subjec t to rapid wear on a hard road and
may snap.
Temporary wheel 3
Tyre chains must not be used on the
temporary spare wheel. If y ou need to use
tyre chains after suffering a flat front tyre,
fit the temporary spa re on the rear ax le
and transfer one of the rea r wheels to the
front axle.
For notes on the tem porary spare wheel –
see page 237.
Wheel changing – see pag e 238.
C orrect tyre pressure.
Tyre pressure monitoring sy stem 3 –
see page 204.
Tyre cha ins 3
Restrictions and further information –
see page 299.
Tyre c hains are only permitted on the drive
wheels (front ax le). They must be fitted to
the ty res sy mmetrica lly in order to achieve
a concentric fit.
Always use fine mesh chains that add no
more than 10 mm to the tyre tread and the
inboard sides (including chain lock).
1)
Va ries from cou ntry to co untry on a ccou nt o f
na tion al reg ulations.
217
218
Drivin g and operatio n
Roo f racks 3
9 Warning
Disreg ard of these notes ca n lead to
injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle
passengers must b e informed
according ly .
For safety reasons and to avoid roof
dam age, we recommend using the
Vauxhall roof ra ck system approved for
your vehicle.
Fasten the roof rack following the
instructions that ac company the sy stem.
Driving hints – see page 184.
Version wit hout roof rail ing
Fold cov ers of installation openings
up wards.
Attac h roof rack at appropriate points see enclosed roof luggage rack system
instructions.
Versi on with roof ra iling 3
Attach roof rack to roof railing at p oints
show n in illustration - see enclosed roof
luggage rack sy stem instructions.
Driving and o peration
Towing equipment
219
3
9 Warning
Disreg ard of these notes ca n lead to
injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle
passengers must b e informed
according ly .
O nly use a ca ra van/trailer tow ing dev ice
approved for the vehicle. Hav e a tow ing
device fitted by workshop, who will inform
you of any possible caravan/trailer load
increases. They will hav e the instructions
for fitting the device and any necessa ry
changes to the vehic le concerning cooling,
heat shields or other devices.
9 Warning
The coupling ball bar is to b e removed
when not towing .
For installation dimensions of the
carava n/trailer towing equipment –
see pages 311, 312.
Towing equipment with
removable coupling ball bar 3 ,
Saloon / Hatch 3
Stowa ge of coupling b all b ar
The coupling ball ba r is stored in a bag
strapped to the spa re wheel.
Fitti ng the coupling b all b ar
C om press the sealing plugs at the ends
and pull out of the opening for the coupling
ball bar. S tow the sealing plugs in the
luggage compa rtm ent. Disengage socket
and fold d ow n 3.
6
220
Drivin g and operatio n
Checking the tensioning of the c oupling
ball b ar:
z Red m arking on turn knob points
towa rd s green m arking on coupling ba ll
bar.
z Gap of approx. 6 millimetres between
rotary knob and coupling ball bar.
z Key is in lock.
Otherwise, the coupling ball bar must be
tensioned before it is inserted into the
coupling housing:
z O pen coupling ball bar,
z Pull turn k nob out and then turn it
clockwise as far as it will go –
see illustration.
Inserting the coupling b all bar
Insert the tensioned coupling ball bar in the
coupling housing and push firmly upwards
until you hear the coupling ball ba r
eng aging.
The turn knob snaps back into its home
position resting a gainst the coup ling ball
bar.
9 Warnin g
Do not touch the turn k nob when
inserting the coupling ball bar – risk of
injury.
Driving and o peration
221
Imp or tant
Check that the coupling ball bar is correctly
installed:
z Red mark ing on turn knob p oints
towards white marking on coupling ball
bar.
z No gap between turn k nob and coupling
ball b ar.
z C oupling ba ll bar must be seated firm ly
in coupling housing.
z C oupling ba ll bar must be locked and
key m ust be rem oved.
O pen coupling ball b ar. Remove key and
put on provided protectiv e clip.
When the coupling b all bar is locked the
turn knob can no longer b e pulled out.
9 Warning
Towing is permitted only with a c orrectly
fitted towb ar. If the towbar cannot be
fitted correctly, contact a workshop.
Eye for b reak-aw ay st opping c able
In the case of carava ns/trailers with brake,
attach the break-away stop ping cable to
the eye. Ey e - see Fig. 17721 J.
Dismounti ng the coupling b all b ar
C lose coup ling ball bar.
Pull the turn knob out and then turn it
clockw ise as far as it will go. Pull the
coupling ball b ar downwards out of the
coupling housing and stow it in the
luggage compa rtm ent – see p age 219,
Fig. 17729 J.
Insert the sealing plug in the hole for the
coupling ball b ar. Fold away the socket –
see page 219, Fig. 17717 J .
Do not use steam -jet cleaners or other
high-pressure clea ners to clean the
coupling ball b ar.
222
Drivin g and operatio n
Towing equipment with pivo ting
coupling ball bar 3
Folding out the c oup ling b all ba r
The release lever is in the stowage
compartment to the left in the luggage
compartment.
To open the stowa ge c om partment, push
both latches down and open the cover.
Push the release lever down; the LED on the
lever is illuminated while the coupling ball
bar is not engaged. A wa rning buzzer also
sounds and the coupling ba ll bar pivots
down.
9 Warning
Mak e sure that no one is in the p iv ot zone
of the c oupling b all bar. Risk of b od ily
injury .
Swivel the coupling ba ll bar back wards
until it engages (see Fig. 17726 J). The LED
must g o out a nd the warning buzzer must
cease. Otherwise, repeat the proced ure.
I mporta nt
C heck tha t the coupling ball bar is correctly
eng aged:
z LED is not illuminated.
z No warning buzzer.
Driving and o peration
223
Caravan/trailer towing
9 Warning
C arava n and tra iler loads 1 )
The permissib le carav an/trailer load s a re
vehicle-dependent and engine-dependent
ma ximum v alues which must not be
exceeded. The actual carava n/trailer load
is the d ifference between the actual gross
weight of the carav an/trailer and the
actual c oupling socket load with the
carav an/trailer atta ched. When the
carav an/trailer load is being checked,
therefore, only the caravan/trailer w heels –
and not the joc key wheel – m ust be
standing on the weighing apparatus.
Caravan/trailer towing is permissible only
when the c oupling ba ll bar is engag ed
correctly. I f the coupling ball b ar cannot
be engaged correctly, the LED does not
go out or the warning b uzz er does not go
off. Seek the assistanc e of a work shop.
Ca rava n/tra iler wit h break-a way cable 3
For caravans/trailers with brak es, loop
break-away cable around coup ling ball
bar.
Stowi ng the coupling ball b ar
Open the stowage compartment –
see p age 222.
Push the release lever down; the LED on
the lev er remains illuminated as long as
the coupling ball ba r is not engaged .
A warning buzzer also sound s a nd the
coupling b all bar piv ots down.
The permissib le carav an/trailer load s for
y our v ehicle are giv en in the vehicle
documents. Unless otherwise stated, they
are valid for g ra dients up to max . 12%.
Piv ot the coupling ball ba r to the right and
up . The LED must g o out and the wa rning
buzzer m ust cease, otherwise repeat the
proc edure.
1)
Ob serve n atio nal regula tions.
224
Drivin g and operatio n
The permissible cara van/trailer load should
be fully utilised only by drivers who are
adequately experienced in towing large or
heav y carav ans/trailers.
The permitted carav an/trailer load ap plies
up to the specified incline and up to an
altitude of 1000 m etres abov e sea -level.
Since engine power decreases as altitude
increases because of the air becom ing
thinner, therefore reducing climbing ability,
the p ermitted towing weig ht a lso
decreases by 10% for every 1000 m etres of
additional altitude. The towing weight
does not have to be reduced when driv ing
on roads with slight inclines (less than 8%,
e.g. m otorway s).
The actual carav an/trailer load plus the
actual gross weight of the towing vehicle
must not exceed the max imum permitted
tow ing weight. For example, if the
permitted Gross Vehicle Weight is utilised ,
the caravan/trailer load must only b e used
until the maximum permitted towing
weight is rea ched. The max imum
permitted towing weight is shown on the
identification plate - see p age 282.
C oup ling sock et load
The coupling socket load is the load
exerted by the ca ra van/trailer on the
coupling ball. It can be va ried by changing
the weight distribution when loading the
carav an/trailer.
The m aximum permissible coupling socket
load (S aloon / Hatch: 78 kg, Estate: 85 k g)
is specified on the towing equipment
identification plate and in the vehicle
documents. Alw ays aim for the maximum
load, espec ia lly in the c ase of heav y
carav ans/tra ilers. The coupling socket load
should never fall below 25 kg.
When measuring the coupling socket load ,
ma ke sure that the drawbar of the loaded
carav an/trailer is at the same height as it
will be when the carav an/trailer is coupled
with the towing vehic le loa ded. Particularly
important for carav ans/trailers with
tandem ax le.
Driving and o peration
Trai ler Stabi lity Assist 3 (TS A)
TSA monitors vehicle movements when
towing a caravan/trailer. If the sy stem
detects lurching movem ents, engine power
is reduced while the vehicle a nd
carav an/trailer com bination is selectively
brak ed until the lurching ceases.
Rear axle load during tow ing
When the carava n/trailer is coup led up and
the towing vehicle is fully load ed, including
all occupants, the permissib le rear axle
load (for inform ation - see the
identification plate or vehicle
documentation) may be ex ceeded by 50
kg. The Gross Vehicle Weight rating must
not be ex ceeded in the process.
TSA is a function of the Electronic Stability
Programme (ES P ®P lu s ) - see page 196.
O n the increased payload version 3, the
permissible rear ax le load may be
exceeded by 65 kg .
If the permissib le rear axle load is
exceeded, a maximum speed of 60 mp h
(100 km/h) must be applied. If lower
nationa l speed limits are p rescrib ed for
vehic les towing caravans/trailers, these
must be observed .
225
Tyre pressure
Ad just the ty re pressure on the towing
vehicle to the v alue specified for a full load
- see page 299. Also check the pressure of
the carav an/trailer w heels and the sp are
wheel.
226
Drivin g and operatio n
Driv ing chara cteristics, tow ing tip s
For caravans/trailers with brak es, attach
break-away cable to eye 3 or loop around
coupling ball ba r if no eye av ailable.
Turn signal control indicator – see page 98.
Before attaching the ca ra van/trailer,
lubricate the ball of the caravan/tra iler
towing device. However, do not lub rica te
the b all if a stabiliser, which acts on the
coupling ball, is being used to da mp
sna king .
Handling is greatly influenced by the
loa ding of the carav an/trailer. Loads
should therefore be secured so that they
cannot slip and be p laced in the centre of
the carav an/trailer if p ossible, i. e. above
the axle.
Check cara van/trailer lig hting b efore
starting to drive. The fog tail light on the
vehic le is deactivated when towing a
carava n/trailer.
Ca ra van/trailers with LED turn signals m ust
have a provision tha t makes it possible to
monitor standard light bulbs.
The parking distance sensors at the rear 3
are d eactivated when tow ing a
caravan/trailer.
In the case of trailers with low driving
stability or caravans with a permitted
Gross Vehicle Weight of 1400 k g (Saloon /
Hatch)/1500 kg (Estate), do not exceed a
speed of 50 mp h (80 km/h); the use of a
friction-type sta biliser is highly
recommended.
Do not d riv e faster than 50 mph (80 k m/h)
if possible, ev en in countries where hig her
speeds are permitted.
Make sure that you have enough room
when cornering and a void sud den
manoeuvres.
If the cara van/trailer starts to sway, drive
more slowly, d o not a ttempt to correct the
steering and b ra ke sharply if necessary.
If it is necessary to apply the brak es fully ,
depress the brak e pedal a s hard as
possible.
Remem ber that the braking d istance for
vehicles towing carava ns/trailers with and
without brake is always greater than that
for vehic les not tow ing a carav an/trailer.
When driving downhill, the brakes are
under considerably m ore load when towing
a caravan/trailer. For this reason, d riv e in
the same gear as if driving up hill and drive
at a sim ila r speed .
Automatic transm ission 3 or Easy tronic 3
in Automatic mode will automatically
select the d riv ing programme with the
optimum engine b ra king effec t.
If necessary, the gears can a lso be selec ted
ma nually.
Driving and o peration
227
The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its
cooling power is therefore independent of
the engine speed.
For v ehicles with a utomatic transmission 3
or Easy tronic 3 in Autom atic mode it is
sufficient to apply full throttle.
Since a considerable amount of heat is
generated at high engine sp eed s a nd less
at slower speeds, d o not shift down when
climbing hills whilst the vehicle is still coping
with the g ra dient in the higher gea r.
Before starting-off under extreme
conditions (high combination weight,
mountainous terrain w ith steep inclines),
switch off all unnecessary electrical loads
(e.g. heated rear window, air conditioning
system 3, heated seats 3).
Diesel engines: O n rising g radients of 10%
or more, do not drive faster than 20 mph
(30 k m/h) in 1st gear or 30 mph (50 km/h)
in 2nd gea r; with automatic
transm ission 3, do not exceed 25 mp h
(40 k m/h) in position 1.
Start ing on inclines
For vehicles with manual transmission,
the most favourable engine speed when
starting-off on an incline is between 2500
and 3000 rpm for petrol engines and
between 2000 and 2200 rpm for diesel
engines. Hold engine speed constant,
engage clutch gradually (let slip), release
ha ndb ra ke and open throttle. If possible,
the engine speed should not drop d uring
this procedure.
228
Self-help, vehicle care
Self-help, vehicle care
Diesel fuel system, bleeding . .... .... ..... .
Bonnet ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Starting .... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Towing ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Warning triangle ¨ 3 ,
first-aid kit + 3.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Spa re wheel 3 . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Jac k £ 3 and vehicle tools 3 .. .... ..... .
Changing wheels . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Tyre repair kit 3 ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Electrical system .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Fuses and the most important c ircuits
they p rotect .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Halogen headlight system, dipped
and main beam . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Xenon headlight system , dipped and
main beam ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Adaptive Forw ard Lighting (AFL)
sy stem 3 ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Halogen headlight system, Xenon
headlight system, parking lights .... .
Tail lights . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Numb er plate light .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Courtesy lig ht .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Vehicle care. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
228
228
229
232
234
236
238
238
242
246
248
252
253
255
257
257
258
261
262
264
9 Warning
Disregard of these notes can lead to
injuries whic h may be fatal. Vehicle
passengers must be informed
accordingly.
Diesel fuel system , bleeding
Nev er let the tank run dry . If control
indica tor Y illuminates, refuel as soon a s
possible. Refuel immediately if it fla shes.
Restarting after running out of fuel is
possible, but sta rting b ehaviour will be
delay ed. Turn on the ignition three times
for 15 seconds eac h tim e. Then start the
engine for a maxim um of 40 seconds. If it
does not start, repeat the p rocess after
waiting at least 5 seconds. I f the engine still
does not start, contac t a workshop .
Bon net
To open the bonnet, pull the release lever
located on the driv er’s side b elow the
instrument panel. The bonnet will then be
unlocked and will partially open. R eturn
release lever to its original position.
Self-help, vehicle care
229
Starting
Do not sta rt wit h quick charger
This prevents d amage to electronic
components.
Do not sta rt by pushing or tow ing
Because your vehicle is fitted with a
cataly tic converter, it must not be started
by pushing or towing – see page 190.
The v ehicle can only be started using jum p
leads – see follow ing page.
There is a safety catch on the underside of
the b onnet: lift this upwards and op en the
bonnet.
To hold the bonnet open, insert the support
loca ted a t the side in the small slot on the
underside of the bonnet.
Dirt or snow on the bonnet may drop onto
the windscreen when the bonnet is opened
and block the air intake.
Before c losing, fasten the support in its
retainer. Lower the bonnet and allow it to
fa ll into its catch.
Air intake – see page 166.
Check tha t the bonnet is lock ed in position
by pulling at its front edge. I f it is not
engaged, repea t the procedure.
230
Self-help, vehicle care
Sta rting t he engine wi th jump lea ds 3
A vehicle with a discharged battery can be
started using jump lead s and the battery of
another vehicle.
Attemp ts to start the vehicle should be
mad e at intervals of one minute a nd
should not last longer than 15 seconds
9 Warning
Be extrem ely careful when starting with
jump leads. Any dev iation from the
following instructions can lead to injuries
or damage caused by battery explosion
or damage to the elec trical sy stems of
both v ehicles.
z Nev er expose the battery to naked
flam es or sparks.
z A discharged ba ttery ca n freeze at
temperatures of around 0 ° C. Alwa ys
thaw out a froz en batteries in a wa rm
room before attaching jum p lead s.
z Do not a llow battery fluid to come into
contact with eyes, skin, fabrics or
painted surfa ces. The fluid c ontains
sulphuric acid which can c ause injuries
and damag e in the event of direct
contact.
z Wear eye protec tion and protective
clothing when handling a b attery.
z Switch off all unnecessary electrical
consumers.
z Use aux iliary battery with same voltage
(12 v olts). Its cap acity (Ah) must not b e
consid erably less than that of the
discharged battery. Voltag e and
capa city inform ation c an be found on
the batteries.
z Do not lean over the ba ttery during jump
starting.
z Use jump leads with insulated terminals
and a cross section of at least 16 mm 2
(25 m m2 for diesel engines).
z Do not disconnect the d ischarged
battery from the vehicle.
z Do not allow the terminals of one lead to
touch those of the other lead .
z Do not allow the vehicles to touch while
jum p sta rting.
z Apply handbrak e. M anual tra nsmission
or Easytronic 3 in neutral, autom atic
tra nsmission 3 in P.
The battery is in a box at the front of the
eng ine compartm ent, on the right-hand
side as v iewed from the front. To open the
box , pull the c ov er forwards and swing it
upwards.
Self-help, vehicle care
z Do not connect leads to negative
term inal of discharged battery.
z Start the engine of the v ehicle prov iding
the jump start.
z The connection p oint should be as far
away from the discharged battery as
possible.
z After 5 minutes, start the other engine.
Start attempts should be made at
intervals of 1 minute and should not last
longer than 15 seconds.
z Route the lead s so that they cannot
catch on rotating parts in the engine
compa rtm ent.
Connect the lea ds in the order shown in the
illustration:
1. Connect one end of the first jump lead to
the positiv e terminal 1 of the battery
prov iding the jump start (identified by
"+" sign on battery case or terminal).
2. Connect the other end of this lea d to the
positive terminal 2 of the discharged
battery (" +" sign).
3. Connect the first end of the other jump
lead to the negativ e terminal 3 of the
battery prov iding the start ("–" sign).
4. Connect the other end of the second
jump lead 4 to ground on the other
vehicle, e. g. engine block or screw
connection in the engine suspension.
231
z After starting, allow both eng ines to idle
for approx. 3 m inutes with the leads
connected.
z In order to a void ex cess voltage in the
electric al sy stem, b efore removing a
lead, sw itc h on a n electrica l consumer
(e.g. light, heated rear window) in the
vehicle receiving the jump sta rt.
z Reverse abov e seq uence exac tly when
removing leads.
232
Self-help, vehicle care
Drive slowly . Do not drive jerkily . Excessive
tractive force c an damage the vehicle.
9 Warnin g
For brak ing and steering, significantly
hig her forces are required: brake
assista nce and steering assistance are
effectiv e only w ith the engine running.
To prevent the entry of exhaust fum es from
the tow ing vehicle, switch on the air
recirc ulation 3 and close the wind ow s.
Towing
Towing your own v ehi cle
To open the cover concealing the towing
eye socket at the front right of the vehicle:
disengage the cover at the bottom and pull
it off downwards.
The front towing ey e is located in the
compartment containing the jack and
vehic le tools underneath the spare wheel in
the lugga ge c om partment. Jack and
vehic le tools – see page 238.
Screw in the front towing ey e anticlockwise
as fa r as it will go until it stops in a
horizontal position.
Attac h a tow rope 3 – or better still a tow
rod 3 – to the eye.
The front towing eye may b e used only for
tow ing the vehic le, not for rescuing it.
Switch on ignition to release steering
colum n lock and to permit opera tion of
brake lights, horn and windscreen wiper.
Manua l transmission or Easy tronic 3 in
neutra l, automatic transmission 3 in N.
Vehicles with automatic tra nsmission 3
should b e towed facing forw ards only and
must not be tow ed faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h) or further than 60 m iles (100 km).
If the transmission is defective, or if the
abov e speed or distance is to be exceeded,
the front ax le m ust be raised off the
ground.
Self-help, vehicle care
233
Contact a workshop.
If the autom atic clutch is relea sed
manually a fter a p ower failure on vehicles
with Easytronic 3 , tow ing is not perm itted see page 175. I n this case, contact a
workshop immediately.
After towing, unscrew front towing eye by
rotating cloc kwise and insert a nd c lose the
cap.
Towing serv ice
Entrust your vehicle only to the towing
service of your choice and obtain an
estimate on tow ing costs before employing
any towing serv ice. In this w ay y ou a void
unnecessary costs and possible insurance
problem s during c la im processing .
Tow ing another v ehic le
To op en the cover c oncealing the towing
eye socket at the rear right of the v ehicle:
disengage the cover at the bottom and pull
it off d ow nwa rds.
S crew in the rear towing eye anticlockwise
as far as it will g o until it stops in a
horizontal position.
The rea r tow ing eye is located in the
compartment containing the ja ck and
vehicle tools underneath the spare w heel in
the luggage compartment. J ack and
vehicle tools – see page 238.
The rear towing eye may be used only for
towing the vehicle, not for rescuing it.
Attach a tow rop e 3 – or better still a tow
rod 3 – to the ey e.
Drive slowly . Do not drive jerkily . Excessive
tractive force c an damage the vehicle.
After towing, unscrew rear towing eye by
rotating clockwise and insert and close
the cap.
234
Self-help, vehicle care
Warning triangle ¨ 3,
first-aid kit + 3
To access press down bar a nd open the
cover.
Sal oon / Ha tch
The w arning triangle and first-aid kit/
cushion are stowed in the side panel trim
on the left-hand side.
Depend ing on the warning triangle version,
move loc king lever upwards and therefore
clamp wa rning triangle in position.
When loading v ehicle, always ensure that
first-aid cushion or first-aid kit is a ccessib le.
Self-help, vehicle care
235
When loading v ehicle, always ensure that
warning triangle and first-aid cushion or
first-aid kit are accessible.
Est ate
The w arning triangle and first-aid kit/
cushion are stowed in the side panel trim
on the left-hand side.
To op en, push both bars down and open
the flap.
236
Self-help, vehicle care
Spare wheel 3
Some vehicles are equipped with a tyre
rep air kit instead of a spare wheel.
See page 242.
Sal oon / Ha tch
The spare wheel is located in the luggage
compartment under the floor cov er. I t is
secured with a plastic wing nut.
To open the floor cover, p ull up the handle
or stra p.
Estat e
The spare wheel is located in the lugg age
compartment under the load floor. I t is
secured with a plastic wing nut.
To open the loading floor, fold out release
lever b y pushing at the m arked point and
raise up the loading floor all the way.
St owing sta nd ard size tyres in the spare
w heel well
The spare w heel well is not designed for all
sizes of permissible tyres. I f a larger wheel
must be stowed in the spa re wheel well
after chang ing wheels, place the floor
cover on the protruding wheel.
Self-help, vehicle care
Genera l informa tion
Dep ending on the model variant, the spa re
wheel is in the form of an temporary
spare wheel 3. Please pay attention
to instructions concerning temporary
spare wheel in the nex t colum n and on
pages 217, 242, 299.
Notes on tem porary spare wheel 3
z Using a temporary spare wheel
may change the driving b ehaviour of
the vehicle, particularly if using winter
tyres 3. Replace defective ty re as quickly
as possible, ba la nce wheel and fit to
vehicle.
O n vehicles w ith a lloy wheels 3 the spare
wheel may have a steel rim.
z Fit only one temporary spare wheel.
If y ou use winter tyres 3, the spare wheel
may still be fitted with a summer tyre. I f you
use the spare wheel the vehicle’s ha nd ling
may be altered. O btain a replacement for
the faulty tyre a s soon as possible, and
have the wheel b alanc ed a nd fitted to the
vehic le.
The spare wheel may have a smaller tyre
and a smaller rim tha n the wheels mounted
on the vehic le 1) : Using the spare wheel m ay
alter vehicle handling. Have the defective
tyre replaced as soon as possible, balance
the w heel and have it mounted on the
vehic le.
z Do not drive faster than 50 m ph
(80 k m/h).
z Take curves slowly.
z Do not use the temporary spa re wheel
for a lengthy period.
z Replace temporary spare wheel with full
specification wheel without delay .
z Tyre chains are not permitted on the
temporary spare wheel. If tyre chains
have to be used after a front wheel
puncture, fit temporary spare wheel to
the rear ax le and fit a rear wheel to the
front axle. Check tyre pressure and
correct if necessary - see pa ge 299.
z Please follow instructions concerning
temporary spare wheel on pages 217
and 299.
1)
Co untry-specific versio n: The s pa re wh eel is
only to b e used as a tem po ra ry sp are wheel.
237
Not es on di rect ional tyres 3
Direc tional ty res only achiev e their full
performa nc e potential when mounted in
the prescribed direction of rotation. If after
a flat tyre the tyre or sp are wheel is
mounted against the prescribed direc tion
of rotation, observe the following:
z Driv ing conditions may be altered.
Replac e the defective tyre a s soon as
possible, balance the wheel and mount it
on the vehic le.
z Do not drive faster than 50 mph
(80 km /h).
z Driv e especially carefully in w et or snowy
weather.
For further information on directional
tyres – see page 211.
238
Self-help, vehicle care
Changing wh eels
There may be a tyre repair kit instead of a
spare wheel – see page 242.
To ensure y our safety, m ake the following
preparations and ob serve the follow ing
inform ation when changing wheels:
z Park the vehic le on a lev el, firm and nonskid surface.
z Switch on hazard warning lig hts, ap ply
ha nd brake, automatic transm ission 3 selector lever in P, manual transm ission
or Easytronic 3 - engage 1st or reverse
gear.
Jack £
3 and vehicle tools 3
The jac k and the vehicle tools hav e been
specially dev eloped for your vehicle and
must only be used on that vehicle. Only use
jack for changing w heels.
Vehi cles w ith tyre rep air k it 3
The vehicle tools a re stored in the luggage
compartment together with the ty re rep air
kit in a compartment beneath the floor
cover.
Vehi cles w ith spare w heel 3
The jack and vehicle tools are loca ted in a
compartment in the luggag e
compartment, b eneath the spare wheel. To
rem ov e the spare w heel - see page 236.
After use, stow away the jack and tools in
the compartm ent as shown in illustration.
z Correctly set up the warning tria ngle.
Wa rning triangle – see page 234.
Self-help, vehicle care
z Remove spare wheel from luggage
com partment - see page 236.
z Before raising the v ehicle, set the front
wheels to the straight-ahead position.
z Slacken the wheel bolts one half turn
before raising the vehicle, but do not
totally unscrew the bolts.
z Nev er change more than one wheel at
once.
z Block the wheel d iagona lly opposite the
wheel to be cha nged by placing w edge
bloc ks or equivalent in front and behind
the wheel.
z Use the jack only to change wheels.
239
z If the ground on which the vehicle is
standing is soft, a solid board (max. 1 cm
thick) should b e placed under the jack 3.
Using a thicker b oard c ould dam age the
jack 3 and the vehicle.
z No people or animals may be in the
vehicle when it is jacked -up.
z Never crawl under a jacked-up vehic le.
z Do not start or run the engine while the
vehicle is on the jac k.
z Before inserting the wheel bolts when
changing wheels, lightly grease the cone
of ea ch b olt. For this reason, c arry som e
conventional grease.
1. Prise off the wheel trim using the hook
included with the vehicle tools 3 . For
vehicle tools - see p age 238.
If the wheel trim ha s visib le w heel bolts 3,
the trim ca n remain on the wheel. The
retaining washers 3 on the wheel bolts
must not be removed .
240
Self-help, vehicle care
Alloy wheels 3: Disengage the wheel bolt
caps with a screwdriv er and remove.
Protect the wheel by inserting a soft c loth
between the screwdriver and alloy
wheel.
2. Turn wheel bolts half a turn using the
wheel bolt wrench 3, p ushing the
wrench 3 on as far as possible.
3. There a re plastic retainers at the front
and rea r of the vehic le underbody for
positioning the jack. The loca tion of each
retainer is indicated by a ma rk on the
bottom ed ge of the vehicle.
Self-help, vehicle care
4. Before a ttac hing jac k 3 set to required
height by turning the eye by hand. Fit the
ja ck 3 a t the front – or rear – in such a
way that the jack head eng ages in the
plastic retainer beneath the vehicle.
Check tha t it is properly engaged.
The jack b ase must be on the ground
directly b elow the jacking point in a
manner that prevents it from slipping .
Attach crank to eye of threaded rod and
turn crank to raise v ehicle.
If this is not the case, carefully lower the
vehicle imm ediately and reposition the
jack.
5. Unscrew wheel b olts and wipe clean with
a c loth. Then apply a light coating of
grease to the wheel bolts. Do not g rease
the thread of the bolts. Do not put the
wheel bolts down in a location where
they may bec om e soiled.
If the wheel bolts hav e retaining
washers 3, they m ust not be rem ov ed.
241
6. Change the wheel. N otes on sp are
wheel – see page 236, notes on
temporary sp are wheel – see page 237.
7. Screw in wheel bolts and tighten slightly ,
inserting the wheel bolt wrench 3 as far
as possible.
8. Lower vehicle.
9. Tighten wheel bolts c rosswise, p utting on
wheel bolt wrench 3 as far as possible.
6
242
Self-help, vehicle care
10. Before refitting the wheel trim, clea n the
wheel around the retaining clips. Valve
sy mbol 3 on back of wheel trim must
point tow ards valve on wheel.
Align and refit wheel trim or w heel bolt
caps 3.
Alloy wheels 3: Align and refit wheel
bolt caps 3.
11. S tow away replaced wheel, tools and
wa rning triangle in the luggage
com partment - see pa ge 238.
12. C heck the tyre pressure of the newly
m ounted wheel. C orrect if necessary.
13. H ave the tightening torque of the wheel
bolts on the new wheel checked on the
v ehicle using a torque wrench as soon
as possible and, if nec essary , c orrected.
Tightening torque – see page 299.
14. Replace the faulty ty re on the wheel
that wa s removed.
15. Replace tem pora ry spare wheel 3 with
a full specification wheel without delay.
Tyre repair kit 3
Minor dam age to the tyre tread or side
wall, e.g . from foreign bodies, can be
repaired using the ty re repair kit.
Do not rem ove the foreign body from the
tyre.
Tyre damage exc eed ing 4 mm or that is on
the rim cannot be repaired with the ty re
repair kit.
9 Warnin g
Driv ing with tyre pressures too low or
tyres deflated c an cause invisible
damage to the tyre. This damage c annot
be eliminated with a tyre rep air kit. Park
the vehicle and contac t a workshop .
Im portant information – see pag e 246.
In the ev ent of a flat ty re:
z Switch on hazard warning lig hts,
apply handb ra ke; for automa tic
tra nsmission 3, move selector lever to P;
for manual transmission or Easytronic 3,
select 1st or rev erse gear.
z Correctly set up the warning tria ngle.
Wa rning triangle – see page 234.
Self-help, vehicle care
The ty re repair kit is in a c om partment in
the spare wheel well of the luggage
compartment.
1. Ta ke the pouch with the ty re repair kit
from the c om partment. Carefully rem ov e
the components from the p ouch.
2. Remove the compressor.
3. Remove the electrical connection cab le
and a ir hose from the stow age
compa rtm ents on the underside of the
compressor.
243
4. Screw the com pressor air hose to the
connection on the sealant bottle.
5. Fit the sealant bottle in the retainer on
the compressor.
Set the compressor near the tyre in such
a way that the sea la nt bottle is upright.
6. Remov e the valve cap from the d efec tiv e
tyre.
244
Self-help, vehicle care
7. Screw the filler hose to the tyre valv e.
8. The switch on the comp ressor must be
set to § .
9. Connect the compressor plug to the
accessory socket or cigarette lighter
sock et. Accessory socket – see pag e 93.
10. Switch on ignition.
To prev ent battery discharge, we
recomm end that y ou leave the engine
running.
11. S et the rocker switch on the compressor
to I . The tyre is filled with sealant.
12. While the sealant bottle drains (approx.
30 seconds) the pressure indicator on
the compressor briefly p oints to 6 bar
(87 psi). Pressure then sinks aga in.
13. All of the sealant is pumped into the
ty re. Afterw ards, the ty re is filled w ith
air.
14. The prescribed tyre pressure –
see pag e 299 should be reached within
10 minutes. Sw itc h off the compressor
when the correc t pressure is obtained.
If the specified ty re pressure is not
reac hed within 10 m inutes, remove the
tyre repair kit. Move the v ehicle through
one ty re rotation, approx. 2 metres, in
either direction. Reconnect the ty re
repa ir kit and continue the filling
process for 10 minutes. I f the specified
tyre pressure is still not reached, the tyre
is too bad ly damag ed. Park the vehicle
and contact a workshop.
Self-help, vehicle care
Drain ex cess ty re p ressure with the
button ov er the pressure ind icator.
Do not run the compressor for more
tha n 10 minutes - see " Important
information" on pa ge 246.
15. Detach the tyre repair k it. Screw the
filler hose to the free connection on the
sealant bottle. This prevents sealant
leak age. Stow the tyre repair kit in the
lug gage compartment.
16. Wip e aw ay any sealant spill with a
cloth.
17. Disma ntle the w arning triangle and
stow it in the luggage compartment –
see page 234.
245
18. The enclosed sticker shows the
m aximum permitted speed at which the
ty re repair m ay be used. App ly sticker in
the driver’ s field of vision.
19. C ontinue driving immediately to allow
the sealant to distrib ute evenly
throughout the tyre. Stop after approx.
6 miles / 10 km (but no more than
10 minutes) and chec k tyre pressure.
S crew the compressor air hose directly
onto the ty re v alve (see Fig. 17256 T).
As long as the tyre pressure is more
than 1.3 ba r (19 psi), it may be adjusted
to the p rescrib ed v alue. Repeat the
proced ure until there is no more
pressure loss.
If the tyre p ressure ha s fallen below
1.3 bar (19 psi), the vehicle ma y no
longer be used. Contact a w ork shop.
20. Stow the tyre repair k it in the luggage
compartment – see pag e 242.
246
Self-help, vehicle care
Im portant
9 Warning
Do not d riv e faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
Do not use the temporary spare wheel for
a lengthy period.
Steerability and d riv ing behav iour m ay
be im paired.
The d riv ing characteristics of the repa ired
tyre is severely affected, therefore have this
tyre replac ed.
If the compressor makes abnorm al noises
or heats up greatly, switch it off for at least
30 minutes.
The integrated safety valv e opens a t a
pressure of 7 bar (102 p si).
Protect the compressor from m oisture and
rain.
The sealant can only be stored for approx.
4 years. After this time, the sealing
prop erties can no longer be gua ra nteed.
Heed the exp iration date on the sealant
bottle.
The sealant bottle can only be used once.
Replace a used sealant bottle.
The compressor and seala nt c an be used
from approx. -30 °C .
Dispose of a used tyre repa ir kit in
accordance with applicable legislation.
The adap ter 3 supplied may be used to
pump up other objects, such a s b alls,
airbeds, d inghies.
This is located on the underside of the
compressor. To remove, unscrew the
compressor air hose and pull out the
adapter.
When using the ty re repair kit, no consumer
may be c onnec ted to the front ac cessory
socket at the sa me tim e.
Electrical system
9 Warnin g
Electronic ignition system s generate very
hig h voltages. Do not touch the ignition
sy stem; high voltage can b e fatal.
Fuses
There are three fusebox es in the v ehicle:
In the passenger com partment on the fa r
left of the instrument panel, in the stowage
compa rtm ent on the left in the luggag e
compa rtm ent, and at the front of the
eng ine compartm ent.
Self-help, vehicle care
We recommend c arry ing a complete set of
fuses.
Before replacing a fuse, turn off the
respective switch and the ignition.
Spa re fuses are kept on b ack of fusebox
cover in the instrument panel. For opening
cover – see nex t page.
A defective fuse (Fig. 17259 T) can be
recognised by its melted wire. A new fuse
should only be installed after the cause of
the fault has been rectified .
There is a fuse extractor on the rear of the
fusebox cover in the instrument panel for
cha ng ing fuses – see illustration ab ov e.
247
O nly install fuses of the specified rating.
Each fuse has its rating written on it, in
add ition the fuses are colour coded.
Fuse,
colour
Light brown
Dark brown
Red
Light blue
Yellow
White
Light green
Orange
Dark blue
Fuse,
rating
5A
7.5 A
10 A
15 A
20 A
25 A
30 A
40 A
60 A
248
Self-help, vehicle care
No. C ircuit
10 S teering column m odule
control unit
Ra ting
7.5 A
11 Diagnostics p lug
7.5 A
12 Battery overload protection 10 A
Fuses and the m ost importan t
circuits they protect
Some circuits may be protected by sev eral
fuses.
Fusebox in passenger compa rtment
The fusebox is on the left, on the outside of
the instrum ent panel. O pen door.
Disengage cover by p ulling firmly and
rem ov e.
No. C ircuit
1 Infotainment system, radio
transport fuse
2 Interior fan, heating, air
conditioning sy stem
3 S unroof
Spa re fuses, fuse ex tra ctor – see page 246.
Ra ting
20 A
13 –
14 –
–
–
15 Door module control unit
16 –
30 A
–
17 instruments, information
display
15 A
18 –
19 –
–
–
20 Y aw rate sensor (ESP® Pl us )
21 –
7.5 A
–
30 A
30 A
40 A
–
20 A
22 C igarette lighter
23 Interior fan, air conditioning,
Electronic Clim ate C ontrol
24 –
4 –
5 Door module control unit
–
7.5 A
25 Heating, air conditioning
system
7.5 A
6 Brake light
7 Body work module control
unit
8 Front passenger’s door
module control unit
9 C entral control unit
7.5 A
30 A
26 Instrum ents, informa tion
display
7.5 A
7.5 A
30 A
7.5 A
Self-help, vehicle care
No. C ircuit
249
Rating
11 Battery voltage
12 S eat heating, rear left
25 A
15 A
13 Towing equipment
14 Tailgate wiper
20 A
15 A
15 Heated seats, seat clim ate 15 A
control, left front
Fusebox in lugga ge compa rtment
The fusebox is loca ted on the left side of
the luggag e compa rtm ent, in the stowage
compartment.
Saloon / Hatch:
Press the latch down a nd open the cover.
Estate:
Press both latches down and open the
cover and interior trim.
Spa re fuses, fuse ex tra ctor – see page 246.
Some circuits may be protected by sev eral
fuses.
No. C ircuit
1 –
Rati ng
–
2 –
3 Electric seat adjustment,
driv er’s seat
4 H eated rear wind ow
–
40 A
5 Electric seat adjustment,
front passenger’s seat
40 A
6 Electric w indow operation,
right rear
30 A
7 Electric w indow operation,
left rear
30 A
8 S eat heating, rea r right
9 H orn, Vauxhall ala rm
system
10 Fuel p um p
40 A
15 A
15 A
20 A
16 S eat heating, front right
17 Accessory socket
15 A
15 A
18 Tailgate locking, Estate
19 Term ina l 30, Tw in Audio
30 A
10 A
20 Tank flap loc king
21 Ultrasonic sensor, Vauxhall
alarm sy stem
22 Electrically op erated
tailgate
23 Glass break age sensor
(Vauxhall alarm system )
24 Battery voltage
7. 5 A
5A
25 Electronic chassis
26 Term ina l 15 (starter
switch), Twin Audio
27 S eat occupancy
recognition, ty re pressure
monitoring sy stem, rain
sensor, air conditioning
system
10 A
25 A
28 Parking distance sensors
29 –
7. 5 A
–
30 A
7. 5 A
25 A
5A
250
Self-help, vehicle care
S om e circuits may b e protec ted by several
fuses.
No. Ci rcuit
Fusebox in engine compa rtment
The fusebox is in the box at the front of the
engine compartment.
9 Warning
Switch off engine before op ening the
fusebox in the eng ine compa rtm ent, risk
of injury.
To open, disengage front b attery c ov er
and tilt upwards.
Disenga ge the bar at the front of the cover
of fusebox and swing it upwards.
Spare fuses, fuse extractor – see p age 246.
Rating
1 Engine electronics,
transm ission elec tronics
20 A
2 Starter
3 Horn
25 A
20 A
4 Air conditioning system ,
Electronic Climate Control
10 A
5 Wind screen wa sh system,
front and rear
15 A
6 Diesel fuel filter heating
30 A
Self-help, vehicle care
No. Ci rcuit
251
Rat ing
27 Easy tronic
30 A
28 Tailgate module control unit 60 A
29 ABS
40 A
30 Tailgate module control unit 60 A
31 Vehicle interior module
control unit
60 A
32 ABS
40 A
33 Vehicle interior module
60 A
control unit
34 Tailgate module control unit 60 A
No. Circuit
R ating
7 Central control unit, ESP® Pl us 15 A
8 Headlights, windscreen
wash nozzles
1)
Ra ting
–
18 –
19 Adap tiv e Forward Lighting ,
headlight range ad justment
20 H eadlight rang e adjustment
–
15 A
5A
5A
11 Windscreen wiper
30 A
12 Central control unit, ESP® Pl us 7.5 A
21 –
22 Windscreen wiper
–
30 A
13 Headlight w ash system
14 Oxy gen sensor
30 A
10 A
23 Auxiliary heating
20 A
24 Ba ttery v oltage, terminal 30 30 A
15 Engine control unit 1 )
16 ABS
10 A
5A
25 Ba ttery v oltage, terminal 30 30 A
26 –
–
9 Power steering, brake servo
10 Ad aptive Forward Lighting
10 A
No. C ircuit
17 –
7.5 A
10 A
The b ra ke lights a re on all the time if the fus e
is d efective an d the ignitio n is switched on.
35 Cooling fan 1)
30 A
40 A
36 Cooling fan 1)
20 A
30 A
Brake servo
30 A
37 Adaptive Forw ard Lighting: Insert
Slot for changing to
any
symmetrical dipped beam
max ifor driving abroad fuse
see page 136
38 –
1 ) Depen ding on eng in e.
–
252
Self-help, vehicle care
Headl ight ai ming
We recommend that headlight adjustm ent
be carried out by a workshop which w ill
have special equipment.
Bulb replacement
Before replacing a bulb , switch ignition off
and switch relevant switch off.
O nly hold new b ulb at base. Do not touch
the b ulb glass with b are hands, otherwise
fingerprints on the glass evap orate.
Residue builds up on the reflector
eventually resulting in a dull reflector.
Inadvertently stained bulbs may b e
cleaned with a clean non-fluffy cloth, using
alcohol or white spirits.
Replacem ent bulb m ust be in accordance
with d ata on base of defective bulb. Do not
exceed wa tta ge g iv en on bulb b ase.
Manual headlight range a djustment 3
must be set to 0 when adjusting the
hea dlights.
To c hange the lights on the left-hand side,
remove filler neck from windscreen wash
sy stem fluid container to gain better
access: disengage reta ining c la mp and
withdra w filler nec k by pulling upw ards.
Wash fluid may escape if the bottle is full.
9 Warning
Protect the environment. Do not allow
wash fluid to seep into the ground or
drain into the sewage sy stem.
As the headlight has to be rem ov ed, have
the bulb on the rig ht cha nged by a
work shop.
Self-help, vehicle care
Halogen headlight system ,
dipped and main beam
Di pped beam
Headlights with separate system s for main
beam 1 (inner bulbs) and dipped beam 2
(outer bulbs).
2. To change the bulb on the left, remove
filler neck from windscreen wash sy stem
fluid container - see pag e 252. As the
hea dlight has to b e removed , have the
bulb on the right cha ng ed b y a
workshop .
1. O pen bonnet.
3. Turn the hea dlight cover a nticlockw ise
and remove.
253
4. Push down bulb at bulb hold er.
6
254
Self-help, vehicle care
5. Remove the bulb hold er with bulb from
the reflector.
6. Detach bulb from bulb mounting.
Ma in beam
7. I nsert new bulb into bulb m ounting,
without touc hing the glass.
1. Open bonnet.
8. I nsert new bulb so that the two lugs on
the bulb mounting engage in the
recesses in the reflector.
9. Engage the bulb holder.
10. Reposition the headlight cover a nd turn
it c lock wise.
11. After cha ng ing the bulb on the left,
insert and engage filler nec k for
windscreen wa sh sy stem fluid container
- see p age 252.
2. To chang e the bulb on the left, rem ove
filler neck from windsc reen w ash system
fluid container - see page 252. As the
headlight has to be remov ed, ha ve the
bulb on the right changed by a
workshop.
3. Turn the headlight cover anticlockwise
and rem ov e.
4. Detach plug connector from bulb .
Self-help, vehicle care
5. Press spring wire clip forwards,
diseng age to the right and open.
6. Remove bulb from reflector housing.
7. When fitting a new bulb, engage the
lugs in the recesses on the reflector
without touc hing the glass.
8. Engage spring wire clip, plug connector
onto bulb.
9. Reposition the headlight cover a nd turn
it c lock wise.
10. After cha ng ing the bulb on the left,
insert and engage filler nec k for
windscreen wa sh sy stem fluid container
- see p age 252.
255
Xenon headlight system,
dipped and main beam
Headlights with separate sy stems for main
beam 1 (inner bulbs) and dipped beam 2
(outer bulbs).
Dipp ed beam
9 Warnin g
The dipped beam work s with very hig h
electric al voltage. Do not touc h, risk of
fatal injury. Have bulbs changed by a
workshop.
6
256
Self-help, vehicle care
Mai n bea m
1. Open bonnet.
2. To cha nge the bulb on the left, remov e
filler neck from windscreen wa sh system
fluid container - see page 252. As the
headlight has to be removed, hav e the
bulb on the right changed by a
work shop.
3. Turn the headlight cover anticlockwise
and remov e.
4. Detach plug connector from b ulb.
5. Press sp ring w ire clip forwards,
disengage to the rig ht and open.
6. Remove bulb from reflector housing.
7. When fitting a new bulb, eng age the
lugs in the rec esses on the reflector
without touching the g lass.
8. Engag e sp ring wire clip, p lug connector
onto bulb .
9. Reposition the head lig ht cover and turn
it clockwise.
10. After changing the bulb on the left,
insert and eng age filler neck for
windscreen wash system fluid container
- see page 252.
Self-help, vehicle care
257
Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL)
system 3
Xenon headlight system for main and
dipped beam together with curve
illumination b ased on steering ang le.
9 Warning
Xenon headlights operate at very high
volta ge. Do not touc h, risk of fatal injury.
Only hav e bulbs for dipped beam, main
beam , turn lig hting, parking lights and
turn signal lights c hanged by a
work shop.
Halogen headlight system,
Xenon headlight system,
parkin g lights
1. O pen bonnet.
2. To change the bulb on the left, remove
filler neck from windscreen wash sy stem
fluid container - see pag e 252. As the
hea dlight has to b e removed , have the
bulb on the right cha ng ed b y a
workshop .
3. Turn the hea dlight cover a nticlockw ise
and remove.
4. Remov e pa rk ing light bulb holder from
reflector.
6
258
Self-help, vehicle care
Halogen headlight system,
Xenon headlight system,
front turn signal lights
Have bulbs changed by a workshop.
Side turn signal lights
Have bulbs changed by a workshop.
Front fog ligh ts
3
Have bulbs changed by a workshop.
5. Remove bulb from socket.
Tail lights
6. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
Sa loon / Hatch
1. To open the stowage compa rtm ent,
press down bar and op en the cov er.
7. Insert socket in reflector, position
headlight cover and turn clockwise.
8. After changing the bulb on the left, insert
and engage filler neck for windscreen
wash system fluid container see pa ge 252.
Self-help, vehicle care
259
4. Remove bulb from socket.
5. Insert new bulb without touching the
glass. Fit bulb mounting into bulb
housing. C onnect plug. Close stow age
compa rtm ent.
2. Detach plug connector from b ulb
mounting.
3. Press the two retaining lugs on outer
edges of bulb mounting towa rd s each
other and rem ove b ulb mounting.
Lights from top to bottom:
Turn sig nal light
Tail light/brake light
Tail light
Fog tail light
Reversing light
Est ate
1. Open the com partment on the left or
right-hand side by pressing the latch
down – see pag e 235.
2. Hold the b ulb housing from the outsid e,
use a w heel bolt spanner 3 to loosen the
retaining nuts and unscrew them by
ha nd . Remove the bulb housing to the
rear. Wheel bolt spanner 3 – see vehicle
tools on page 238.
3. Detach the cab le from the bulb housing .
6
260
Self-help, vehicle care
4. Und o the three screws using a
screwdriver and deta ch the bulb
mounting.
5. Remove bulb from socket. Bulb s in b ulb
holder:
1
2
=
=
Brake/tail lig ht
Turn signal light
6. Fit a new bulb without touching the
glass. R efit the b ulb mounting a nd screw
it into plac e. Position the bulb housing in
the v ehicle b od y and screw it into place.
C lose the compa rtm ent in the side trim.
Tailgate lights
Due to the large am ount of effort required,
bulbs should b e replaced by a workshop.
1. Use a screw driver to p rise off the plastic
plugs in the tailgate panelling to the
right and left of the tailgate lock .
Self-help, vehicle care
2. Und o screws in handle of inner panelling
with torx screwdriver.
3. Remove the inner panelling and clip s
from the tailgate.
4. Unscrew c orresponding holder:
1
2
3
=
=
=
Reversing light
Fog tail light
Reversing light
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Fit a new bulb without touching the
glass. Refit the mounting in the tailgate.
7. Refit the inner panelling to the tailgate
using the clips. Tighten the sc rew in the
handle. Refit the plastic plugs in the
openings.
Lights in electrically operated ta ilg ate 3
Have bulbs replaced by a workshop.
261
Number plate ligh t
1. Insert screw driver vertically in b ulb insert
as shown in illustration. Press to the side
and release spring.
6
262
Self-help, vehicle care
2. Remove bulb housing downw ards,
ta king care not to pull on the cable.
4. Rotate bulb holder to left and
disengage.
3. Lift flap and disconnect plug from bulb
socket.
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb, without touc hing the
glass.
7. Insert light holder in b ulb housing and
eng age by rotating clockwise.
8. C onnec t plug to bulb socket.
9. Insert and engage bulb housing.
Courtesy light
Front courtesy l ight, read ing light s 3
To ensure that no power is supp lied to the
lights, close the doors before removing.
1. Lever the lens out of the housing
recesses.
Self-help, vehicle care
2. Remove bulb from socket.
3. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
4. Mount lens and engage in position.
Rear court esy lights 3,
rear readi ng lights 3
Hav e bulbs changed by a workshop .
Glove comp artm ent l ighting,
luggag e c om part ment light ing,
footwell lig hting 3
To ensure that no power is supplied to the
lig hts, close the doors or hold the contact
switch depressed before removing.
1. Prise the lig ht out with a screwdriver.
263
2. Press b ulb slightly towards spring clip
and rem ov e.
3. Insert new b ulb, without touching the
glass.
4. Insert light in opening and engage in
position.
I nstrum ent illumi na tion,
inform ation di sp lay illumina tion 3
Hav e b ulbs changed by a workshop.
264
Self-help, vehicle care
Vehicle care
When caring for your vehicle, observe all
nationa l environmental regulations,
particularly when washing it.
Regula r, thorough care helps to imp rov e
the a ppearance of your vehicle and
maintain its value ov er the years. It is also
a p rerequisite for warranty claims for any
paint or corrosion dam age. The following
pages contain tip s for vehicle care which, if
used properly, w ill help comba t the
unavoidable damag ing effects of the
env ironment.
Vehicle ca re a ids 3
Vehicle wash:
z Wash brush,
z C ar Shampoo,
z C ar Sponges,
z Insect Removal Sponge,
z Wheel Cleaners,
z Engine Cleaners,
z Glass Clea ners,
z C ham ois Lea ther.
Vehicle care:
z Paintwork Cleaner,
z Paintwork Polish,
z C ream Polish,
z Metallic Paintw ork Wax,
z Hard wax,
z Touch-up pens,
z Touch-U p/Aerosol Paint,
z Wheel Preserver,
z Insect Remover,
z Window Cleaning Spray ,
z Lock C ylinder Grease,
z Alloy Wheel Cleaner,
z Alloy Wheel Preserver,
z Rust Preventa tiv e,
z Vauxhall De-icer Spray ,
z Vauxhall Wind screen Wash Solvent,
z Silicone Oil for Rubber Seals.
Interior care:
z Interior/Upholstery Cleaner.
Washing
The paintwork of your vehicle is exposed to
env ironmental influenc es, e.g. c ontinuous
changes in w eather conditions, industrial
waste gases and dust or thawing salts, so
wash a nd wax your vehicle regularly . When
using autom atic car wa shes, select a
programm e w hich includes w axing.
Bird d ropp ings, dead insec ts, resin, pollen
and the like should be cleaned off
imm ediately, a s they contain aggressive
constituents which can ca use paint
dam age.
Plea se follow the wash system
ma nufacturer’s instructions when using
wash systems. The windscreen wip er and
the automatic wiper with rain sensor 3 and
the rear window wiper 3 must be switched
off - see pages 11, 126. Unscrew the
antenna rod 3 and the roof rac k 3,
standing on the door sill to make them
easier to rea ch.
If y ou wash your vehicle by hand, make
sure that the insides of the wings are also
thoroughly rinsed out.
Self-help, vehicle care
Clean edges and folds on opened doors
and flaps as well as the areas they cover.
Thoroughly rinse off and leather-off the
vehic le. R inse leather frequently. Use
separate lea thers for pa int a nd window
surfaces: remnants of wa x on the windows
will impa ir vision.
O bserve na tional regulations.
Waxing
Wax y our vehicle regularly, in particula r
after it ha s b een washed using Car
Shamp oo and at the latest when water no
longer forms beads on the paintwork,
otherwise the paintwork will dry out.
Also wax edges and folds on opened doors
and flaps as well as the areas they cover.
Pol ishi ng
Polishing is necessa ry only if the paint has
become dull or if solid deposits have
become attached to it.
Pa intwork polish with silic one form s a
protective film , ma king waxing
unnec essary .
Plastic body parts should not be treated
with wax a nd polish.
Use Metallic Paintw ork Wa x on vehic les
with a metallic-effect paint finish.
Wheels
Use a p H-neutral wheel clea ning a gent to
clean the wheels.
Wheels are painted a nd can be treated
with the sam e agents as the body . For a lloy
wheels we recommend use of Alloy Wheel
Preserver.
265
Paintw ork d amag e
Repair minor paintwork da mage such as
stone chips, scratches etc. immediately
using the Touch-up pen or Touch-Up/
Aerosol Paint before rust forms. If rust has
already formed, hav e a workshop
elimina te the cause. Also check the
surfac es and edges facing the road surface
on which rust may hav e develop ed for
some tim e unnoticed.
Exterior lights
Headlight and other protectiv e light bezels
are made of plastic. If they require
add itional cleaning after the vehicle has
been wa shed , clean them w ith C ar
S ham poo. Do not use any a brasiv e or
caustic agents, do not use an ice scraper,
and d o not clean them dry.
266
Self-help, vehicle care
Plastic and rubb er p arts
For additiona l cleaning of plastic and
rubber parts use Interior/Upholstery
Cleaner. Do not use any other ag ent, and
in particular do not use solvents or petrol.
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners on
plastic and rubber parts.
Wheels and tyres
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners on
wheels and tyres.
Interior and upholstery
Clean the v ehicle interior, includ ing the
instrument panel facia, using I nterior/
Upholstery C leaner.
The instrum ent panel should only be
cleaned using a soft damp cloth.
Clean fabric upholstery with a vacuum
cleaner and b rush. To rem ove stains, use
Interior/U pholstery Clea ner that is suitable
for both fabrics and vinyl.
Do not use cleaning agents such a s
acetone, tetrachloride, p aint thinner, paint
rem ov er, na il varnish remover, washing
powder or bleach. Petrol is also unsuitable.
O pen Velcro fasteners on clothing could
dam age seat upholstery . Mak e sure that
Velcro fasteners are closed.
Seat belts
Alw ays keep seat belts clean and dry.
Clea n only w ith lukewarm water or Interior/
Upholstery Cleaner.
Wi nd ows
When cleaning the heated rear w indow,
make sure that the hea ting element on the
inside of the window is not dama ged.
Use a soft lint-free c loth or cham ois leather
in conjunction with Window Cleaning Spray
and Insect Remover.
Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent is
suitable for de-icing windows.
For mechanical rem oval of ice, use a
commerc ia lly availab le sharp-edg ed ice
scraper. Press the scraper firmly ag ainst
the glass so that no dirt c an get under it
and scra tch the glass.
Windscreen wiper b lades
Wax, such as that used in car w ashes, can
cause strea king on the windscreen when
the wiper is used.
S mearing wiper blades c an be cleaned with
a soft cloth and Vauxhall Wind screen
Wash Solvent, and rep la ced if necessary –
see page 277.
Locks
The locks are lubricated with a high-quality
Lock C ylinder Grease in the fa ctory . O nly
use de-icer in urgent cases, since it has a
de-greasing effect and affects the
operation of the locks. Hav e the locks
regreased in a workshop after using
de-icer.
Engine compa rtment
Area s of the eng ine compartment that are
painted in the same colour as the vehicle
must b e look ed after like any other painted
surfac e.
It is ad visab le to wa sh the engine
compa rtm ent before and after winter and
preserve it with wax. Cover alternator and
brak e fluid reservoir with plastic sheets
before washing the engine.
Self-help, vehicle care
When washing the engine w ith a steam jet,
do not direct the jet at components of the
Anti-lock Brake Sy stem (ABS), the air
conditioning system 3, the Electronic
Clim ate C ontrol system 3, the auxiliary
heater 3 or the belt drive or its
components.
Engine washing also rem ov es subsequently
applied protec tiv e wa x. Therefore after
washing, have a workshop protect the
engine, parts of the b ra king sy stem in the
engine bay, axle elements with steering ,
body elements and cav ities, thoroughly
with protective wax .
An engine wash can be performed in the
spring in ord er to remove dirt that has
adhered to the engine compartment,
which may also ha ve a high sa lt content.
Check p rotective wax layer and make good
if necessary.
Do not use high-pressure jet clea ners in the
engine compartment.
267
Underbody
Your vehicle has a factory-app lied PVC
undercoating in the wheel arches
(including the longitudinal mem bers) which
prov ides permanent protec tion and needs
no special maintenance.
C aution - c om mercially available bitumen/
rubber materials can damage the PVC
coating. We recom mend that y ou ha ve
underbody w ork carried out by a work shop
which knows the p rescrib ed materials and
has ex perienc e in the use thereof.
The surfaces of the vehicle underb od y not
covered by PVC are provided a durable
protective wax coating in critic al areas.
The underbody should be washed
following the end of the cold weather
season to remov e any dirt adhering to the
underbody since this may also contain salt.
C heck p rotective wax c oa ting and , if
nec essary , have it restored to perfec t
condition.
On vehicles which are washed frequently in
autom atic car washes with underbody
washing facility, the protective wax
coating may b e impaired by d irt-dissolv ing
additives, so check the underbody after
washing and ha ve it waxed if necessary .
Before the start of the cold weather season,
check the PVC c oa ting a nd protective wax
coating and, if necessary , have them
restored to perfect condition.
268
Service, maintenanc e
Service, maintenance
Inspection system .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Genuine Vauxhall Parts and
Accessories ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
A note on safety .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Checking and topping up fluids ... ..... .
Engine oil . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Diesel fuel filter .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Coolant .... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Brake fluid ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Wind screen wiper .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Wind screen and headlight wash
sy stems 3.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Battery ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Protecting electronic components .... .
Vehicle decomm issioning. ..... .... .... ..... .
Vehicle recommissioning.. ..... .... .... ..... .
270
In our ex perience, the most com mon cause
of all complaints is the result of
misunderstanding or lack of
communication betw een the customer a nd
the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
We sincerely hope y ou will never have
cause to complain ab out y our vehicle.
However, if things do go wrong, the best
course of action for y ou to ta ke is to
contact your Vaux hall Authorised
Repairer’s Serv ice Reception S taff and
exp la in the difficulty you are having. We
are confident they will d o their utmost to
resolv e the problem to your complete
satisfaction.
271
271
271
272
274
274
276
277
Sometim es, howev er, despite the best of
intentions of all concerned,
misunderstandings can occur. If y our
prob lem has not been resolved to y our
satisfaction, please make an appointment
to discuss the matter with the M ana ger of
the department c oncerned.
279
280
280
281
281
Should you wish to pursue the matter
further, the Principal of the Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer should be made
aware of your concern. It is ad visab le in
cases such as this to write to him to confirm
your problem and the solutions that have
been offered.
The majority of areas of concern can be
quic kly resolved in this way.
You can be assured the Authorised
Repairer’s Principal w ill only be too anxious
to fully inv estigate y our prob lems and
correct any errors mad e. After all, he has a
large investment in his business a nd is
proud of his reputation and
professionalism and fully realises that
satisfied customers are his key to success.
In the unlikely event that you are still not
happy with the answer your Vaux hall
Authorised Repa irer has given, or the
action he proposes to c orrect the problem ,
y ou m ay contact the Custom er C are
Department 1 ) where a team of C ustomer
C are C onsultants will spare no effort to
ensure y our complete satisfaction.
Vauxhall Motor s Ltd.
C ustomer Care,
Griffin House,
O sborne Road
LUTON ,
Beds. , LU1 3Y T
Telephone: 0845 090 2044
They w ill review all the facts involved. Then
if it is felt some further action can be tak en,
the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer will b e
adv ised accordingly. In any case, y our
contact will b e ac knowledged confirm ing
Vauxhall Motors’ position in the m atter.
If y ou are not satisfied with the outcome,
y ou ca n if you wish, seek advice from an
independent third p arty suc h as:
Autom obile Association (A. A. )
Fanum House, Basing View,
BASI NGSTO KE,
Hants., R G21 4EA
1)
Ca lls may b e mon itored a nd record ed for
training purpo ses.
Service, mainten ance
Royal Autom obile Club (R.A.C. ),
R.A.C . Motoring Services Ltd.
89-91 Pall Mall,
LON DO N, SW1Y 5HS
General Motors Belgium N.V.
Noordelaan 401 - Haven 500
2030 Antw erp – Belgium
Tel. 00 32-34 50 63 29
The C ustomer Rela tions Depa rtm ent,
Soci ety of Motor Manufacturers and
Traders Ltd. (S .M.M. T.),
Forbes House, Ha lk in Street,
LON DO N, SW1X 7DS
General Motors Southeast Europe
org. slož ka
Olbrachtova 9
140 00 Prague – C zech Republ ic
Tel. 00 420-2 39 004 321
Customer C omplaints Serv ice,
Scot tish Motor Trad e A ssocia tion,
(S.M .T.A.),
3 Palmerston Place,
EDI NBURGH, EH12 5AQ
General Motors Danmark
Jaegersborg Alle 4
2920 C harlottenlund – Denm ark
Tel. 00 45-39 97 85 00
The N ationa l Conciliation Service,
Retail Motor Ind ust ry Fed era tion,
9 North Street,
RUBGY , CV21 2AB
If you have a p roblem w hilst abroa d:
The S ervice Departments of Adam Opel
GmbH and General Motors branches
everyw here will provide information and
assistance:
Vauxhall M otors Ltd .
Customer Ca re
Griffin House, O sborne Road
Luton, Bedfor dshi re, LU1 3YT – Engla nd
Tel. 00 44-845 090 2044
General Motors Finland Oy
Pa juniityntie 5
00320 Helsinki – Finl and
Tel. 00 358-9 817 101 47
In Luxemb ourg please contact the
General Motors S ervice Department in
Antwerp – Belg ium
Telephone: 00 32-34 50 63 29
General Motors Franc e
1 – 9, avenue du M arais
Angle Q ua i de Bezons
95101 Argenteuil C edex – France
Tel. 00 33-1-34 26 30 51
General Motors Austria GmbH
Groß-Enzersdorfer S tr. 59
1220 Vi enna – Austria
Tel. 00 43-1-2 88 77 444 or
00 43-1-2 88 77 0
ADAM OPEL Gm bH
Bahnhofsp la tz 1
65423 Rüsselsheim – Germ any
Tel. 00 49-61 42-77 50 00 or
00 49-61 42-7 70
General Motors Hellas S. A.
56 Kifisia s Av enue & Delfon str.
Amarousion
151 25 Athens – Greece
Tel. 00 30-1-6 80 65 01
General Motors Southeast Europe Ltd.
S zabadsag utca 117
2040 Budaörs – H ung ary
Tel. 00 36-23 446 100
General Motors India
S ix th Floor, Tower A
Global Business Park
Mehra uli – Gurgaon Road
Gurga on 122 022, Haryana – I ndia
Tel. 00 91-124 280 3333
General Motors Ireland Ltd.
O pel House, Unit 60, Heather Road
Sa ndyford , Dublin 18 – Ireland
Tel. 00 353 1-216 10 00
General Motors Italia Srl
Piazza le dell’Industria 40
00144 Rome – It aly
Tel. 00 39-06-5 46 51
General Motors Ned erland B. V.
Lage Mosten 49 – 63
4822 NK Breda – N et herla nds
Tel. 00 31-76-5 44 83 00
General Motors Norge AS
K jeller-Vest 6
2027 Kj el ler – Norw ay
Tel. 00 47-23 50 01 04
General Motors Poland Sp. z o. o.
Wołoska 5
06- 675 Wa rsa w – Pola nd
Tel. 00 48-22-606 17 00
269
270
Service, maintenanc e
General Motors Portugal
Q uinta d a Fonte
Ed ificío Fernão M agalhães, Piso 2
2780-190 Pa ço d’Arc os – Portugal
Tel. 00 351- 21 440 75 00
data is continually gathered and is used to
calculate the remaining distanc e until the
nex t service.
The remaining distanc e can be seen in the
odometer display when the ignition is off:
Press the reset button next to the trip
odometer. InSP and the remaining distance
will be displayed.
General Motors S outheast Europe
org. z ložk a
Apollo Business Centre
Mlynské Nivy 45
821 09 Bra tislav a - Slov aki a
Tel. 00 421-2 58 275 543
General Motors España S. L.
Paseo de la C astellana, 91
28046 M adrid – Spa in
Tel. 00 34-902 25 00 25
General Motors N orden AB
Årstaä ngv ägen 17
100 73 S tockhol m – S weden
Tel. 00 46-20 333 000
General Motors S uisse S .A.
Stelzenstraße 4
8152 Glatt brugg – Swit zerland
Tel. 00 41-44 828 28 80
General Motors Türkiy e Ltd. S ti.
Kemalpa sa y olu üz eri
35861 Torb ali / Izmir – Turkey
Tel. 00 90-2 32-8 53-14 53
In Alb ania, Bosnia-H erzegovina ,
Bulga ria, C roatia, Estonia, La tvia ,
Lithuania, Macedonia, Romania ,
Serbia -Monteneg ro and Sl ov enia
please contact the
General Motors S ervice Department in
Budaörs – Hungary
Tel. 00 36-23 446 100
In spec tion system
In order to guarantee econom ical and safe
vehicle operation and to m ainta in the
value of y our v ehicle, it is of vital
importanc e that all maintenance work is
carried out at the proper intervals.
For vehicles with strict engine oil c hange
and service intervals, before servic ing is
due the disp la y InS P appea rs on the
od om eter disp la y after the ignition ha s
been sw itched on and off: Ha ve your next
service carried out by a workshop within
one week or 300 miles (500 km ).
The service interval display takes account
of off-the-road p eriods during which the
battery is d isconnected.
For vehicles with flex ible oil change and
service intervals, the length of these
intervals is based on sev eral para meters
stemming from usage.
For this reason, various engine-spec ific
If the rema ining d istance is less than
1000 miles (1500 km ), InSP is displayed
with a remaining distance of 600 miles
(1000 k m) when the ignition is switched on.
I nS P is display ed for several seconds if the
remaining distance is less tha n 300 miles
(500 km ). Have service work that is d ue
carried out within one week or 300 miles
(500 km ). Have this work carried out by a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer in order to
av oid inv alidation of warranty claims.
Further information on maintenance and
the inspection system can be found in the
S ervice Booklet, found in the glove
compa rtm ent.
Hav e ma intena nce work – and repair work
on the body and the eq uipm ent – carried
out professionally by a work shop. We
recommend using your Vauxhall
Authorised Repa irer, who has excellent
knowledge of Vauxhall v ehicles and has
the necessary special tools and up-to-date
S ervice Instructions from Vauxhall. It is
particularly a dvisable to use a Vauxhall
Authorised Repa irer during the wa rra nty
period in order to prevent loss of w arra nty .
Further information can b e found in the
S ervice Booklet.
Service, mainten ance
271
Separ ate anti-cor rosion servi ce
Hav e this work carried out according to the
intervals spec ified in the S ervice Booklet.
Genuine Vauxhall Parts and
Accessories
We recommend that you use " Genuine
Vauxhall Parts a nd Accessories" and
conversion parts approved ex pressly for
your vehicle ty pe. These parts have
undergone special tests to establish their
reliab ility , safety and specific suitability for
Vauxhall vehicles. Despite continuous
market monitoring, we cannot assess or
guarantee these attributes for other
products, ev en if they have been granted
approva l by the relevant authorities or in
som e other form.
"Genuine Vaux ha ll Pa rts and Ac cessories"
and conversion parts approved by
Vauxhall can be obtained from your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can
provide ex pert a dvice on permitted
tec hnical c hanges and ensure correct
installation.
A note on safety
To avoid injury from moving p arts a nd
cables conducting ignition volta ge, only
carry out engine compartment checks
(e.g. checking brake fluid or engine oil
level) when the ignition is switched off.
9 Warning
The cooling fan is controlled by a
thermoswitch and ca n therefore start
unexp ectedly even if the ignition is
switched off. Risk of injury.
Electronic ignition systems generate very
high voltages. Do not touch the ignition
system; hig h voltage can be fatal.
N ever carry out any repairs or adjustment
and m aintenance work on the vehicle
y ourself. This especially applies to the
eng ine, chassis and safety parts. You may
unwittingly infringe the p rov isions of the
law and, by not performing the work
properly , endanger y ourself and other
road users.
Checking and topping u p fluids
To aid identification, the cap s used when
topping up engine oil, coolant and wash
fluid as well as the oil dipstick handle may
be coloured y ellow.
272
Service, maintenanc e
Engine oil
Information on engine oils is found in the
Service Booklet.
Eng ine oi l level and consum ption
Ev ery engine consumes engine oil for
tec hnical reasons. The engine oil
consump tion cannot be assessed until a
fairly long distance has been driv en, a nd
may be a bove the specified value when the
vehic le is first b eing driven (run-in period ).
Frequent d riv ing at high revs increases
engine oil consumption.
9 Warning
In vehicles with engine oil level
monitoring 3 , the engine oil level is
monitored automatically - see page 103.
It is advisable to check the oil lev el b efore
setting out on long journeys.
9 Warning
Imp ortant: It is the owner’ s responsibility
to maintain the correct level of a n
appropriate quality oil in the engine.
Engine oil level check , topp ing up engine
oil
The illustrations on this p age show
examples of the checks for various petrol
and diesel engines. Fig. 17780 J on the next
pag e shows the check s for engine
Z 30 DT 1).
The oil level must be checked with the
vehicle on a level surface and w ith the
eng ine (which must be at operating
temperature) switched off. Wait at least
5 minutes before chec king the level to
allow the norm al engine oil accumulation
in the engine to d rain into the oil pan.
Do not allow the engine oil to drop below
the minimum level.
1)
Sales des ig nation – see p ag e 284, 285.
Service, mainten ance
To check the engine oil level, insert wiped
oil dipstick into dipstick tube as far as it will
go. Top engine oil up if the lev el has
dropped into the range of the top -up m ark
MIN .
The engine oil level must not exceed the
upper mark M AX on the dipstic k. Excess
engine oil must be drained off or extracted.
If the engine oil level is above the MAX
mark there is a risk of damage to the
engine or the ca ta lytic converter.
The a mount filled must be between
the M IN and MAX marks – see p age 308.
Top up with the same brand of engine oil
that was used during the previous oil
cha ng e, following the instruc tions in the
Serv ic e Booklet.
To close, position the cap and screw it into
place.
Capacities – see page 308.
273
Engine oil change, oi l filter chang e
C ha nge oil at a work shop according to the
service interva l shown on the display .
We recommend that you use g enuine
eng ine oil filters.
9 Warnin g
Wa ste engine oil cannot b e disposed of
with domestic refuse. Observ e the lega l
requirem ents for d isposal of old oil and
filters to protect the environment and
your health.
274
Service, maintenanc e
Diesel fuel filter
Coo lant
O n each engine oil change, have the fuel
filter checked for any water residue by a
workshop.
The glycol-ba sed coolant provides
exc ellent corrosion protection for the
heating and cooling systems as well
as anti-freeze protection down to ap prox .
-28 °C . It remains in the cooling system
throughout the year and need not b e
cha ng ed.
For engines 1) Z 19 DT, Z 19 DTL and
Z 19 DTH , control indica tor A illuminates
if there is water in the diesel fuel filter.
Hav e fuel filter checked at shorter intervals
if the v ehicle is subjected to extrem e
opera ting conditions such as hig h humidity
(primarily in coastal areas), extrem ely high
or low outside temperatures a nd
sub stantially v arying day tim e a nd nig httime temp eratures.
Use of certain a nti-freezes ca n lead to
engine dam age. We therefore rec om mend
that you use only approved anti-freezes.
9 Warning
Anti-freeze is a danger to health; it m ust
therefore be k ept in the original conta iner
and out of the reach of children.
Anti -freeze a nd corrosion prot ect ion
Before the start of winter, have a work shop
check the anti-freeze protection. The antifreeze level must guarantee protection
down to a pprox. -28 °C. Insufficient antifreeze will reduce the frost p rotection level
and the corrosion protection. If necessary
add anti-freeze.
If c oolant loss is topped up with wa ter,
have concentration checked and a dd antifreeze if necessary.
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ge 28 4, 285.
Service, mainten ance
275
When the engine is at op erating
temperature, coolant lev el rises. It falls
aga in when the system cools. If it falls
below the KALT/C OLD mark when the
system is cold, top up to the mark.
Top up a nti-freeze. If no anti-freeze is
av ailable, top up with clean tap water. If
tap water is unavailable, distilled water
can b e used.
Coola nt level
Hardly any losses occur since the cooling
system is sealed and it is thus rarely
necessary to top up the c oolant.
4-cylinder petrol and diesel engines: When
the cooling system is c old , the c oolant level
in the expansion tank should be slightly
above the KALT/C OLD mark. C oolant level
can be read off from the outsid e of the
expansion tank.
For V6 petrol and d iesel engines, the
exp ansion tank must be opened in ord er to
check coolant level. When the c ooling
sy stem is cold, the coolant should be up to
the CO LD mark on the filler opening.
9 Warning
Allow engine to cool down before
rem oving coola nt filler cap . Rem ov e filler
cap carefully so that p ressure can escape
slow ly, otherwise there is a risk of
scalding.
After filling with tap water or d istilled
water, measure the anti-freeze
concentration and ad d anti-freez e if
required. H ave a workshop establish the
cause of the coolant loss.
Too low a coolant level can cause engine
dam age.
To close, position the cap and screw it into
place.
6
276
Service, maintenanc e
Coola nt temperat ure
If the temperature ga uge enters the righthand (wa rning) z one or control indic ator W
illuminates, check the coolant level
immediately .
Use of certain brake fluids can lead to
dam age or reduced braking effect. We
therefore rec om mend that you use only
high performa nce app roved b ra ke fluid.
Extrem e cleanliness is needed when
topping up, since contamination in the
brak e fluid can c ause brake sy stem
ma lfunctions.
z Coolant level too low:
Top up coolant, noting the instructions
given under "Anti-freeze and corrosion
protection" and "C oolant level". H ave
the cause of the coolant loss rectified by
a workshop.
z Coolant level O K:
Have the cause of the elevated coolant
temperature rectified. C ontac t a
work shop.
After c orrecting the brak e fluid level, have
a work shop eliminate the cause of the
brak e fluid loss.
Brake fluid
Brake fluid lev el
9 Warning
Brake fluid is poisonous and corrosiv e. Do
not allow it to come into contact with
eyes, skin, fab ric or painted surfaces.
Direct contac t could cause injury and
dam age.
The fluid lev el in the reservoir must be
neither higher than the MAX mark nor
low er than the M IN m ark.
Service, mainten ance
Brak e fluid chang e
Brake fluid is hy groscopic, i.e. it absorbs
water. If the brakes b ecome hot, suc h as
when d riv ing on long downhill stretches,
vap our bubb les can occur in the w ater,
which can have an extrem ely adverse
effect on braking power (depending on the
proportion of w ater).
Windscreen wiper
The fluid change intervals specified in the
Service Booklet m ust therefore be
observed.
If the windscreen is dirty, operate the
wind screen wash system before switching
on the windscreen wiper or setting the
wiper to automatic operation with the rain
sensor 3. This will avoid w iper blad e wear.
9 Warning
Have the brak e fluid changed by a
work shop. O bserve the legal
requirements for disposal of brake fluid
to protect the environment and your
health.
Clea r vision is essential for safe driv ing.
Perform regular checks on the windscreen
wiper a nd headlight wash system 3 to
ensure they are operating correctly. We
recommend wiper blade rep la cement at
least once a year.
Do not switch on the wind screen wiper or
set the wiper to automatic operation with
the rain sensor 3 if the w indscreen is iced
up as this could da mage the wiper blades
or the wiper sy stem.
277
If the wiper bec om es frozen on to the glass,
we recomm end that it be released with the
aid of De-icer Spray.
S mearing wiper blades c an be cleaned with
a soft cloth and Vauxhall Wind screen
Wash Solvent.
Wiper blades whose lips have become
hardened, crack ed or covered with silicone
must be replac ed. This may be necessary
as a result of the effects of ic e, thawing salt
or hea t, or the incorrect use of cleaning
agents.
S witc h off the windsc reen w ip er or
automatic w ip er with rain sensor 3 in car
washes - see pa ges 11, 264.
Windscreen w ip er blad e m aintenanc e see page 266.
6
278
Service, maintenanc e
To ensure proper operation of the ra in
sensor 3, the sensor a rea must be free from
dust, dirt and ice. The windscreen w ash
system m ust also be operated at regular
intervals and the sensor a rea m ust be
de-iced. Vehicles with rain sensor c an be
identified by the sensor area near the top
of the w indscreen.
Service set ting for front wind sc reen wip er
(e.g. for cha nging or cleaning the front
wiper b la des).
Within 8 seconds of switching off the
engine b ut with the key in the starter
switch, press the windscreen wiper stalk
downwards. Release the stalk as soon as
the wiper blades are v ertical.
Wiper bl ades on the windscreen
Activating serv ic e position - see p receding
column. Lift wiper arm. Press the release
lever a nd detac h the wiper blade.
Service, mainten ance
Fill only with clean water to prev ent the
nozz les from clogging. To im prov e
cleaning efficienc y, w e recommend tha t
you ad d a little Vauxhall Windscreen Wash
Solvent.
Windscreen and headlight wash
systems 3
The filler neck of the windsc reen wash
system a nd headlight wash system fluid
container 3 is at the front left of the eng ine
compartment next to the b attery. The fluid
lev el in the reservoir ca n be read off from
the level indicator. Do not fill above 1/ 1.
Ca pacities – see p age 308.
279
The wind screen wash system and
hea dlight wash system will not freeze in
winter:
Frost protection
down to
- 5 °C
M ixture ratio of
Vauxhall
Windscreen
Wash Solvent to
Water
1:3
- 10 ° C
- 20 ° C
1:2
1:1
- 30 ° C
2:1
When closing the reservoir, press the lid
firmly ov er the bea ded edge all the way
round.
280
Service, maintenanc e
Lay ing up the v ehicle for m ore than
4 weeks can lead to battery discharge,
whic h may reduce the service life of the
battery. Disconnect battery from on-board
power supply b y detaching negative
terminal.
The Vauxhall a larm system 3 siren must be
deactiv ated a s follows: switch the ignition
on then off, disconnec t the vehicle’s
battery within 15 seconds.
Ensure that ignition is switched off before
connecting battery . Then perform the
following actions:
Battery
The b attery is m aintenanc e-free.
9 Warning
Have the ba ttery changed by a
work shop. O bserve the legal
requirements for disposa l of old ba tteries
to protect the environment and your
health.
Retro-fitting of electrical or electronic
accessories can discharge or add extra
load to the battery . Take adv ic e on the
tec hnical p ossibilities, e. g. use of a more
powerful ba ttery.
z Setting date and tim e in the inform ation
display – see pages 110, 113, 118.
z Activate window and sunroof
electronics 3 if necessary –
see pages 47, 49.
In order to prevent the battery from
discharging, some consumers such as the
courtesy light autom atically switch off
after approx . 20 minutes.
Di sc onnecti ng/connect ing the bat ter y
from/to the elec trica l system
Disconnect b attery from v ehicle power
supply before charging : disconnect
negative cable first, then the positive
cable.
The polarity of the battery , i.e. the positiv e
and negativ e terminal connections, must
not b e switched. Always connect the
positive cable first, then the negative
cable.
Protecting electronic compo nen ts
In order to prev ent faults in elec tronic
components in the electrical system, never
connect or d isconnect b attery w ith engine
running or ignition switched on. Nev er start
eng ine with battery disconnected, e. g.
when starting using jum p lead s.
To av oid damaging the vehic le, d o not
ma ke a ny modifications to the electrical
system, e. g. connecting ad ditional
consum ers or tampering with electronic
control units (chip tuning).
9 Warnin g
Electronic ignition system s generate very
hig h voltages. Do not touch the ignition
sy stem; high voltage can b e fatal.
Service, mainten ance
Vehicle decomm issioning
O bserve na tional regulations.
If the vehicle is to be parked for severa l
months, to avoid da mage have the
follow ing work performed by a workshop.
z Wash and preserve the vehicle –
see pa ge 264.
z Check corrosion protection in engine
com partment a nd on underbody a nd
repair if necessary .
z Clean and preserv e rubber seals on
bonnet and doors.
Vehicle storag e
z Park vehicle in dry, well v entilated plac e.
With manual transmission or
Easy tronic 3 , enga ge 1st or rev erse
gear. With automatic transm ission 3,
selector lever in P. Use chocks or the like
to prevent the vehicle from rolling .
281
Vehicle recommissioning
O bserve national regulations.
Perform the following work before
recommissioning the vehicle:
z Connect ba ttery – see page 280.
z Do not apply handbrake.
z Check tyre pressure and correc t if
necessary – see page 299.
z Disconnect battery by disengaging
neg ativ e terminal from vehicle electrical
system – see page 280.
z Fill up w indscreen wash system a nd
headlight wash system 3 –
see page 279.
z Check engine oil level – see p age 272.
z Change engine oil – see page 273.
z Check the coolant level; top up with antifreez e if necessa ry – see pa ge 275.
z Check anti-freeze and c orrosion
protection – see page 274.
z Fit the num ber p la te if necessary .
z Check the coola nt level, top up with antifreeze if nec essary – see pag e 275.
z Empty windsc reen w ash system and
headlight wash system 3 .
z Inc rease ty re pressure to value sp ecified
for full load – see page 299.
282
Tec hnic al data
Technical data
Vehicle docum ents, identification
plate. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Vehicle identification d ata.... .... .... ..... .
Coolant, b ra ke fluid, oils .. ..... .... .... ..... .
Engine data. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Performance.... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Fuel consump tion, CO 2 emissions ..... .
Weights, pay loa d and roof load .. ..... .
Tyres ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Electrical system .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Ca pacities ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
Dimensions.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .
282
283
283
284
286
288
293
299
307
308
310
Veh icle documents,
identification plate
The tec hnical d ata is determined in
accordance with European C ommunity
standards. We reserve the right to make
modifications. S pecifications in the vehic le
docum ents alwa ys have priority ov er those
given in this manual.
The identification plate is affix ed to the
front right door frame.
Information on identification plate:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Manufa cturer
Type approval numb er
Vehicle I dentification Number
Gross Vehicle Weight rating
Permissib le Gross Train Weig ht
Maxim um perm issible front axle load
Maxim um perm issible rear ax le load
Vehicle-specific or country-specific
data
Technical data
In other model variants, the id entifica tion
plate may also be affix ed to the instrument
panel.
Engine code and engine number: stamp ed
on left-ha nd side of engine on crankcase.
Vehicle identification data
The Vehicle Identification Numb er is
stamped on the identification plate and
beneath a cover on the floor of the vehicle
between the front door and driver’s seat.
283
Coolant, brake flu id, oils
O nly use app rov ed fluids.
Use of unsuitab le fluids can cause serious
dam age to the vehicle.
Engine oils
Information on engine oils is found in the
S ervice Booklet.
284
Tec hnic al data
Engine data
Sales designation
Eng ine identifier code
1.8
Z 18 XE
1. 8
Z 18 XER
2.0 Turb o
Z 20 NET
2.2
Z 22 SE
2.2 DIREC T
Z 22 YH
2.8 V6
Z 28 NEL
Numb er of cylinders
4
4
4
4
4
6
1796
1796
1998
2198
2198
2792
Engine power (k W)
at rpm
90
6000
103
6300
129
5500
108
5600
114
5600
169
5500
Torque (Nm )
at rpm
167
3800
175
3800
265
2500 to 3800
203
4000
220
3800
330
1800 to 4500
Petrol
Petrol
Petrol
Petrol
Petrol
Petrol
95
98
91
95
98
91
95
98
91
95
98 2)
91 2) 4)
95 5 )
98 2 )
–6 )
95
98
91
Piston displacement
(cm 3)
Type of fuel
O ctane requirement
unleaded
or unleaded
or unleaded
(RO N) 1 )
2)
2)3 )
2)
2 )3)
2)
2)4 )
2)
2)3 )
Max . permissible engine speed,
continuous opera tion (rpm) ap prox . 6500
6500
6200
6500
6500
6700
Engine oil consumption (l/1000 km )
0. 6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
0.6
Stan da rd high-q uality fuels , e.g . unlea ded DIN EN 228; value p rinted in b old: reco mmend ed fuel.
Kn ock contro l s ys tem a utoma tically a d jus ts ig nition tim ing a ccording to typ e o f fuel used (octa ne nu mber).
Slight reduction in engine ou tp ut a nd to rq ue if 91 R ON is used .
If no unlea ded P rem ium fuel is a vailab le, 91 RON ca n be used ta king ca re to avoid hig h engine loa d or full loa d a s well a s for driving in m ountaino us
terra in with a caravan /trailer loa d o r hig h pa ylo ad .
The use o f fuel tha t is a t leas t 95 R ON is p rescrib ed.
91 octa ne fu el m ust not be used .
Technical data
285
Engine data
Sales designation
Eng ine identifier code
2.8 V6
Z 28 NET
VXR
Z 28 N ET
1.9 CDTI
Z 19 DTL
1. 9 CDTI
Z 19 DT
1. 9 CDTI
Z 19 DTH
3. 0 C DTI
Z 30 DT
Numb er of cylinders
6
6
4
4
4
6
2792
2792
1910
1910
1910
2958
Engine power (k W)
at rpm
184
5500
206
5500
74
3500
88
3500 to 4000
110
4000
135
4000
Torque (Nm )
at rpm
350
1800 to 4500
355
1800 to 4500
260
1700 to 2500
280
2000 to 2750
320
2000 to 2750
400
1900 to 2700
Petrol
Petrol
Diesel
Diesel
Diesel
Diesel
95
98
91
–
95 4)
98 2 )
–5 )
–
–
–
–
49 (D) 6)
–
–
–
49 (D) 4 )
–
–
–
49 (D) 4 )
–
–
–
49 (D)4 )
Max . permissible engine speed,
continuous op eration (rpm) approx. 6700
6700
5100
5100
5100
5000
Engine oil consumption (l/1000 km )
0.6
0.6
0. 6
0. 6
0. 6
Piston displacement
(cm 3)
Type of fuel
(RO N) 1 )
O ctane requirement
unleaded
or unleaded
or unleaded
Cetane requirement (CN) 1 )
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
0.6
2)
2)3 )
Stan da rd high-q uality fuels , e.g . unlea ded DIN EN 228, Diesel DIN EN 590; D = Diesel; value p rinted in bo ld : recom mend ed fuel.
Kn ock contro l s ys tem a utoma tically a d jus ts ig nition tim ing a ccording to typ e o f fuel used (octa ne nu mber).
Slight reduction in engine ou tp ut a nd to rq ue if 91 R ON is used .
Slight reduction in engine ou tp ut a nd to rq ue if 95 R ON is used .
91 octa ne fu el m ust not be used .
A lo wer va lue is pos sib le with w inter fu els.
286
Tec hnic al data
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), Sal oon / Ha tch
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 SE
Z 22 YH
Z 28 N EL
Max imum speed2)
Manual tra nsmission
Sports transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
126/203
127/205
–
–
130/210
130/210
129/207
–
–
143/230
–
–
134/216
–
–
130/210
135/218
135/218
–
130/210
155/250
–
–
155/250
Eng ine 1 )
Z 28 NET
Z 28 NET VXR
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
155/2503)
–
–
155/2503)
155/250 3)
–
–
155/250 3)
116/186
–
–
–
124/200
–
–
–
135/217
–
–
130/210
143/230
–
–
140/226
speed2)
Max imum
Manual tra nsmission
Sports transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
1)
2)
3)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
The ma xim um s peed ind ica ted is achieva ble a t kerb weig ht (with out driver) p lu s 200 kg p ayloa d. Optiona l eq uipm ent cou ld red uce th e s pecified
maximu m sp eed of th e vehicle.
The ma xim um s peed is limited electro nica lly.
Technical data
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), Esta te
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 N ET
Z 22 YH
Z 28 N EL
Max imum speed2)
Manual tra nsmission
Sports transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
–
124/199
–
–
126/203
130/209
128/207
–
–
139/224
–
–
130/210
130/210
–
129/208
152/245
–
–
152/245
Z 28 N ET
Z 28 N ET VXR
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
155/2503 )
–
–
155/2503 )
155/2503 )
–
–
155/2503 )
113/182
–
–
–
121/195
–
–
–
130/210
–
–
129/208
140/225
–
–
137/221
Eng ine 1 )
speed2)
Max imum
Manual tra nsmission
Sports transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
1)
2)
3)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
The ma xim um s peed ind ica ted is achieva ble a t kerb weig ht (with out driver) p lu s 200 kg p ayloa d. Optiona l eq uipm ent cou ld red uce th e s pecified
maximu m sp eed of th e vehicle.
The ma xim um s peed is limited electro nica lly.
287
288
Tec hnic al data
Fuel consumption, CO 2 emissions
Directive 80/1268/EEC (last c hanged
by 2004/3/EC ) has applied for the
measurement of fuel consumption
since 1996.
The direc tiv e is oriented to actual driving
practices: Urba n driving is rated at
approx. 1/ 3 and ex tra-urb an driving with
approx. 2/ 3 (urban and extra-urban
consumption). C old sta rts a nd acceleration
phases are also taken into considera tion.
The specification of CO 2 emission is also a
constituent of the directive.
The figures given m ust not be taken as a
guarantee for the actual fuel consumption
of a p artic ular vehicle.
All values are b ased on the EU base model
with standard equipment.
The calculation of fuel consumption as
spec ified by directive 2004/3/EC takes
acc ount of the v ehicle’ s kerbweight,
ascertained in accordance with these
regula tions. O ptional extras ma y result in
slightly higher fuel consumption and CO 2
emission lev els than those quoted.
To convert l/100 k m into mpg, divide 282
by num ber of litres/100 km.
S aving fuel, p rotecting the environm ent –
see page 186.
Technical data
Fuel consumption
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
Eng ine 1 )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Eng ine 1 )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Fuel consumption
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Eng ine 1 )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Saloo n 4-doo r (tyre width up to 225 mm )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 S E
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
10.4/10. 7/–/–
5.5/ 5.8/– /–
7.3/ 7.6/– /–
175/ 182/–/–
Z 28 NET
10.1/ 9. 9/ 9.7/–
5.5/ 5.6/ 5.4/–
7.2/ 7.2/ 7.0/–
173/173/168/–
Z 19 DTL
–/12.5/–/–
–/ 6. 3/–/–
–/ 8. 6/–/–
–/ 206/–/–
Z 19 DT
– /11. 4/–/13.3
– / 6.2/–/ 6.5
– / 8.1/–/ 9.0
– / 194/–/ 216
Z 19 DTH
10. 3/10.3/–/11.3
6. 0/ 5.9/– / 6.1
7. 6/ 7.5/– / 8.0
182/ 180/–/ 192
Z 30 DT
15.4/–/–/17.1
7. 3/–/–/ 7. 3
10.3/–/–/10.9
247/–/–/ 262
15.4/–/–/17.1
7.3/–/–/ 7.3
10.3/–/–/10.9
247/–/–/ 262
7.4/–/–/–
4.7/–/–/–
5.7/–/–/–
154/–/–/–
7. 4/–/–/–
4. 7/–/–/–
5. 7/–/–/–
154/–/–/–
7.4/– /–/ 9.4
4.7/– /–/ 5.3
5.7/– /–/ 6.8
154/– /– /184
9.8/– /– /10. 2
5.2/– /– / 5.3
6.9/– /– / 7.1
186/–/– / 192
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
Eng ine 1 )
289
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Saloo n 4-doo r (tyre width up to 235 mm )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 S E
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
10.5/10. 8/–/–
5.6/ 5.9/– /–
7.4/ 7.7/– /–
178/ 185/–/–
Z 28 NET
10.2/10.0/ 9.8/–
5.6/ 5. 7/ 5.5/–
7.3/ 7. 3/ 7.1/–
175/ 175/170/–
Z 19 DTL
–/12.6/–/–
–/ 6.4/–/–
–/ 8.7/–/–
–/209/–/–
Z 19 DT
– /11. 5/–/13.4
– / 6.3/–/ 6.6
– / 8.2/–/ 9.1
– / 197/–/ 218
Z 19 DTH
10. 4/10.4/–/11.4
6. 1/ 6.0/– / 6.2
7. 7/ 7.6/– / 8.1
185/ 182/–/194
Z 30 DT
15.5/–/–/17.2
7. 4/–/–/ 7. 4
10.4/–/–/11.0
250/–/–/264
15.5/–/–/17.2
7.4/–/–/ 7.4
10.4/–/–/11.0
250/–/–/264
7.5/–/–/–
4.8/–/–/–
5.8/–/–/–
157/–/–/–
7. 5/–/–/–
4. 8/–/–/–
5. 8/–/–/–
157/–/–/–
7.5/– /–/ 9.5
4.8/– /–/ 5.4
5.8/– /–/ 6.9
157/– /– /186
9.9/– /– /10. 3
5.3/– /– / 5.4
7.0/– /– / 7.2
189/–/– / 194
290
Tec hnic al data
Fuel consumption
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Hatch 5-door (tyre width up to 225 mm)
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 N ET
Z 22 SE
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
10.4/10.7/–/–
5.5/ 5.8/–/–
7.3/ 7.6/–/–
175/ 182/–/–
10.1/ 9.9/ 9.7/–
5.5/ 5.6/ 5.4/–
7.2/ 7.2/ 7.0/–
173/173/168/–
–/12.5/– /–
–/ 6.3/–/–
–/ 8.6/–/–
–/ 206/– /–
–
–
–
–
Eng ine 1 )
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
Z 28 N ET
Z 28 NET VXR
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
10.3/10.3/–/11.3
6.0/ 5.9/–/ 6.1
7.6/ 7.5/–/ 8.0
182/ 180/–/ 192
15.4/–/–/17.1
7.3/–/–/ 7.3
10.3/–/–/10.9
247/–/–/ 262
15.4/–/– /17. 1
7.3/– /–/ 7.3
10.3/–/– /10. 9
247/–/– / 262
15.4/–/–/ 2)
7. 3/–/–/ 2 )
10.3/–/–/ 2)
247/–/–/ 2)
Eng ine 1 )
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
7.4/–/–/–
4.7/–/–/–
5.7/–/–/–
154/– /–/–
7.4/–/– /–
4.7/–/– /–
5.7/–/– /–
154/–/–/–
7.4/–/–/ 9.5
4.7/–/–/ 5.4
5.7/–/–/ 6.9
154/– /–/186
9.8/–/– /10. 2
5.2/–/– / 5. 3
6.9/–/– / 7. 1
186/–/–/ 192
1)
2)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Va lues no t a va ila ble at tim e of p rinting.
/11.4/–/13.3
/ 6. 2/–/ 6.5
/ 8. 1/–/ 9.0
/ 194/–/ 216
Technical data
Fuel consumption
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
291
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Hatch 5-door (tyre width up to 235 mm)
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 S E
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
10. 5/10.8/–/–
5. 6/ 5.9/–/–
7. 4/ 7.7/–/–
178/ 185/–/–
10. 2/10.0/ 9. 8/–
5.6/ 5.7/ 5.5/–
7.3/ 7.3/ 7.1/–
175/ 175/170/–
–/12.6/–/–
–/ 6.4/–/–
–/ 8.7/–/–
–/ 209/–/–
– /11.5/–/13.4
– / 6.3/– / 6. 6
– / 8.2/– / 9. 1
– / 197/–/ 218
Eng ine 1 )
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
Z 28 NET
Z 28 N ET VXR
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
10. 4/10.4/–/11.4 15. 5/–/–/17.2
6. 1/ 6.0/–/ 6.2
7.4/–/– / 7. 4
7. 7/ 7.6/–/ 8.1 10. 4/–/–/11.0
185/ 182/–/ 194 250/–/–/ 264
15.5/– /–/17.2
7.4/–/–/ 7.4
10.4/– /–/11.0
250/– /–/ 264
15.4/–/– /2 )
7.3/– /–/ 2)
10.3/–/– /2 )
247/–/– /2 )
Eng ine 1 )
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic tra nsmission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
7.5/– /–/–
4.8/– /–/–
5.8/– /–/–
157/–/– /–
7.5/– /–/–
4.8/– /–/–
5.8/– /–/–
157/–/– /–
7.5/–/–/ 9. 6
4.8/–/–/ 5. 5
5.8/–/–/ 7. 0
157/–/–/189
9.9/–/–/10.3
5.3/–/–/ 5.4
7.0/–/–/ 7.2
189/– /–/ 194
1)
2)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Va lues no t a va ila ble at tim e of p rinting.
292
Tec hnic al data
Fuel consumption
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
Eng ine 1 )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Eng ine 1 )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Fuel consumption
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 YH
Z 28 N EL
Z 28 NET
– /11. 0/–/–
– / 6.1/–/–
– / 7.9/–/–
– / 190/–/–
Z 28 NET VXR
10. 3/10.4/10.0/–
5.9/ 6.1/ 5. 7/–
7.5/ 7.7/ 7. 3/–
180/ 185/ 175/–
Z 19 DTL
–/12.7/–/–
–/ 6.5/–/–
–/ 8.8/–/–
–/ 211/–/–
Z 19 DT
10.6/10.6/–/11.5
6. 3/ 6.2/– / 6. 3
7. 9/ 7.8/– / 8. 2
190/ 187/–/ 197
Z 19 DTH
15.5/–/– /17. 4
7.4/– /–/ 7.6
10.4/–/– /11. 2
250/–/– / 269
Z 30 DT
15.5/–/–/17.4
7. 4/–/–/ 7. 6
10.4/–/–/11.2
250/–/–/ 269
15.5/–/–/ 2 )
7. 4/–/–/2 )
10.4/–/–/ 2 )
250/–/–/ 2)
7.5/– /–/–
4.8/– /–/–
5.8/– /–/–
157/–/– /–
7.5/–/–/–
4.8/–/–/–
5.8/–/–/–
157/–/–/–
7.5/–/– / 9.6
4.8/–/– / 5.5
5.8/–/– / 7.0
157/–/– /189
9.8/–/–/10.3
5.2/–/–/ 5.4
6.9/–/–/ 7.2
186/– /–/ 194
(approx. l/100 km ) ,
Eng ine 1 )
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Estate (tyre width up to 225 mm )
CO2 emissions (approx. g/k m) , Estate (tyre width up to 235 mm )
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 YH
Z 28 N EL
– /11. 1/–/–
– / 6.2/–/–
– / 8.0/–/–
– / 192/–/–
10. 4/10.5/10.1/–
6.0/ 6.2/ 5. 8/–
7.6/ 7.8/ 7. 4/–
182/ 187/ 178/–
–/12.8/–/–
–/ 6.6/–/–
–/ 8.9/–/–
–/ 214/–/–
10.7/10.7/–/11.6
6. 4/ 6.3/– / 6. 4
8. 0/ 7.9/– / 8. 3
192/ 190/–/ 199
15.6/–/– /17. 5
7.5/– /–/ 7.7
10.5/–/– /11. 3
252/–/– / 271
Eng ine 1 )
Z 28 NET
Z 28 NET VXR
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Manual/sports/Ea sytronic/a utomatic
transm ission
urban
extra-urban
tota l
CO 2
15.6/–/–/17.5
7. 5/–/–/ 7. 7
10.5/–/–/11.3
252/–/–/ 271
15.5/–/–/ 2 )
7. 4/–/–/2 )
10.4/–/–/ 2 )
250/–/–/ 2)
7.6/– /–/–
4.9/– /–/–
5.9/– /–/–
159/–/– /–
7.6/–/–/–
4.9/–/–/–
5.9/–/–/–
159/–/–/–
7.6/–/– / 9.7
4.9/–/– / 5.6
5.9/–/– / 7.1
159/–/– /192
9.9/–/–/10.4
5.3/–/–/ 5.5
7.0/–/–/ 7.3
189/– /–/ 197
1)
2)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Va lues no t a va ila ble at tim e of p rinting.
Technical data
Weights, payload and roof load
The p ayload is the difference between the
permitted Gross Vehic le Weight (see
identification plate on page 282) and the
EC kerbweig ht.
To ca lc ulate the kerbweight, enter the data
for your vehicle below:
z Kerb weight from
Ta ble 1, p ages 294 to
296
+ ... ..... .... .. kg
z Ad ditional w eight of
equipment versions
from Ta ble 2, page 297 + ... ..... .... .. kg
z Weight of heavy
accessories from
Ta ble 3, p age 298
+ ... ..... .... .. kg
Total
= ... ..... .... .. kg
is the EC k erbweight.
O ptional equipment and accessories
increase the kerbweight, w hich means that
the p ayload will also change slig htly.
Pay attention to weight ranges in v ehicle
documents and on identifica tion plate.
The combined total of front a nd rear ax le
loa ds must not exceed the perm issible
Gross Vehicle Weight. For exam ple, if the
front ax le is bearing its m aximum
permissib le load, the rear axle can only
bear a load that is eq ua l to the Gross
Vehicle Weight m inus the front axle load.
When the carav an/trailer is coupled and
the towing vehic le fully loaded (including
all occupants), the perm issible rear ax le
loa d (see identification plate or v ehicle
docum ents) may be exceeded by 40 kg. I f
the perm issible rear axle load is exceeded,
a max imum speed of 60 mph (100 km /h)
applies. I f na tional regulations specify a
low er ma ximum speed for vehicles towing
a carava n/trailer, this must be observed .
See the identification plate or v ehicle
docum ents for permissib le ax le loads.
293
Roof loa d
The permissib le roof load is 90 kg, a nd
100 k g for Estate with roof railing 3 . The
roof load is the c om bined weight of the
roof rack a nd the load.
Driving hints – see page 184.
Roof rack – see page 218.
294
Tec hnic al data
Weights (kg) : Table 1, Kerbweight1) , Saloon
Model
Vec tra w ith
Elec tronic C limat e
Cont rol 3
1)
2)
Eng ine 2 )
4-door
Ma nual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic tra nsmission
Z 18 XE
1395
–
–
Z 18 XER
1395
1395
–
Z 20 NET
1505
–
–
Z 22 SE
1460
–
1490
Z 22 YH
1460
–
1490
Z 28 NEL
1565
–
1590
Z 28 NET
1565
–
1590
Z 19 DTL
1505
–
–
Z 19 DT
1505
–
–
Z 19 DTH
1503
–
1523
Z 30 DT
1635
–
1660
According to EC D irective, inclu ding ass umed weights for d river (68 kg), lugg ag e (7 kg ) a nd a ll flu id s (ta nk 9 0% fu ll).
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Technical data
Weights (kg) : T able 1, Kerbweight1 ), Hatch
M odel
Vectra with
Electronic Clim ate
C ontrol 3
1)
2)
Engine2)
5-d oor
Manua l transmission
Easytronic
Automatic tra nsmission
Z 18 XE
1393
–
–
Z 18 XER
1393
1393
–
Z 20 NET
1503
–
–
Z 22 SE
1475
–
1505
Z 22 Y H
1475
–
1505
Z 28 NEL
1580
–
1605
Z 28 NET
1580
–
1605
Z 19 DTL
1503
–
–
Z 19 DT
1503
–
–
Z 19 DTH
1523
–
1548
Z 30 DT
1650
–
1675
Acco rd in g to EC Directive, in clud in g a ssum ed weig hts for driver (68 kg ), lug ga ge (7 kg ) a nd all fluids (ta nk 90% full).
Sales d esig na tion – see p ag es 284, 285 .
295
296
Tec hnic al data
Weights (kg) : Table 1, Kerbweight1) , Estate
Model
Engi ne2 )
Vectra w ith
Elec tronic C limat e
Cont rol 3
Z 18 XE
1475
–
–
Z 18 XER
1475
1475
–
Z 20 N ET
1570
–
–
Z 22 Y H
1523
–
1553
Z 28 N EL
1613
–
1638
Z 28 N ET
1613
–
1638
Z 19 DTL
1585
–
–
Z 19 DT
1585
–
–
Z 19 DTH
1600
–
1613
Z 30 DT
1685
–
1710
1)
2)
Estate
M anual tra nsmission
Easytronic
According to EC D irective, inclu ding ass umed weights for d river (68 kg), lugg ag e (7 kg ) a nd a ll flu id s (ta nk 9 0% fu ll).
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Automatic transm ission
Technical data
297
Weights (kg) : Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions
Sal oon / Ha tch
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE,
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 SE
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
Z 28 NET
Life
16
16
16
16
16
16
Ex clusiv
32
32
32
32
32
32
Design/Elite
31
31
31
31
31
31
SRi
28
28
28
28
28
28
Eng ine 1 )
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Life
16
16
16
6
Ex clusiv
32
32
32
22
Design/Elite
31
31
31
21
SRi
28
28
28
26
Est ate
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE,
Z 18 XER
Z 20 N ET
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL
Z 28 NET
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Life
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
3
Ex clusiv
22
22
22
22
22
22
22
22
20
Design/Elite
27
27
27
27
27
27
27
27
25
SRi
23
23
23
23
23
23
23
23
26
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
298
Tec hnic al data
Weights (kg) , Table 3, Heavy accessories
Sal oon / Ha tch
Accessories
Sunroof
Towing equip ment
Weight
17
23
Accessories
Sunroof
Towing equip ment
Weight
18
33
Est ate
Technical data
Tyres
Not a ll tyres ava ila ble on the market
currently meet the structural requirem ents.
We recommend that you consult a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer concerning
suitab le tyre mak es.
These ty res have und ergone special tests
to establish their reliab ility , safety and
specific suitability for Vaux hall vehicles.
Despite continuous ma rk et monitoring, we
are unab le to assess these attributes for
other tyres, ev en if they hav e been g ra nted
approva l by the relevant authorities or in
som e other form.
Further information – see pa ge 211.
Winter tyres 3
Tyres of size 215/50 R 17, 225/45 R 18 and
235/35 R 19 are not to be used as winter
tyres.
O nly the winter tyres sp ecified on p age 306
may b e used on vehicles factory-fitted with
235/35 R 19 tyres.
For Vectra VXR, tyres of size 225/45 R 17 on
a Vauxhall-approved alloy wheel with
designation 7x17, ET39 as well as ty res of
size 235/40 R 18 are permissible as winter
tyres.
If winter tyres are in use, the spare wheel
may still be fitted w ith a summ er ty re. Use
of the spare w heel may a lter vehicle
ha ndling. Obtain a replacement for the
fa ulty tyre as soon as possible, and hav e
the wheel balanced and fitted to the
vehicle.
Further inform ation – see page 216.
Tyre ch ains 3
Ty re c hains may be used on the front
wheels only.
We rec om mend the use of fine-link tyre
cha ins which am ount to max 10 mm on the
tread a nd tyre inner wall with chain lock
Ty re chains are not perm itted on tyre sizes
115/70 R 16, 215/50 R 17, 225/45 R 18,
235/40 R 18 a nd 235/35 R 19.
Further inform ation – see page 217.
Wheels
Wheel bolt tightening torque: 110 N m.
Spare wheel
3
On vehicles with alloy w heels 3 the spare
wheel may ha ve a steel rim .
299
Depending on the model variant, the sp are
wheel is designed to be an emergency
wheel 3: Using a spare wheel may change
the vehicle’s ha nd ling. Repla ce defective
tyres a s quickly as possib le, bala nce wheel
and fit to v ehicle.
The spare wheel ma y be fitted w ith a
smaller tyre1 ) and a sm aller rim than the
wheels fitted to the vehicle: Using the spare
wheel m ay change the v ehicle’ s handling.
Tyre pressure in psi/bar 2)
The specified ty re pressures are valid for
cold ty res. The increased ty re pressure
resulting from ex tensiv e d riv ing must not
be reduced. The tyre pressures specified on
the following pages ap ply to both summer
and w inter tyres.
Alway s inflate the spare wheel to the tyre
pressure for full load - see tables on
following pages.
Temporary spare wheel tyre pressure 3 –
see tables on the following p ages.
In v ehicles with tyre pressure monitoring
system 3 there is an adapter in the v alve
cap key . S crew a dapter to valve before
attaching tyre pressure gauge –
see page 213.
Further inform ation – see p ages 211 to 217.
1)
2)
Co untry-specific version: Th e spa re w heel is
only to be used as a tempo ra ry sp are wh eel.
1 ba r corresp on ds to 100 kPa / 14.5 p si.
300
(ctd.)
Tec hnic al data
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Saloon / Hat ch
Tyre pressure for
load of up to
3 people
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure for
ECO 1) loa ded with full loa d
up to 3 people
Engine2 )
Tyres
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Z 18 XE,
Z 18 XER
195/65
205/55
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
29/2. 0
32/2.2
35/2.4
38/2.6
35/2. 4
42/2.9
Z 20 N ET
205/55 R 16 3)
35/2. 4
35/2.4
–
–
36/2. 5
44/3.0
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
16,
17,
17,
18
33/2. 3
33/2.3
38/2.6
38/2.6
35/2. 4
42/2.9
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
33/2. 3
33/2.3
–
–
35/2. 4
42/2.9
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
32/2. 2
32/2.2
36/2.5
36/2.5
33/2. 3
41/2.8
61/4. 2
61/4.2
–
–
61/4. 2
61/4.2
Z 22 S E,
Z 22 Y H
all
1)
2)
3)
4)
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
15,
16,
16,
17,
17,
18
16,
17,
17,
18
T 115/70 R 16 4)
To red uce fuel co nsum ption a s much a s po ssible.
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
Only permitted a s winter tyres.
For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel – see p ag e 237.
Technical data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Saloon / Hat ch
301
Ty re pressure for
load of up to
3 p eople
Tyre pressure for full
load
Engine1 )
Ty res
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Z 28 N EL,
Z 28 N ET
215/55 R 16 2 )
35/2.4
35/2.4
38/2.6
45/3.1
215/50 R 17 2 ),
225/45 R 17 2 ),
225/45 R 18 2 )
38/2.6
35/2.4
41/2.8
48/3.3
215/55 R 16 3 )
36/2.5
33/2.3
39/2.7
46/3.2
215/50 R 17 3 ),
225/45 R 17 3 ),
225/45 R 18 3 )
39/2.7
35/2.4
42/2.9
49/3.4
235/35 R 19,
235/40 R 18
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
225/45 R 17 4 )
41/2.8
36/2.5
44/3.0
51/3.5
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
Vectra VXR
all
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
T 115/70 R
165 )
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
Versio n with ma nua l tra nsm is sio n.
Versio n with au tom atic tra nsm iss io n.
Only permitted a s winter tyres o n Vau xh all-a pp ro ved alloy wheels.
For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel - see p ag e 237.
302
(ctd.)
Tec hnic al data
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Saloon / Hat ch
Tyre p ressure for
loa d of up to
3 people
Ty re pressure
Tyre pressure for
ECO 1) loaded w ith full load
up to 3 p eople
Engine2 )
Tyres
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Front
Rea r
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DTH
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
35/2.4
35/2.4
–
–
36/2.5
44/3. 0
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
33/2.3
33/2.3
38/2.6
38/2.6
35/2.4
42/2. 9
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
33/2.3
33/2.3
–
–
35/2.4
42/2. 9
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
32/2.2
32/2.2
36/2.5
36/2.5
33/2.3
41/2. 8
215/55 R 16,
36/2.5
33/2.3
–
–
39/2.7
46/3. 2
215/50 R 17,
225/45 R 18
38/2.6
35/2.4
–
–
39/2.7
46/3. 2
39/2.7
35/2.4
–
–
41/2.8
48/3. 3
61/4.2
61/4.2
–
–
61/4.2
61/4. 2
Z 19 DT
Z 30 DT
225/45 R 17
all
T 115/70 R 16
3)
1) To red uce fuel co nsum ption a s much a s po ssible.
2)
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
3) For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel - see p ag e 237.
Technical data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Estat e
303
Tyre p ressure for
loa d of up to
3 people
Ty re pressure
Tyre pressure for
ECO 1) loaded w ith full load
up to 3 p eople
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Front
Rea r
29/2.0
32/2.2
35/2.4
38/2.6
35/2.4
42/2. 9
Engine2 )
Tyres
Z 18 XE,
Z 18 XER
195/65
205/55
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
Z 20 N ET
205/55 R 16 3 )
35/2.4
35/2.4
–
–
36/2.5
44/3. 0
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
33/2.3
33/2.3
38/2.6
38/2.6
35/2.4
42/2. 9
195/65 R 15 3 ),
205/55 R 16
33/2.3
33/2.3
–
–
35/2.4
42/2. 9
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
32/2.2
32/2.2
36/2.5
36/2.5
33/2.3
41/2. 8
61/4.2
61/4.2
–
–
61/4.2
61/4. 2
Z 22 Y H,
Z 22 S E
all
1)
2)
3)
4)
R 15,
R 16,
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
T 115/70 R 16 4)
To red uce fuel co nsum ption a s much a s po ssible.
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
Only permitted a s winter tyres.
For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel – see p ag e 237.
304
(ctd.)
Tec hnic al data
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Estat e
Ty re pressure for
load of up to
3 p eople
Tyre pressure for full
load
Engine1 )
Ty res
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Z 28 N EL,
Z 28 N ET
215/55 R 16 2 )
36/2.5
33/2.3
39/2.7
46/3.2
215/50 R 17 2 ),
225/45 R 17 2 ),
225/45 R 18 2 )
39/2.7
35/2.4
42/2.9
49/3.4
215/55 R 16 3 )
38/2.6
35/2.4
41/2.8
48/3.3
17 3 ),
215/50 R
225/45 R 18 3 )
39/2.7
35/2.4
42/2.9
49/3.4
225/45 R 17 3 )
41/2.8
36/2.5
44/3.0
51/3.5
235/35 R 19,
235/40 R 18
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
225/45 R 17 4 )
41/2.8
36/2.5
44/3.0
51/3.5
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
Vectra VXR
all
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
T 115/70 R
165 )
Sales d esigna tion - see p ag es 284, 285 .
Versio n with ma nua l tra nsm is sio n.
Versio n with au tom atic tra nsm iss io n.
Only permitted a s winter tyres o n Vau xh all-a pp ro ved alloy wheels.
For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel – see p ag e 237.
Technical data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Estat e
305
Tyre p ressure for
loa d of up to
3 people
Ty re pressure
Tyre pressure for
ECO 1) loaded w ith full load
up to 3 p eople
Engine2 )
Tyres
Front
Front
Rear
Rear
Front
Rea r
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DTH
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
35/2.4
35/2.4
–
–
36/2.5
44/3. 0
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
33/2.3
33/2.3
38/2.6
38/2.6
35/2.4
42/2. 9
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
33/2.3
33/2.3
–
–
35/2.4
42/2. 9
215/55
215/50
225/45
225/45
R 16,
R 17,
R 17,
R 18
32/2.2
32/2.2
36/2.5
36/2.5
33/2.3
41/2. 8
215/55 R 16
36/2.5
33/2.3
–
–
39/2.7
46/3. 2
215/50 R 17,
225/45 R 18
38/2.6
35/2.4
–
–
39/2.7
46/3. 2
39/2.7
35/2.4
–
–
41/2.8
48/3. 3
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4. 2
Z 19 DT
Z 30 DT
225/45 R 17
all
T 115/70 R 16
3)
1) To red uce fuel co nsum ption a s much a s po ssible.
2)
Sales d esigna tion – s ee p a ges 284, 28 5.
3) For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel - see p ag e 237.
306
(ctd.)
Tec hnic al data
Tyre pressure in psi/bar
Saloon / Hat ch, Esta te
with 19-inch wheels
Ty re pressure for
load of up to
3 p eople
Tyre pressure for full
load
Engine1 )
Ty res
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Z
Z
Z
Z
XE,
XER,
S E,
YH
235/35 R 19
39/2.7
35/2.4
41/2.8
48/3.3
215/55 R 16 2 ),
225/45 R 17 2 ),
205/50 R 17 2 )
33/2.3
33/2.3
36/2.5
44/3.0
Z 20 N ET,
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DTH
235/35 R 19
39/2.7
35/2.4
41/2.8
48/3.3
215/55 R 16 2 ),
225/45 R 17 2 )
33/2.3
33/2.3
36/2.5
44/3.0
205/50 R 17 2 )
39/2.7
35/2.4
41/2.8
48/3.3
235/35 R 19
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
215/55 R 16 2 ),
225/45 R 17 2 )
41/2.8
36/2.5
44/3.0
51/3.5
2)
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
18
18
22
22
Z 28 N EL,
Z 28 N ET
205/50 R 17
Z 30 DT
all
235/35 R 19
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
16 2 ),
2)
215/55 R
225/45 R 17
39/2.7
36/2.5
42/2.9
49/3.4
205/50 R 17 2 )
42/2.9
38/2.6
45/3.1
51/3.5
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
61/4.2
T 115/70 R
163 )
1) Sales d esigna tion - see p ag es 284, 285 .
2)
Only permitted a s winter tyres.
3) For notes on the temp orary spa re w heel - see p ag e 237.
Technical data
Electrical system
Battery
Voltage
12 Volt
Amp hours
55 Ah / 60 Ah 3 / 66 Ah 3 / 70 Ah 3 /
72 Ah 3 / 85 Ah 3
Battery for remote control of central locking
sy stem
CR 20 32
Battery for remote control of auxiliary
heater/ventilation
AAA LR 06
307
308
Tec hnic al data
Capacities
(approx. litres)
Eng ine 1 )
Z 18 XE
Z 18 XER
Z 20 NET
Z 22 SE
Z 22 YH
Z 28 NEL,
Z 28 NET
Fuel tank (nominal content)
Saloon / H atch
Estate
61
60
61
60
61
60
61
60
61
60
61
60
Engine oil with filter change
between MI N and M AX on dipstick
4.25
1.0
4.5
1.0
6.0
1.0
4.75
0.75
5.0
1.0
6.0
1.0
Wind screen wash reserv oir
with headlight wash system
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
Technical data
Capacities
(approx. litres)
Eng ine 1 )
Z 19 DTL
Z 19 DT
Z 19 DTH
Z 30 DT
Fuel tank (nominal content)
Saloon / H atch
Estate
61
60
61
60
61
60
61
60
Engine oil with filter change
between MI N and M AX on dipstick
4.3
1.0
4.3
1.0
4.3
1.0
7.5
1.0
Wind screen wash reserv oir
with headlight wash system
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
2.9
5.6
1)
Sa les desig nation – see pa ges 284, 285.
309
310
Tec hnic al data
Dimensions
(approx. mm)
Sa loon / Hatch
Est ate
Sal oon / Ha tch VXR Estat e VXR
O verall length
4611
4839
4642
4870
O verall w id th
1798
1798
1798
1798
Width with two ex terior mirrors
2036
2036
2036
2036
1460
1500
1460
1500
Length of luggage compartment floor
1047
1176
1047
1176
Lug gage compartment width
maximum
between the wheel arches
1396
972
1079
1060
1396
972
1079
1060
Height of lugg age compartment
opening
614 2 )
767
614
767
Wheelb ase
2700
2830
2700
2830
11. 50
11. 50
11. 50
11.50
O verall
height 1 )
Turning c ircle
1)
2)
3)
diam eter 3 )
At kerb weig ht w ith d river.
4-d oor Saloon 324 mm .
In metres.
Technical data
Installatio n dimensions of
caravan/trailer towing
equipment with removable
coupling ball bar 3 ,
Salo on / Hatch
All dimensions refer to fac tory -fitted
towing equipm ent.
Dimension
mm
A
334
B
1061
C
492.5
D
486.5
E
218
F
495
G
492.5
H
201
9 Warning
Only use towing eq uipm ent approved for
your vehicle. We recommend entrusting
retro-fitting of towing equipment to a
work shop.
311
312
Tec hnic al data
Installatio n dimensions of
caravan/trailer towing
equipment with pivotin g
coupling ball bar 3 ,
Estate
All dimensions refer to fac tory -fitted
towing equipm ent.
Dimension
mm
A
396.5
B
157.5
C
386
D
74
E
630
F
590
G
491
H
486
I
480
J
379.5
9 Warning
Only use towing eq uipm ent approved for
your vehicle. We recommend entrusting
retro-fitting of towing equipment to a
work shop.
Technical data
313
314
In dex
Index
A
Ac cessories. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 77, 234
Ac cessory socket ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 60, 93
Ad aptive brake light ... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 208
Ad aptive Forward Lighting (AFL) 132, 133
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 257
Driving abroad ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 136
Ad justing the incline
Seats ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 51
Air conditioning system ... .... .... ..... .... .... 140
Air intak e.... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 166
Air outlet .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 166
Air qua lity sensor ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 157
Air recirculation system .... .... . 148, 153, 161
Air vents . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 142
Airba gs... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 81
Ala rm .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 40
Ala rm system .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 38
Alterna tor ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 99
Antenna . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 137
Anti-corrosion service.. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 271
Anti-freeze . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 274
Anti-freeze protection. ..... .... .... ..... 274, 279
Anti-knock q ua lity of fuel .... .... ..... .... .... 188
O ctane number.... .... ..... .... .... ..... 284, 285
Anti-loc k Brake Sy stem (ABS).. .... ..... .... 210
Anti-theft alarm system .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 38
Anti-theft locking system .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 30
Anti-theft protection .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 16
Aquaplaning.. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 215
Armrest . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 57
Ashtray .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ... 94, 135
Automatic air recircula tion m od e.... .... 161
Automatic anti-dazz le interior mirror.. .. 44
Automatic level control system ... ..... .... 204
Automatic transm ission.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 14
Automatic mode .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 177
Driv ing programmes ... .... ..... .... ..... .... 178
Fault .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 182
Interruption of p ow er supply ... ..... .... 183
Kickd ow n.... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 180
Manual mode . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 178
Selector lev er... .... .... ..... .... .... 14, 177, 178
Selector lev er lock ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 177
Winter programme. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 180
Automatic wiping ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ... 12, 127
Auxiliary heating .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 163
Program ming.. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 164
Remote control ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 165
Index
B
C
Battery ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 185, 280, 307
Interrup tion of
power supply .... .... ..... .... ..... .. 47, 175, 183
Battery discharge p rotection.... .... ..... ... 136
Before sta rting-off ... ..... .... ..... .... 15, 16, 126
Belt force limiters . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 73
Belt tensioners. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 73
Bleeding, d iesel fuel system.. .... .... ..... ... 228
Board Information Disp la y ... .... .... ..... ... 108
Bonnet ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 228
Boot, see Lug gage compartment .... 34, 65
Brake assist . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Brake light ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Brake system ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 99
Brakes
ABS .. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 210
Bra ke assist . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Bra ke fluid ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 276
Bra ke lig hts.. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Bra ke servo unit ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 184
Footbrake .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Handbrake .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 209
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 252
Bulbs ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 252
Capacities .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 308
Car Pass . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 26
Carava n/trailer towing ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 184
Care .... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 264
Catalytic conv erter .. .... ..... .... .... ..... 195, 229
CDC (C ontinuous Da mping Control).... 198
Central lock ing sy stem ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 30
Centre console lighting .... .... .... ..... .... .... 135
Changing the b attery
Remote c ontrol .... .... ..... .... ... 29, 165, 307
Changing tyre/wheel typ e ... .... ..... .... .... 211
Changing wheels ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 238
Chassis num ber,
see Vehic le Id entific ation N umber . .... 283
Check control .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 20, 124
Child restraint sy stem.. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 77
Child safety lock s..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 41, 46
Cigarette lighter . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 93, 135
Climate control ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 140
Climate control system .... .... .... ..... .... .... 156
Clutch operation. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 185
CO 2 emissions . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 287, 288
Cold start ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 185
Colour Information Display . .... ..... .... .... 108
Continuous Damping C ontrol (CDC ).... 198
Contra st.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 119
315
C ontrol indicators... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... 10, 98
Adaptive Forward Lighting . .... . 104, 133
Airb ag .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 86
Anti-lock Bra ke System (ABS ).. ..... .... 210
Belt tensioners .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 74
Brake sy stem... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 209
Engine elec tronics... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 192
Electronic S tability Programme .... .... 196
Exhaust... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 192
IDS+ .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 199
Immobiliser. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 27
Parking dista nce sensors ... 202 133, 203
Tyre pressure monitoring system . .... 207
C ool box ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 61
C oolant . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 274
C oolant level .. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 275
C oolant tempera ture display .. .... ..... .... 106
C ooled glove compartm ent .... .... ..... .... 143
C ooling .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 149, 154
C orrecting time... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 112, 118
C oupling socket load . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 224
C ourtesy light ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 134
C ourtesy lights
Bulb replacement ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 262
C ruise control. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 200
C urtain airbag s .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 85
C urv e lighting (AFL) ... ..... .... ..... .... ... 22, 132
316
In dex
D
E
Dashb oa rd, see Instrument panel ..... .... ... 6
Data .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... .. 26, 282
Date .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 110, 113
Daytime running lig hts . .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 128
Dec om missioning .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 281
Dem isting and defrosting
Windows .. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 147
With climate control sy stem.. .... ..... ... 159
With air conditioning sy stem .... 150, 155
Diesel fuel filter .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 274
Diesel fuel system .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 228, 274
Diesel particle filter.. ..... 102, 143, 185, 194
Dimensions.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 310
Dipped beam .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ... 7
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... 253, 255
Display ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 107, 108
Display mode .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 120
Door locks.... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... .. 26, 266
Doors .. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 100
Door-to-door lighting ... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 133
Drink holders ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 97
Driver’ s seat with climate control . ..... ... 144
Driving abroad ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 188, 269
Headlights ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 136
Toll system ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 138
Driving hints .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 184
Easytronic ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 14, 168
Driving programm es .... .... .... ..... .... .... 171
Interruption of power supply .... .... .... 175
K ic kdown ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 172
Selector lever... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 14
Starting-off.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 170
Winter programm e.. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 172
Economical driving .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 186
Elec tric seat adjustment... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 52
Elec tric sunroof ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 47
Elec tric windows . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 45
Elec trica l sy stem . ..... .... ..... .... . 246, 280, 307
Elec tro-hydraulic p ow er-assisted
steering. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... ... 10, 103, 184
Elec tronic com ponents ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 280
Elec tronic imm obiliser . ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 27
Elec tronic S tability Programme .... .... .... 196
Engine c od e .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 283, 284, 285
Engine c ontrol indicator... .... .... ..... .... .... 192
Engine oil .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 272
Engine oil c hange .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 273
Engine oil level and consump tion 103, 272
Engine oil filter .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 273
Engine oil p ressure .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 98
Engine speed .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 185
Engine w ash .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 266
Env ironmental protection ... ..... .... . 264,
ESP (Electronic Stability Programm e) ..
Exhaust c ontrol indicator ... ..... .... ..... ....
Exhaust g ases..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... ....
Exhaust system ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... ....
Exterior mirrors ... .... .... ..... .... ..... ... 6, 43,
273
196
192
193
193
143
Index
317
F
G
H
Fan.. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 145, 152, 271
Filling station
Capacities.... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 308, 309
Engine oil level . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 272
Fuel . ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 188, 284, 285
Opening the bonnet . .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 228
Ty re pressure.... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 187, 299
Vehicle data ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 283
Windscreen wash sy stem .. .... .... ..... ... 279
First-aid k it, . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 234
Flat tyre ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 242
FlexO rganizer . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 69
Fog tail light .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 131
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Footbrak e.... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Front fog lights .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 130
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Front pa ssenger’s airbag. ..... .... .... ..... .... . 81
Fuel . .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 188, 284, 285
Fuel consump tion .... ..... 186, 188, 287, 288
Fuel filter.. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 274
Fuel gauge .. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 106
Fuel system, diesel ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 228
Fuses ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 246
Gears .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 14
Generator, see Alternator .... .... ..... .... ..... . 99
Genuine Vauxhall Parts
and Accessories ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 271
Glov e com partment .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 95
C ooled .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 143
Glov e com partment lighting ... ..... .... .... 135
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 263
Gra phic al Inform ation Display ..... .... .... 108
Gross Vehicle Weight .. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 293
Halogen headlight system . ..... .... ..... .... 253
Bulb replacement ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 253
Driv ing abroad ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 136
Handb ra ke. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ... 16, 209
Haz ard warning lights .... .... ..... .... ..... .... 131
Head restraints... .... .... ..... .... .... 5, 19, 55, 56
Headlight flash... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 129
Headlight range adjustment... .... . 131, 252
Headlight switch .... .... ..... .... ..... . 7, 128, 129
Headlight wash system .. .... .... 12, 127, 279
Headlights . .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... . 7
Daytime running lights.... ..... .... ..... .... 128
Driv ing abroad ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 136
Front fog lights ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 130
Reversing lig hts... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 131
Wa rning device... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 126
Heated ex terior mirrors .. .... ..... .... ... 13, 143
Heated front sea ts . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 144
Heated rear seats .. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 144
Heated rear w indow .. ..... .... ..... .... ... 13, 143
Heating . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .. 140, 146, 154
Seats.. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 144
With clima te control sy stem .... ..... .... 158
With air c onditioning sy stem ... . 150, 155
Height adjustm ent
Seat belts ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 76
Steering wheel .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... . 6
High-pressure cleaners ... .... .. 221, 266, 267
Horn... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 11
318
In dex
I
J
K
Identification plate .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 282
IDS+ (Interactive Driving Sy stem) . 196, 198
Ignition logic ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 113, 120
Ignition sy stem ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 271, 280
Imm ob iliser.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 27
Information display . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 108
Infotainm ent system ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 137
Inspection system .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 268
Instrument display ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 105
Instrument illum ination .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 134
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 263
Instrument panel . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ... 6
Instruments . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .. 98, 105, 137
Interactiv e Driving S ystem (I DS+) . 196, 198
Interior mirror .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... . 5, 44
Univ ersal remote control ... .... .... ..... .... . 41
Interruption of power supply .. 47, 122, 125
Easytronic .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 175
Elec tric wind ow s... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 47
Selector lever lock ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 183
ISO FIX. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 79
Jack ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 238
Jump starting.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 230
K eys
Extending ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..
Ignition lock ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 6, 15,
Locking doors . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..
Remov e .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..
Starting the engine. ..... .... ..... .... . 6, 15,
26
27
30
16
27
Index
319
L
M
N
Langua ge selection. ..... .... ..... .... .... 113, 118
Lashing eyes ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 69
Leather trim .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 266
Level control sy stem ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 204
Light switch . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ... 7
Lighting ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 7, 100, 128
Driv ing abroad . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 136
Loa ding ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 223
Loc king doors . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... . 2, 30
Loc king from the inside.... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 31
Loc ks... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 266
Lub rica nts ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 272, 283
Lug gage compartment
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 263
Extension . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 65
FlexOrga nizer... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 69
Lashing ey es .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 69
Lighting ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 135
Loading ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 223, 293
Locking .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 34
Safety net .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 67
Lug gage compartment cover .. .... ..... .... . 66
Lum bar sup port ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... .... 51, 53
Main bea m. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 7, 129
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... 254, 256
C ontrol indicator.. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 101
Maintenance... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 268
Air conditioning system .... .... ..... .... .... 167
Anti-freeze protec tion .. .... .... ..... .... .... 274
Brake fluid ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 276
Brakes. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 208
C atalytic converter .. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 195
Engine oil ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 272, 273
Fuel consum ption .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 187
Tyre pressure... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 213
Tyres ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 214
Windscreen wiper .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 277
Manua l transmission ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 14
Mirrors .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 5, 43, 44
Misted windows .. ..... .... ..... .... ... 13, 147, 159
Mobile telephone..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 139
Motorwa y lighting (AFL).. .... .... ..... .. 22, 132
Muffler, see Ex haust system .... ..... .... .... 193
N um ber plate lights
Bulb replacement ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 261
N um ber plate lighting .... .... ..... .... ..... .... 261
N um ber plates.... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 281
320
In dex
O
P
Q
O ctane numbers.. .... ..... .... .... 188, 284, 285
O dometer .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 105
O il chang e... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 273
O il filter change ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 273
O il level and consum ption .... .... .... ..... ... 272
O il pressure . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 98
O ils .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 272
O perating temperature.... ..... .... .... ..... ... 185
O utside temperature ga uge . .... .... ..... ... 109
O verrun.... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 185, 187
Pa intwork damage.. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 265
Pa rk ing ... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 16, 202
Pa rk ing distance sensors . .... .... ..... .... .... 202
Pa rk ing lights .. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 7, 134
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 257
Pa rts ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 271
Pedals . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 185
Perform ance ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 287, 288
Petrol .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 188, 284, 285
Pinking .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 188
Pollen filter . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 166
Position mem ory . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 43, 54
Power steering, see electro-hyd ra ulic
power-assisted steering . .... .... ..... .... .... 184
Preheating.. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 102
Pushing, towing .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 229
Q uic kheat .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .. 146, 154, 158
Index
R
S
Radio .. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 137
Radio equipment (C B).. .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 139
Radio reception ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 137
Rain sensor.. .... .... 12, 47, 48, 127, 264, 277
Reading lights. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 135
Rear light cluster.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 128
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Rear window
wa sh system .. ..... .... ..... .. 12, 127, 264, 279
Refuelling . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 189
Fuel filler cap .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 188
Remote control
Aux iliary heating.. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 165
Central locking system . ..... .... .... ..... .... . 28
Steering wheel.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... .. 21, 137
Univ ersal remote control ... .... .... ..... .... . 41
Replacem ent keys ... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 26
Reversible carpet . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 69
Reversing lights
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Roof load . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .. 71, 184, 187
Roof rack . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 187, 218
Running-in
Bra kes .. .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 208
Safeguard against unauthorised use 6, 16
Safety accessories ... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 77, 234
Safety net ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 67
Saving energy . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 186
Sea t adjustment . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 3, 50, 52
Sea t belts ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... . 72, 76, 266
Sea t height adjustm ent ... .... .... ..... .... .. 3, 51
Sea t occupancy recognition .... ..... .... ..... . 87
Sea t position ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 52, 53
Sea ts ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 3, 50, 51
Extending the lug gage compartment 65
Heated .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 144
With climate control ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 144
Selector lev er... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 169, 177
Selector lev er lock .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 14, 177
Self-diagnosis . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 74, 86
Self-help . .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 228
C entral locking system . .... .... ..... .... ..... . 33
Electric sunroof .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 49
Electric windows... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 47
Information disp la y . ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 110
Remote c ontrol .... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 29
Serv ic e interv al display .... .... .... ..... .... .... 270
Serv ic e work .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 270
Side airbags .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 83
Spare fuses. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 247
Spare keys.. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 26
Spare wheel .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 236, 238
321
S peed .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 186
Fuel consumption ... ..... .... ..... .... . 186, 187
S peedometer . ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 105
S port mode .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 101, 198
S ta rter switch. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 6, 15, 27
S ta rting the engine .... ..... .... .. 6, 15, 27, 229
Self-help . .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 229
S team-jet cleaners . .... ..... .... .. 221, 266, 267
S teering column lock .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .. 6, 16
S teering w heel a djustment . ..... .... ..... .... .... . 6
S teering w heel remote control .... ... 21, 137
S towa ge c om partments . .... ..... ... 57, 95, 96
S unblind ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 49
S unroof.. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 47
S unsha de ... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 49
S ystem settings... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 112, 117
322
In dex
T
Tables. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 62
Tachometer. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 105
Tail lights . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 128
Bulb replacement. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 258
Tailgate ... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 34
Tailgate wiper . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 127
Technical d ata ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 282
Telephone, see Mobile telephone ..... ... 139
Tem perature regulation... ..... .... .... 145, 158
Tem porary spare wheel ... ..... .... .... 217, 237
The first 600 miles.... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 184
Thigh support . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... . 53
Tightening torque.... ..... .... ..... .... .... 242, 299
Time .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 110, 113
Toll sy stems. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 138
Tools ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 238
Towing ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 232
Towing eq uipm ent .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 219
Towing ey e.. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 232, 233
Trailer/caravan towing . .... ..... .... .... ..... ... 184
Trailer S tability Assist (TSA).. .... .... ..... ... 225
Transm ission display .... .... ..... .... .... 168, 176
Tra nsmission, automatic . .... .... ..... .... ..... . 14
Automatic mode.. .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 177
Driving programm es .... .... .... ..... .... .... 178
Fault.... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 182
Interruption of power supply .... .... .... 183
K ic kdown ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 180
Selector lever... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 177, 178
Selector lever loc k .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 177
Winter programm e.. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 180
Tra nsmission, Easytronic . .... .... ..... .... .... 168
Driving programm es .... .... .... ..... .... .... 171
Interruption of power supply .... .... .... 175
K ic kdown ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 172
Selector lever... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 14, 170
Winter programm e.. ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 172
Tra nsmission, m anual . ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... . 14
Tra vel Assistant .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... 22, 58
Tread d epth .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 214
Trip computer . .... ..... .... ..... .... ... 20, 114, 120
Trip odometer . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 105
Triple Information Display ... .... ..... .... .... 108
TS A (Trailer S ta bility Assist) . .... ..... .... .... 225
Turn lighting (AFL) .. .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 22, 132
Turn signal lights ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... ... 7
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 258
Tw in Audio . ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .. 21, 138
Ty re c hains. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... 217, 299
Ty re c ondition . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 214
Ty re p ressure .. .... ..... .... ..... .... . 204, 213, 299
Ty re p ressure monitoring system . .... .... 204
Ty re repair kit . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 242
U
Units of mea sure .... .... ..... .... ..... .... . 113, 119
Unlea ded fuel ..... .... .... ... 188, 190, 284, 285
Used oil . ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 273
V
Valve cap k ey ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 213
Vauxhall alarm system ... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 38
Vauxhall Service . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 268
Vehicle care ... ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 264
Vehicle decom missioning ... ..... .... ..... .... 281
Vehicle Identification Number .... ..... .... 283
Vehicle key s, see Keys .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .. 26
Vehicle recomm issioning .... ..... .... ..... .... 281
Vehicle tools .. ..... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... 238
Ventilation . .... ..... .... .... ... 140, 146, 153, 160
Index
W
Warning buzzers.. .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Warning messages .. ..... .... ..... .... .... 111,
Warning triangle, . .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Wash fluid reservoir,
windscreen wash sy stem ..... .... .... ..... ...
Wheels, ty res ... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Wind ow s
Demisting
and defrosting . ... 13, 147, 150, 155,
Wind screen wash system . ..... .... .... .. 12,
Anti-freeze protection .. ..... .... .... ..... ...
Capacities.... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 308,
Wash fluid reservoir .. .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Wind screen wiper .... ..... .... ..... .. 11, 126,
Winter mode
Starting -off aid .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Winter operation
Battery . .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Coolant, anti-freeze.. .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Fuel consumption ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Fuel for d iesel engines.. ..... .... .... ..... ...
Heating .... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 140, 150,
Locks .... .... .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Ty re chains .. ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 217,
Window demisting and defrosting ...
Windscreen wash sy stem,
anti-freeze protection... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Winter programme .. ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... ...
Winter tyres. .... ..... .... ..... .... ..... .... .... 216,
X
126
116
234
279
211
159
127
279
309
279
277
172
185
274
187
188
155
266
299
147
279
172
299
Xenon headlight system .. .... .... ..... .... .... 255
Bulb replacem ent .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 255
Driving abroad ..... .... ..... .... .... ..... .... .... 136
323
324
In dex
Owner’s Manual
VECTRA
Operation, Safety and Maintenance
Reproduction or translation, in whole or in parts,
is not permitted without prior written consent from
Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
All rights as understood under the copyright laws are explicitly
reserved by Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this
manual are based on the latest production information
available at the time of publication.
The right is reserved to make changes at any time without
notice.
Edition: July 2007.
TS 1557-A-08
VECTRA
©Copyright by Vauxhall Motors Ltd., England.